90usb646 647 1286 1287
90usb646 647 1286 1287
90usb646 647 1286 1287
•
– Programming of Flash, EEPROM, Fuses, and Lock Bits through the JTAG Interface
USB 2.0 Full-speed/Low-speed Device and On-The-Go Module
AT90USB646
– Complies fully with: AT90USB647
– Universal Serial Bus Specification REV 2.0
– On-The-Go Supplement to the USB 2.0 Specification Rev 1.0 AT90USB1286
– Supports data transfer rates up to 12 Mbit/s and 1.5 Mbit/s
• USB Full-speed/Low Speed Device Module with Interrupt on Transfer Completion AT90USB1287
– Endpoint 0 for Control Transfers : up to 64-bytes
– 6 Programmable Endpoints with IN or Out Directions and with Bulk, Interrupt or
Isochronous Transfers
– Configurable Endpoints size up to 256 bytes in double bank mode
Preliminary
– Fully independant 832 bytes USB DPRAM for endpoint memory allocation
– Suspend/Resume Interrupts
– Power-on Reset and USB Bus Reset
– 48 MHz PLL for Full-speed Bus Operation
– USB Bus Disconnection on Microcontroller Request
• USB OTG:
– Supports Host Negotiation Protocol (HNP) and Session Request Protocol (SRP)
for OTG dual-role devices
– Provide Status and control signals for software implementation of HNP and SRP
– Provides programmable times required for HNP and SRP
• Peripheral Features
– Two 8-bit Timer/Counters with Separate Prescaler and Compare Mode
– Two16-bit Timer/Counter with Separate Prescaler, Compare- and Capture Mode
– Real Time Counter with Separate Oscillator
– Two 8-bit PWM Channels
7593D–AVR–07/06
– Six PWM Channels with Programmable Resolution from 2 to 16 Bits
– Output Compare Modulator
– 8-channels, 10-bit ADC
– Programmable Serial USART
– Master/Slave SPI Serial Interface
– Byte Oriented 2-wire Serial Interface
– Programmable Watchdog Timer with Separate On-chip Oscillator
– On-chip Analog Comparator
– Interrupt and Wake-up on Pin Change
• Special Microcontroller Features
– Power-on Reset and Programmable Brown-out Detection
– Internal Calibrated Oscillator
– External and Internal Interrupt Sources
– Six Sleep Modes: Idle, ADC Noise Reduction, Power-save, Power-down, Standby, and Extended Standby
• I/O and Packages
– 48 Programmable I/O Lines
– 64-lead TQFP and 64-lead QFN
• Operating Voltages
– 2.7 - 5.5V
– 2.2 - 5.5V (Check availabilty)
• Operating temperature
– Industrial (-40°C to +85°C)
• Maximum Frequency
– 8 MHz at 2.7V - Industrial range
– 16 MHz at 4.5V - Industrial range
2 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
1. Pin Configurations
Figure 1-1. Pinout AT90USB64/128-TQFP
PF5 (ADC5/TMS)
PF6 (ADC6/TDO)
PF4 (ADC4/TCK)
PF7 (ADC7/TDI)
PF0 (ADC0)
PF1 (ADC1)
PF2 (ADC2)
PF3 (ADC3)
PA0 (AD0)
PA1 (AD1)
PA2 (AD2)
AVCC
AREF
GND
GND
VCC
64
63
62
61
60
59
58
57
56
55
54
53
52
51
50
49
(INT.6/AIN.0) PE6 1 48 PA3 (AD3)
3 INDEX CORNER
UVcc 46 PA5 (AD5)
D- 4 45 PA6 (AD6)
D+ 5 44 PA7 (AD7)
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
VCC
GND
XTAL2
XTAL1
(PCINT7/OC.0A/OC.1C) PB7
(INT4/TOSC1) PE4
(INT.5/TOSC2) PE5
RESET
(OC0B/SCL/INT0) PD0
(OC2B/SDA/INT1) PD1
(RXD1/INT2) PD2
(TXD1/INT3) PD3
(ICP1) PD4
(XCK1) PD5
(T1) PD6
(T0) PD7
3
7593D–AVR–07/06
Figure 1-2. Pinout AT90USB64/128-QFN
PF5 (ADC5/TMS)
PF6 (ADC6/TDO)
PF4 (ADC4/TCK)
PF7 (ADC7/TDI)
PF0 (ADC0)
PF1 (ADC1)
PF2 (ADC2)
PF3 (ADC3)
PA0 (AD0)
PA1 (AD1)
PA2 (AD2)
AVCC
AREF
GND
GND
VCC
64
63
62
61
60
59
58
57
56
55
54
53
52
51
50
49
(INT.6/AIN.0) PE6 1 48 PA3 (AD3)
(INT.7/AIN.1/UVcon) PE7 2 47 PA4 (AD4)
UVcc 3 46 PA5 (AD5)
INDEX CORNER
D- 4 45 PA6 (AD6)
D+ 5 44 PA7 (AD7)
UGnd 6 43 PE2 (ALE/HWB)
UCap 7 42 PC7 (A15/IC.3/CLK0)
VBus 8 AT90USB128 41 PC6 (A14/OC.3A)
(IUID) PE3 9 40 PC5 (A13/OC.3B)
(SS/PCINT0) PB0 10
(64-lead QFN top view) 39 PC4 (A12/OC.3C)
(PCINT1/SCLK) PB1 11 38 PC3 (A11/T.3)
(PDI/PCINT2/MOSI) PB2 12 37 PC2 (A10)
(PDO/PCINT3/MISO) PB3 13 36 PC1 (A9)
(PCINT4/OC.2A) PB4 14 35 PC0 (A8)
(PCINT5/OC.1A) PB5 15 34 PE1 (RD)
(PCINT6/OC.1B) PB6 16 33 PE0 (WR)
20
28
17
18
19
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
29
30
31
32
VCC
GND
XTAL2
XTAL1
(PCINT7/OC.0A/OC.1C) PB7
(INT4/TOSC1) PE4
(INT.5/TOSC2) PE5
RESET
(OC0B/SCL/INT0) PD0
(OC2B/SDA/INT1) PD1
(RXD1/INT2) PD2
(TXD1/INT3) PD3
(ICP1) PD4
(XCK1) PD5
(T1) PD6
(T0) PD7
Note: The large center pad underneath the MLF packages is made of metal and internally connected to
GND. It should be soldered or glued to the board to ensure good mechanical stability. If the center
pad is left unconnected, the package might loosen from the board.
1.1 Disclaimer
Typical values contained in this datasheet are based on simulations and characterization of
other AVR microcontrollers manufactured on the same process technology. Min and Max values
will be available after the device is characterized.
2. Overview
The AT90USB64/128 is a low-power CMOS 8-bit microcontroller based on the AVR enhanced
RISC architecture. By executing powerful instructions in a single clock cycle, the
4 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
AT90USB64/128 achieves throughputs approaching 1 MIPS per MHz allowing the system
designer to optimize power consumption versus processing speed.
RESET
XTAL2
XTAL1
PF7 - PF0 PA7 - PA0 PC7 - PC0
GND
DATA REGISTER DATA DIR. DATA REGISTER DATA DIR. DATA REGISTER DATA DIR.
PORTF REG. PORTF PORTA REG. PORTA PORTC REG. PORTC
POR - BOD
RESET
AVCC INTERNAL
CALIB. OSC
OSCILLATOR
ADC
AGND
AREF OSCILLATOR
WATCHDOG
PROGRAM STACK TIMER
JTAG TAP
COUNTER POINTER
OSCILLATOR
BOUNDARY-
INSTRUCTION TIMER/
SCAN GENERAL
REGISTER COUNTERS
PURPOSE
REGISTERS
X
PROGRAMMING
INSTRUCTION Y INTERRUPT
LOGIC
DECODER Z UNIT
CONTROL
LINES ALU EEPROM
PLL
STATUS
REGISTER
TWO-WIRE SERIAL
USART0 SPI USB
INTERFACE
COMPARATOR
ANALOG
DATA REGISTER DATA DIR. DATA REGISTER DATA DIR. DATA REGISTER DATA DIR. DATA REG. DATA DIR.
PORTE REG. PORTE PORTB REG. PORTB PORTD REG. PORTD PORTG REG. PORTG
-
+
The AVR core combines a rich instruction set with 32 general purpose working registers. All the
32 registers are directly connected to the Arithmetic Logic Unit (ALU), allowing two independent
registers to be accessed in one single instruction executed in one clock cycle. The resulting
architecture is more code efficient while achieving throughputs up to ten times faster than con-
ventional CISC microcontrollers.
5
7593D–AVR–07/06
The AT90USB64/128 provides the following features: 64/128K bytes of In-System Programma-
ble Flash with Read-While-Write capabilities, 2K/4K bytes EEPROM, 4K/8K bytes SRAM, 48
general purpose I/O lines, 32 general purpose working registers, Real Time Counter (RTC), four
flexible Timer/Counters with compare modes and PWM, one USART, a byte oriented 2-wire
Serial Interface, a 8-channels, 10-bit ADC with optional differential input stage with programma-
ble gain, programmable Watchdog Timer with Internal Oscillator, an SPI serial port, IEEE std.
1149.1 compliant JTAG test interface, also used for accessing the On-chip Debug system and
programming and six software selectable power saving modes. The Idle mode stops the CPU
while allowing the SRAM, Timer/Counters, SPI port, and interrupt system to continue function-
ing. The Power-down mode saves the register contents but freezes the Oscillator, disabling all
other chip functions until the next interrupt or Hardware Reset. In Power-save mode, the asyn-
chronous timer continues to run, allowing the user to maintain a timer base while the rest of the
device is sleeping. The ADC Noise Reduction mode stops the CPU and all I/O modules except
Asynchronous Timer and ADC, to minimize switching noise during ADC conversions. In Standby
mode, the Crystal/Resonator Oscillator is running while the rest of the device is sleeping. This
allows very fast start-up combined with low power consumption. In Extended Standby mode,
both the main Oscillator and the Asynchronous Timer continue to run.
The device is manufactured using Atmel’s high-density nonvolatile memory technology. The On-
chip ISP Flash allows the program memory to be reprogrammed in-system through an SPI serial
interface, by a conventional nonvolatile memory programmer, or by an On-chip Boot program
running on the AVR core. The boot program can use any interface to download the application
program in the application Flash memory. Software in the Boot Flash section will continue to run
while the Application Flash section is updated, providing true Read-While-Write operation. By
combining an 8-bit RISC CPU with In-System Self-Programmable Flash on a monolithic chip,
the Atmel AT90USB64/128 is a powerful microcontroller that provides a highly flexible and cost
effective solution to many embedded control applications.
The AT90USB64/128 AVR is supported with a full suite of program and system development
tools including: C compilers, macro assemblers, program debugger/simulators, in-circuit emula-
tors, and evaluation kits.
2.2.1 VCC
Digital supply voltage.
2.2.2 GND
Ground.
6 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
2.2.4 Port B (PB7..PB0)
Port B is an 8-bit bi-directional I/O port with internal pull-up resistors (selected for each bit). The
Port B output buffers have symmetrical drive characteristics with both high sink and source
capability. As inputs, Port B pins that are externally pulled low will source current if the pull-up
resistors are activated. The Port B pins are tri-stated when a reset condition becomes active,
even if the clock is not running.
Port B has better driving capabilities than the other ports.
Port B also serves the functions of various special features of the AT90USB64/128 as listed on
page 82.
7
7593D–AVR–07/06
2.2.9 D-
USB Full speed / Low Speed Negative Data Upstream Port. Should be connected to the USB D-
connector pin with a serial 22 Ohms resistor.
2.2.10 D+
USB Full speed / Low Speed Positive Data Upstream Port. Should be connected to the USB D+
connector pin with a serial 22 Ohms resistor.
2.2.11 UGND
USB Pads Ground.
2.2.12 UVCC
USB Pads Internal Regulator Input supply voltage.
2.2.13 UCAP
USB Pads Internal Regulator Output supply voltage. Should be connected to an external capac-
itor (1µF).
2.2.14 VBUS
USB VBUS monitor and OTG negociations.
2.2.15 RESET
Reset input. A low level on this pin for longer than the minimum pulse length will generate a
reset, even if the clock is not running. The minimum pulse length is given in Table 8-1 on page
60. Shorter pulses are not guaranteed to generate a reset.
2.2.16 XTAL1
Input to the inverting Oscillator amplifier and input to the internal clock operating circuit.
2.2.17 XTAL2
Output from the inverting Oscillator amplifier.
2.2.18 AVCC
AVCC is the supply voltage pin for Port F and the A/D Converter. It should be externally con-
nected to VCC, even if the ADC is not used. If the ADC is used, it should be connected to VCC
through a low-pass filter.
2.2.19 AREF
This is the analog reference pin for the A/D Converter.
8 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
instructions must be replaced with instructions that allow access to extended I/O. Typically
"LDS" and "STS" combined with "SBRS", "SBRC", "SBR", and "CBR".
9
7593D–AVR–07/06
4. AVR CPU Core
4.1 Introduction
This section discusses the AVR core architecture in general. The main function of the CPU core
is to ensure correct program execution. The CPU must therefore be able to access memories,
perform calculations, control peripherals, and handle interrupts.
Program Status
Flash
Counter and Control
Program
Memory
Interrupt
32 x 8 Unit
Instruction General
Register Purpose SPI
Registrers Unit
Instruction Watchdog
Decoder Timer
Indirect Addressing
Direct Addressing
ALU Analog
Control Lines Comparator
I/O Module1
I/O Module n
EEPROM
I/O Lines
In order to maximize performance and parallelism, the AVR uses a Harvard architecture – with
separate memories and buses for program and data. Instructions in the program memory are
executed with a single level pipelining. While one instruction is being executed, the next instruc-
tion is pre-fetched from the program memory. This concept enables instructions to be executed
in every clock cycle. The program memory is In-System Reprogrammable Flash memory.
10 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
The fast-access Register File contains 32 x 8-bit general purpose working registers with a single
clock cycle access time. This allows single-cycle Arithmetic Logic Unit (ALU) operation. In a typ-
ical ALU operation, two operands are output from the Register File, the operation is executed,
and the result is stored back in the Register File – in one clock cycle.
Six of the 32 registers can be used as three 16-bit indirect address register pointers for Data
Space addressing – enabling efficient address calculations. One of the these address pointers
can also be used as an address pointer for look up tables in Flash program memory. These
added function registers are the 16-bit X-, Y-, and Z-register, described later in this section.
The ALU supports arithmetic and logic operations between registers or between a constant and
a register. Single register operations can also be executed in the ALU. After an arithmetic opera-
tion, the Status Register is updated to reflect information about the result of the operation.
Program flow is provided by conditional and unconditional jump and call instructions, able to
directly address the whole address space. Most AVR instructions have a single 16-bit word for-
mat. Every program memory address contains a 16- or 32-bit instruction.
Program Flash memory space is divided in two sections, the Boot Program section and the
Application Program section. Both sections have dedicated Lock bits for write and read/write
protection. The SPM instruction that writes into the Application Flash memory section must
reside in the Boot Program section.
During interrupts and subroutine calls, the return address Program Counter (PC) is stored on the
Stack. The Stack is effectively allocated in the general data SRAM, and consequently the Stack
size is only limited by the total SRAM size and the usage of the SRAM. All user programs must
initialize the SP in the Reset routine (before subroutines or interrupts are executed). The Stack
Pointer (SP) is read/write accessible in the I/O space. The data SRAM can easily be accessed
through the five different addressing modes supported in the AVR architecture.
The memory spaces in the AVR architecture are all linear and regular memory maps.
A flexible interrupt module has its control registers in the I/O space with an additional Global
Interrupt Enable bit in the Status Register. All interrupts have a separate Interrupt Vector in the
Interrupt Vector table. The interrupts have priority in accordance with their Interrupt Vector posi-
tion. The lower the Interrupt Vector address, the higher the priority.
The I/O memory space contains 64 addresses for CPU peripheral functions as Control Regis-
ters, SPI, and other I/O functions. The I/O Memory can be accessed directly, or as the Data
Space locations following those of the Register File, 0x20 - 0x5F. In addition, the
AT90USB64/128 has Extended I/O space from 0x60 - 0x0FF in SRAM where only the
ST/STS/STD and LD/LDS/LDD instructions can be used.
11
7593D–AVR–07/06
4.4 Status Register
The Status Register contains information about the result of the most recently executed arith-
metic instruction. This information can be used for altering program flow in order to perform
conditional operations. Note that the Status Register is updated after all ALU operations, as
specified in the Instruction Set Reference. This will in many cases remove the need for using the
dedicated compare instructions, resulting in faster and more compact code.
The Status Register is not automatically stored when entering an interrupt routine and restored
when returning from an interrupt. This must be handled by software.
The AVR Status Register – SREG – is defined as:
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
I T H S V N Z C SREG
Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
12 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
• Bit 0 – C: Carry Flag
The Carry Flag C indicates a carry in an arithmetic or logic operation. See the “Instruction Set
Description” for detailed information.
7 0 Addr.
R0 0x00
R1 0x01
R2 0x02
…
R13 0x0D
General R14 0x0E
Purpose R15 0x0F
Working R16 0x10
Registers R17 0x11
…
R26 0x1A X-register Low Byte
R27 0x1B X-register High Byte
R28 0x1C Y-register Low Byte
R29 0x1D Y-register High Byte
R30 0x1E Z-register Low Byte
R31 0x1F Z-register High Byte
Most of the instructions operating on the Register File have direct access to all registers, and
most of them are single cycle instructions.
As shown in Figure 4-2, each register is also assigned a data memory address, mapping them
directly into the first 32 locations of the user Data Space. Although not being physically imple-
mented as SRAM locations, this memory organization provides great flexibility in access of the
registers, as the X-, Y- and Z-pointer registers can be set to index any register in the file.
13
7593D–AVR–07/06
Figure 4-3. The X-, Y-, and Z-registers
15 XH XL 0
X-register 7 0 7 0
R27 (0x1B) R26 (0x1A)
15 YH YL 0
Y-register 7 0 7 0
R29 (0x1D) R28 (0x1C)
15 ZH ZL 0
Z-register 7 0 7 0
R31 (0x1F) R30 (0x1E)
In the different addressing modes these address registers have functions as fixed displacement,
automatic increment, and automatic decrement (see the instruction set reference for details).
14 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
4.6.1 Extended Z-pointer Register for ELPM/SPM - RAMPZ
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
RAMPZ RAMPZ RAMPZ RAMPZ RAMPZ RAMPZ RAMPZ1 RAMPZ0 RAMPZ
7 6 5 4 3 2
Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
For ELPM/SPM instructions, the Z-pointer is a concatenation of RAMPZ, ZH, and ZL, as shown
in Figure 4-4. Note that LPM is not affected by the RAMPZ setting.
Bit ( 7 0 7 0 7 0
Individually)
RAMPZ ZH ZL
Bit (Z-pointer) 23 16 15 8 7 0
The actual number of bits is implementation dependent. Unused bits in an implementation will
always read as zero. For compatibility with future devices, be sure to write these bits to zero.
clkCPU
1st Instruction Fetch
1st Instruction Execute
2nd Instruction Fetch
2nd Instruction Execute
3rd Instruction Fetch
3rd Instruction Execute
4th Instruction Fetch
Figure 4-6 shows the internal timing concept for the Register File. In a single clock cycle an ALU
operation using two register operands is executed, and the result is stored back to the destina-
tion register.
15
7593D–AVR–07/06
Figure 4-6. Single Cycle ALU Operation
T1 T2 T3 T4
clkCPU
Total Execution Time
16 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Note that the Status Register is not automatically stored when entering an interrupt routine, nor
restored when returning from an interrupt routine. This must be handled by software.
When using the CLI instruction to disable interrupts, the interrupts will be immediately disabled.
No interrupt will be executed after the CLI instruction, even if it occurs simultaneously with the
CLI instruction. The following example shows how this can be used to avoid interrupts during the
timed EEPROM write sequence..
When using the SEI instruction to enable interrupts, the instruction following SEI will be exe-
cuted before any pending interrupts, as shown in this example.
17
7593D–AVR–07/06
Assembly Code Example
sei ; set Global Interrupt Enable
sleep; enter sleep, waiting for interrupt
; note: will enter sleep before any pending
; interrupt(s)
C Code Example
__enable_interrupt(); /* set Global Interrupt Enable */
__sleep(); /* enter sleep, waiting for interrupt */
/* note: will enter sleep before any pending interrupt(s) */
18 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
5. AVR AT90USB64/128 Memories
This section describes the different memories in the AT90USB64/128. The AVR architecture has
two main memory spaces, the Data Memory and the Program Memory space. In addition, the
AT90USB64/128 features an EEPROM Memory for data storage. All three memory spaces are
linear and regular.
19
7593D–AVR–07/06
memory locations. The operation of Boot Program section and associated Boot Lock bits for
software protection are described in detail in “Memory Programming” on page 368. “Memory
Programming” on page 368 contains a detailed description on Flash data serial downloading
using the SPI pins or the JTAG interface.
Constant tables can be allocated within the entire program memory address space (see the LPM
– Load Program Memory instruction description and ELPM - Extended Load Program Memory
instruction description).
Timing diagrams for instruction fetch and execution are presented in “Instruction Execution Tim-
ing” on page 15.
0x00000
20 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
An optional external data SRAM can be used with the AT90USB64/128. This SRAM will occupy
an area in the remaining address locations in the 64K address space. This area starts at the
address following the internal SRAM. The Register file, I/O, Extended I/O and Internal SRAM
occupies the lowest 4,608/8,704 bytes, so when using 64KB (65,536 bytes) of External Memory,
60,478/56,832 Bytes of External Memory are available. See “External Memory Interface” on
page 30 for details on how to take advantage of the external memory map.
When the addresses accessing the SRAM memory space exceeds the internal data memory
locations, the external data SRAM is accessed using the same instructions as for the internal
data memory access. When the internal data memories are accessed, the read and write strobe
pins (PE0 and PE1) are inactive during the whole access cycle. External SRAM operation is
enabled by setting the SRE bit in the XMCRA Register.
Accessing external SRAM takes one additional clock cycle per byte compared to access of the
internal SRAM. This means that the commands LD, ST, LDS, STS, LDD, STD, PUSH, and POP
take one additional clock cycle. If the Stack is placed in external SRAM, interrupts, subroutine
calls and returns take three clock cycles extra because the three-byte program counter is
pushed and popped, and external memory access does not take advantage of the internal pipe-
line memory access. When external SRAM interface is used with wait-state, one-byte external
access takes two, three, or four additional clock cycles for one, two, and three wait-states
respectively. Interrupts, subroutine calls and returns will need five, seven, or nine clock cycles
more than specified in the instruction set manual for one, two, and three wait-states.
The five different addressing modes for the data memory cover: Direct, Indirect with Displace-
ment, Indirect, Indirect with Pre-decrement, and Indirect with Post-increment. In the Register file,
registers R26 to R31 feature the indirect addressing pointer registers.
The direct addressing reaches the entire data space.
The Indirect with Displacement mode reaches 63 address locations from the base address given
by the Y- or Z-register.
When using register indirect addressing modes with automatic pre-decrement and post-incre-
ment, the address registers X, Y, and Z are decremented or incremented.
The 32 general purpose working registers, 64 I/O registers, and the 8,192 bytes of internal data
SRAM in the AT90USB64/128 are all accessible through all these addressing modes. The Reg-
ister File is described in “General Purpose Register File” on page 13.
21
7593D–AVR–07/06
Figure 5-2. Data Memory Map
Data Memory
32 Registers $0000 - $001F
64 I/O Registers $0020 - $005F
160 E xt I/O Reg. $0060 - $00FF
ISRAM start
Internal S RAM
(8192 x 8)
ISRAM end
XMem start
External S RAM
(0 - 64K x 8)
$FFFF
22 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Figure 5-3. On-chip Data SRAM Access Cycles
T1 T2 T3
clkCPU
Address Compute Address Address valid
Data
Write
WR
Data
Read
RD
23
7593D–AVR–07/06
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Read/Write R R R R R/W R/W R/W R/W
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 X X X X
X X X X X X X X
24 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
25
7593D–AVR–07/06
When the write access time has elapsed, the EEPE bit is cleared by hardware. The user soft-
ware can poll this bit and wait for a zero before writing the next byte. When EEPE has been set,
the CPU is halted for two cycles before the next instruction is executed.
The following code examples show one assembly and one C function for writing to the
EEPROM. The examples assume that interrupts are controlled (e.g. by disabling interrupts glo-
bally) so that no interrupts will occur during execution of these functions. The examples also
assume that no Flash Boot Loader is present in the software. If such code is present, the
EEPROM write function must also wait for any ongoing SPM command to finish.
26 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
27
7593D–AVR–07/06
The next code examples show assembly and C functions for reading the EEPROM. The exam-
ples assume that interrupts are controlled so that no interrupts will occur during execution of
these functions.
28 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
5.4 I/O Memory
The I/O space definition of the AT90USB64/128 is shown in “Register Summary” on page 414.
All AT90USB64/128 I/Os and peripherals are placed in the I/O space. All I/O locations may be
accessed by the LD/LDS/LDD and ST/STS/STD instructions, transferring data between the 32
general purpose working registers and the I/O space. I/O Registers within the address range
0x00 - 0x1F are directly bit-accessible using the SBI and CBI instructions. In these registers, the
value of single bits can be checked by using the SBIS and SBIC instructions. Refer to the
instruction set section for more details. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the
I/O addresses 0x00 - 0x3F must be used. When addressing I/O Registers as data space using
LD and ST instructions, 0x20 must be added to these addresses. The AT90USB64/128 is a
complex microcontroller with more peripheral units than can be supported within the 64 location
reserved in Opcode for the IN and OUT instructions. For the Extended I/O space from 0x60 -
0x1FF in SRAM, only the ST/STS/STD and LD/LDS/LDD instructions can be used.
For compatibility with future devices, reserved bits should be written to zero if accessed.
Reserved I/O memory addresses should never be written.
Some of the Status Flags are cleared by writing a logical one to them. Note that, unlike most
other AVRs, the CBI and SBI instructions will only operate on the specified bit, and can therefore
be used on registers containing such Status Flags. The CBI and SBI instructions work with reg-
isters 0x00 to 0x1F only.
The I/O and peripherals control registers are explained in later sections.
29
7593D–AVR–07/06
5.5 External Memory Interface
With all the features the External Memory Interface provides, it is well suited to operate as an
interface to memory devices such as External SRAM and Flash, and peripherals such as LCD-
display, A/D, and D/A. The main features are:
• Four different wait-state settings (including no wait-state).
• Independent wait-state setting for different external Memory sectors (configurable sector size).
• The number of bits dedicated to address high byte is selectable.
• Bus keepers on data lines to minimize current consumption (optional).
5.5.1 Overview
When the eXternal MEMory (XMEM) is enabled, address space outside the internal SRAM
becomes available using the dedicated External Memory pins (see Figure 2-1 on page 5, Table
10-3 on page 81, and Table 10-9 on page 85). The memory configuration is shown in Figure 5-4.
0x0000
Internal memory
ISRAM end
XMem start
Lower sector
SRW01
SRW00
SRL[2..0]
SRW11
SRW10
0xFFFF
30 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
When the XMEM interface is enabled, the XMEM interface will override the setting in the data
direction registers that corresponds to the ports dedicated to the XMEM interface. For details
about the port override, see the alternate functions in section “I/O-Ports” on page 74. The XMEM
interface will auto-detect whether an access is internal or external. If the access is external, the
XMEM interface will output address, data, and the control signals on the ports according to Fig-
ure 5-6 (this figure shows the wave forms without wait-states). When ALE goes from high-to-low,
there is a valid address on AD7:0. ALE is low during a data transfer. When the XMEM interface
is enabled, also an internal access will cause activity on address, data and ALE ports, but the
RD and WR strobes will not toggle during internal access. When the External Memory Interface
is disabled, the normal pin and data direction settings are used. Note that when the XMEM inter-
face is disabled, the address space above the internal SRAM boundary is not mapped into the
internal SRAM. Figure 5-5 illustrates how to connect an external SRAM to the AVR using an
octal latch (typically “74 x 573” or equivalent) which is transparent when G is high.
D[7:0]
AD7:0 D Q A[7:0]
ALE G
SRAM
AVR
A15:8 A[15:8]
RD RD
WR WR
31
7593D–AVR–07/06
5.5.4 Pull-up and Bus-keeper
The pull-ups on the AD7:0 ports may be activated if the corresponding Port register is written to
one. To reduce power consumption in sleep mode, it is recommended to disable the pull-ups by
writing the Port register to zero before entering sleep.
The XMEM interface also provides a bus-keeper on the AD7:0 lines. The bus-keeper can be dis-
abled and enabled in software as described in “External Memory Control Register B – XMCRB”
on page 35. When enabled, the bus-keeper will keep the previous value on the AD7:0 bus while
these lines are tri-stated by the XMEM interface.
5.5.5 Timing
External Memory devices have different timing requirements. To meet these requirements, the
XMEM interface provides four different wait-states as shown in Table 5-5. It is important to con-
sider the timing specification of the External Memory device before selecting the wait-state. The
most important parameters are the access time for the external memory compared to the set-up
requirement. The access time for the External Memory is defined to be the time from receiving
the chip select/address until the data of this address actually is driven on the bus. The access
time cannot exceed the time from the ALE pulse must be asserted low until data is stable during
a read sequence (See tLLRL+ tRLRH - tDVRH in Tables 30-6 through Tables 30-13 on pages 408 -
411). The different wait-states are set up in software. As an additional feature, it is possible to
divide the external memory space in two sectors with individual wait-state settings. This makes it
possible to connect two different memory devices with different timing requirements to the same
XMEM interface. For XMEM interface timing details, please refer to Tables 30-6 through Tables
30-13 and Figure 30-7 to Figure 30-10 in the “External Data Memory Timing” on page 408.
Note that the XMEM interface is asynchronous and that the waveforms in the following figures
are related to the internal system clock. The skew between the internal and external clock
(XTAL1) is not guarantied (varies between devices temperature, and supply voltage). Conse-
quently, the XMEM interface is not suited for synchronous operation.
Figure 5-6. External Data Memory Cycles without Wait-state (SRWn1=0 and SRWn0=0)
T1 T2 T3 T4
ALE
Write
DA7:0 Prev. data Address XX Data
WR
RD
Note: 1. SRWn1 = SRW11 (upper sector) or SRW01 (lower sector), SRWn0 = SRW10 (upper sector) or
SRW00 (lower sector). The ALE pulse in period T4 is only present if the next instruction
accesses the RAM (internal or external).
32 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Figure 5-7. External Data Memory Cycles with SRWn1 = 0 and SRWn0 = 1(1)
T1 T2 T3 T4 T5
ALE
Write
DA7:0 Prev. data Address XX Data
WR
Read
DA7:0 (XMBK = 1) Prev. data Address Data
RD
Note: 1. SRWn1 = SRW11 (upper sector) or SRW01 (lower sector), SRWn0 = SRW10 (upper sector) or
SRW00 (lower sector).
The ALE pulse in period T5 is only present if the next instruction accesses the RAM (internal
or external).
Figure 5-8. External Data Memory Cycles with SRWn1 = 1 and SRWn0 = 0(1)
T1 T2 T3 T4 T5
ALE
Write
DA7:0 Prev. data Address XX Data
WR
Read
DA7:0 (XMBK = 1) Prev. data Address Data
RD
Note: 1. SRWn1 = SRW11 (upper sector) or SRW01 (lower sector), SRWn0 = SRW10 (upper sector) or
SRW00 (lower sector).
The ALE pulse in period T6 is only present if the next instruction accesses the RAM (internal
or external).
33
7593D–AVR–07/06
Figure 5-9. External Data Memory Cycles with SRWn1 = 1 and SRWn0 = 1(1)
T1 T2 T3 T4 T5 T6
ALE
Write
DA7:0 Prev. data Address XX Data
WR
Read
DA7:0 (XMBK = 1) Prev. data Address Data
RD
Note: 1. SRWn1 = SRW11 (upper sector) or SRW01 (lower sector), SRWn0 = SRW10 (upper sector) or
SRW00 (lower sector).
The ALE pulse in period T7 is only present if the next instruction accesses the RAM (internal
or external).
34 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
• Bit 3..2 – SRW11, SRW10: Wait-state Select Bits for Upper Sector
The SRW11 and SRW10 bits control the number of wait-states for the upper sector of the exter-
nal memory address space, see Table 5-5.
• Bit 1..0 – SRW01, SRW00: Wait-state Select Bits for Lower Sector
The SRW01 and SRW00 bits control the number of wait-states for the lower sector of the exter-
nal memory address space, see Table 5-5.
35
7593D–AVR–07/06
so even if the XMEM interface is disabled, the bus keepers are still activated as long as XMBK is
one.
Table 5-6. Port C Pins Released as Normal Port Pins when the External Memory is Enabled
XMM2 XMM1 XMM0 # Bits for External Memory Address Released Port Pins
0 0 0 8 (Full 56KB space) None
0 0 1 7 PC7
0 1 0 6 PC7 - PC6
0 1 1 5 PC7 - PC5
1 0 0 4 PC7 - PC4
1 0 1 3 PC7 - PC3
1 1 0 2 PC7 - PC2
1 1 1 No Address high bits Full Port C
36 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Figure 5-10. Address Map with 32 KB External Memory
Memory Configuration A
AVR Memory Map External 32K S RAM
0x0000 0x0000
Internal Memory
0x7FFF External
0x7FFF
0x8000 Memory
(Unused)
0xFFFF
37
7593D–AVR–07/06
Assembly Code Example(1)
; OFFSET is defined to 0x4000 to ensure
; external memory access
; Configure Port C (address high byte) to
; output 0x00 when the pins are released
; for normal Port Pin operation
ldi r16, 0xFF
out DDRC, r16
ldi r16, 0x00
out PORTC, r16
; release PC7:6
ldi r16, (1<<XMM1)
sts XMCRB, r16
; write 0xAA to address 0x0001 of external
; memory
ldi r16, 0xaa
sts 0x0001+OFFSET, r16
; re-enable PC7:6 for external memory
ldi r16, (0<<XMM1)
sts XMCRB, r16
; store 0x55 to address (OFFSET + 1) of
; external memory
ldi r16, 0x55
sts 0x0001+OFFSET, r16
C Code Example(1)
#define OFFSET 0x4000
void XRAM_example(void)
{
unsigned char *p = (unsigned char *) (OFFSET + 1);
DDRC = 0xFF;
PORTC = 0x00;
XMCRB = (1<<XMM1);
*p = 0xaa;
XMCRB = 0x00;
*p = 0x55;
}
38 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
6. System Clock and Clock Options
clkADC
clkPllin (2MHz)
Source clock Watchdog clock
System Clock
Prescaler
PLL Clock
Prescaler
Clock
Multiplexer
39
7593D–AVR–07/06
6.1.4 Asynchronous Timer Clock – clkASY
The Asynchronous Timer clock allows the Asynchronous Timer/Counter to be clocked directly
from an external clock or an external 32 kHz clock crystal. The dedicated clock domain allows
using this Timer/Counter as a real-time counter even when the device is in sleep mode.
Note: 1. For all fuses “1” means unprogrammed while “0” means programmed.
40 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
dependent as shown in “AT90USB64/128 Typical Characteristics – Preliminary Data” on page
429.
Main purpose of the delay is to keep the AVR in reset until it is supplied with minimum Vcc. The
delay will not monitor the actual voltage and it will be required to select a delay longer than the
Vcc rise time. If this is not possible, an internal or external Brown-Out Detection circuit should be
used. A BOD circuit will ensure sufficient Vcc before it releases the reset, and the time-out delay
can be disabled. Disabling the time-out delay without utilizing a Brown-Out Detection circuit is
not recommended.
The oscillator is required to oscillate for a minimum number of cycles before the clock is consid-
ered stable. An internal ripple counter monitors the oscillator output clock, and keeps the internal
reset active for a given number of clock cycles. The reset is then released and the device will
start to execute. The recommended oscillator start-up time is dependent on the clock type, and
varies from 6 cycles for an externally applied clock to 32K cycles for a low frequency crystal.
The start-up sequence for the clock includes both the time-out delay and the start-up time when
the device starts up from reset. When starting up from Power-save or Power-down mode, Vcc is
assumed to be at a sufficient level and only the start-up time is included.
41
7593D–AVR–07/06
Figure 6-2. Crystal Oscillator Connections
C2
XTAL2
C1
XTAL1
GND
The Low Power Oscillator can operate in three different modes, each optimized for a specific fre-
quency range. The operating mode is selected by the fuses CKSEL3..1 as shown in Table 6-3.
42 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Table 6-4. Start-up Times for the Low Power Crystal Oscillator Clock Selection
Start-up Time from Additional Delay
Oscillator Source / Power-down and from Reset
Power Conditions Power-save (VCC = 5.0V) CKSEL0 SUT1..0
Ceramic resonator, fast
258 CK 14CK + 4.1 ms(1) 0 00
rising power
Ceramic resonator,
258 CK 14CK + 65 ms(1) 0 01
slowly rising power
Ceramic resonator,
1K CK 14CK(2) 0 10
BOD enabled
Ceramic resonator, fast
1K CK 14CK + 4.1 ms(2) 0 11
rising power
Ceramic resonator,
1K CK 14CK + 65 ms(2) 1 00
slowly rising power
Crystal Oscillator, BOD
16K CK 14CK 1 01
enabled
Crystal Oscillator, fast
16K CK 14CK + 4.1 ms 1 10
rising power
Crystal Oscillator,
16K CK 14CK + 65 ms 1 11
slowly rising power
Notes: 1. These options should only be used when not operating close to the maximum frequency of the
device, and only if frequency stability at start-up is not important for the application. These
options are not suitable for crystals.
2. These options are intended for use with ceramic resonators and will ensure frequency stability
at start-up. They can also be used with crystals when not operating close to the maximum fre-
quency of the device, and if frequency stability at start-up is not important for the application.
43
7593D–AVR–07/06
Table 6-5. Start-up times for the internal calibrated RC Oscillator clock selection
Start-up Time from Power- Additional Delay from
Power Conditions down and Power-save Reset (VCC = 5.0V) SUT1..0
BOD enabled 6 CK 14CK 00
Fast rising power 6 CK 14CK + 4.1 ms 01
Slowly rising power 6 CK 14CK + 65 ms(1) 10
Reserved 11
Note: 1. The device is shipped with this option selected.
Table 6-6. Start-up Times for the Low Frequency Crystal Oscillator Clock Selection
Start-up Time from Additional Delay
Power-down and from Reset
Power Conditions Power-save (VCC = 5.0V) CKSEL0 SUT1..0
(1)
BOD enabled 1K CK 14CK 0 00
Fast rising power 1K CK 14CK + 4.1 ms(1) 0 01
(1)
Slowly rising power 1K CK 14CK + 65 ms 0 10
Reserved 0 11
BOD enabled 32K CK 14CK 1 00
Fast rising power 32K CK 14CK + 4.1 ms 1 01
Slowly rising power 32K CK 14CK + 65 ms 1 10
Reserved 1 11
Note: 1. These options should only be used if frequency stability at start-up is not important for the
application.
44 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
the Reset Time-out. For more information on the pre-programmed calibration value, see the sec-
tion “Calibration Byte” on page 371
45
7593D–AVR–07/06
Table 6-8. Start-up times for the internal calibrated RC Oscillator clock selection
Start-up Time from Power- Additional Delay from
Power Conditions down and Power-save Reset (VCC = 5.0V) SUT1..0
BOD enabled 6 CK 14CK 00
Fast rising power 6 CK 14CK + 4.1 ms 01
Slowly rising power 6 CK 14CK + 65 ms(1) 10
Reserved 11
Note: 1. The device is shipped with this option selected.
46 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
When this clock source is selected, start-up times are determined by the SUT Fuses as shown in
Table 6-10.
Table 6-10. Start-up Times for the 128 kHz Internal Oscillator
Start-up Time from Power- Additional Delay from
Power Conditions down and Power-save Reset SUT1..0
BOD enabled 6 CK 14CK 00
Fast rising power 6 CK 14CK + 4 ms 01
Slowly rising power 6 CK 14CK + 64 ms 10
Reserved 11
NC XTAL2
EXTERNAL
CLOCK XTAL1
SIGNAL
GND
When this clock source is selected, start-up times are determined by the SUT Fuses as shown in
Table 6-11.
47
7593D–AVR–07/06
6.8 Clock Output Buffer
The device can output the system clock on the CLKO pin. To enable the output, the CKOUT
Fuse has to be programmed. This mode is suitable when the chip clock is used to drive other cir-
cuits on the system. The clock also will be output during reset, and the normal operation of I/O
pin will be overridden when the fuse is programmed. Any clock source, including the internal RC
Oscillator, can be selected when the clock is output on CLKO. If the System Clock Prescaler is
used, it is the divided system clock that is output.
48 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
• Bit 7 – CLKPCE: Clock Prescaler Change Enable
The CLKPCE bit must be written to logic one to enable change of the CLKPS bits. The CLKPCE
bit is only updated when the other bits in CLKPR are simultaneously written to zero. CLKPCE is
cleared by hardware four cycles after it is written or when CLKPS bits are written. Rewriting the
CLKPCE bit within this time-out period does neither extend the time-out period, nor clear the
CLKPCE bit.
49
7593D–AVR–07/06
Table 6-12. Clock Prescaler Select
CLKPS3 CLKPS2 CLKPS1 CLKPS0 Clock Division Factor
0 0 0 0 1
0 0 0 1 2
0 0 1 0 4
0 0 1 1 8
0 1 0 0 16
0 1 0 1 32
0 1 1 0 64
0 1 1 1 128
1 0 0 0 256
1 0 0 1 Reserved
1 0 1 0 Reserved
1 0 1 1 Reserved
1 1 0 0 Reserved
1 1 0 1 Reserved
1 1 1 0 Reserved
1 1 1 1 Reserved
6.11 PLL
The PLL is used to generate internal high frequency (48 MHz) clock for USB interface, the PLL
input is generated from an external low-frequency (the crystal oscillator or external clock input
pin from XTAL1). The internal RC Oscillator can not be used for USB operations.
50 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Figure 6-4. PLL Clocking System
PLLE PLOCK
Lock
Detector
clk
PLL clock 2MHz PLL
clkUSB (48MHz)
Prescaler 24x
XTAL1
OSCILLATORS System Clock
XTAL2
RC OSCILLATOR
8 MHz
Watchdog
OSCILLATOR
51
7593D–AVR–07/06
• Bit 0 – PLOCK: PLL Lock Detector
When the PLOCK bit is set, the PLL is locked to the reference clock, and it is safe to enable PCK
for Timer/Counter1. After the PLL is enabled, it takes about 100 ms for the PLL to lock.
To clear PLOCK, clear PLLE and PLLPx bits.
52 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
7. Power Management and Sleep Modes
Sleep modes enable the application to shut down unused modules in the MCU, thereby saving
power. The AVR provides various sleep modes allowing the user to tailor the power consump-
tion to the application’s requirements.
To enter any of the five sleep modes, the SE bit in SMCR must be written to logic one and a
SLEEP instruction must be executed. The SM2, SM1, and SM0 bits in the SMCR Register select
which sleep mode (Idle, ADC Noise Reduction, Power-down, Power-save, or Standby) will be
activated by the SLEEP instruction. See Table 7-1 for a summary. If an enabled interrupt occurs
while the MCU is in a sleep mode, the MCU wakes up. The MCU is then halted for four cycles in
addition to the start-up time, executes the interrupt routine, and resumes execution from the
instruction following SLEEP. The contents of the Register File and SRAM are unaltered when
the device wakes up from sleep. If a reset occurs during sleep mode, the MCU wakes up and
executes from the Reset Vector.
Figure 6-1 on page 39 presents the different clock systems in the AT90USB64/128, and their
distribution. The figure is helpful in selecting an appropriate sleep mode.
Note: 1. Standby modes are only recommended for use with external crystals or resonators.
53
7593D–AVR–07/06
7.1 Idle Mode
When the SM2..0 bits are written to 000, the SLEEP instruction makes the MCU enter Idle
mode, stopping the CPU but allowing the USB, SPI, USART, Analog Comparator, ADC, 2-wire
Serial Interface, Timer/Counters, Watchdog, and the interrupt system to continue operating. This
sleep mode basically halts clkCPU and clkFLASH, while allowing the other clocks to run.
Idle mode enables the MCU to wake up from external triggered interrupts as well as internal
ones like the Timer Overflow and USART Transmit Complete interrupts. If wake-up from the
Analog Comparator interrupt is not required, the Analog Comparator can be powered down by
setting the ACD bit in the Analog Comparator Control and Status Register – ACSR. This will
reduce power consumption in Idle mode. If the ADC is enabled, a conversion starts automati-
cally when this mode is entered.
54 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
If Timer/Counter2 is enabled, it will keep running during sleep. The device can wake up from
either Timer Overflow or Output Compare event from Timer/Counter2 if the corresponding
Timer/Counter2 interrupt enable bits are set in TIMSK2, and the Global Interrupt Enable bit in
SREG is set.
If Timer/Counter2 is not running, Power-down mode is recommended instead of Power-save
mode.
The Timer/Counter2 can be clocked both synchronously and asynchronously in Power-save
mode. If the Timer/Counter2 is not using the asynchronous clock, the Timer/Counter Oscillator is
stopped during sleep. If the Timer/Counter2 is not using the synchronous clock, the clock source
is stopped during sleep. Note that even if the synchronous clock is running in Power-save, this
clock is only available for the Timer/Counter2.
Table 7-2. Active Clock Domains and Wake-up Sources in the Different Sleep Modes.
Active Clock Domains Oscillators Wake-up Sources
USB Asynchonous
USB Synchronous
EEPROM Ready
WDT Interrupt
TWI Address
Interrupts(4)
Pin Change
Main Clock
INT7:0 and
Timer Osc
Interrupts
Other I/O
Enabled
Enabled
clkFLASH
Source
Timer2
clkADC
Match
clkCPU
clkASY
SPM/
ADC
clkIO
Sleep Mode
Idle X X X X X(2) X X X X X X X X X
(2) (3) (2)
ADCNRM X X X X X X X X X X X X
(3)
Power-down X X X X
(2) (3)
Power-save X X X X X X X
Standby(1) X X(3) X X X
Extended
X(2) X X(2) X(3) X X X X
Standby
Notes: 1. Only recommended with external crystal or resonator selected as clock source.
2. If Timer/Counter2 is running in asynchronous mode.
3. For INT7:4, only level interrupt.
4. Asynchronous USB interrupts are VBUSTI, WAKEUPI, IDTI, WAKEUPI and HWUPI.
55
7593D–AVR–07/06
7.7 Power Reduction Register
The Power Reduction Register, PRR, provides a method to stop the clock to individual peripher-
als to reduce power consumption. The current state of the peripheral is frozen and the I/O
registers can not be read or written. Resources used by the peripheral when stopping the clock
will remain occupied, hence the peripheral should in most cases be disabled before stopping the
clock. Waking up a module, which is done by clearing the bit in PRR, puts the module in the
same state as before shutdown.
Module shutdown can be used in Idle mode and Active mode to significantly reduce the overall
power consumption. See “Supply Current of IO modules” on page 429 for examples. In all other
sleep modes, the clock is already stopped.
56 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
7.7.2 Power Reduction Register 1 - PRR1
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
PRUSB – – – PRTIM3 – – PRUSART1 PRR1
Read/Write R/W R R R R/W R R R/W
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
57
7593D–AVR–07/06
7.8.3 Brown-out Detector
If the Brown-out Detector is not needed by the application, this module should be turned off. If
the Brown-out Detector is enabled by the BODLEVEL Fuses, it will be enabled in all sleep
modes, and hence, always consume power. In the deeper sleep modes, this will contribute sig-
nificantly to the total current consumption. Refer to “Brown-out Detection” on page 61 for details
on how to configure the Brown-out Detector.
58 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
8. System Control and Reset
8.0.1 Resetting the AVR
During reset, all I/O Registers are set to their initial values, and the program starts execution
from the Reset Vector. The instruction placed at the Reset Vector must be a JMP – Absolute
Jump – instruction to the reset handling routine. If the program never enables an interrupt
source, the Interrupt Vectors are not used, and regular program code can be placed at these
locations. This is also the case if the Reset Vector is in the Application section while the Interrupt
Vectors are in the Boot section or vice versa. The circuit diagram in Figure 8-1 shows the reset
logic. Table 8-1 defines the electrical parameters of the reset circuitry.
The I/O ports of the AVR are immediately reset to their initial state when a reset source goes
active. This does not require any clock source to be running.
After all reset sources have gone inactive, a delay counter is invoked, stretching the internal
reset. This allows the power to reach a stable level before normal operation starts. The time-out
period of the delay counter is defined by the user through the SUT and CKSEL Fuses. The dif-
ferent selections for the delay period are presented in “Clock Sources” on page 40.
59
7593D–AVR–07/06
Figure 8-1. Reset Logic
DATA BUS
MCU Status
Register (MCUSR)
PORF
BORF
EXTRF
WDRF
JTRF
Power-on Reset
Circuit
Brown-out
BODLEVEL [2..0] Reset Circuit
Pull-up Resistor
SPIKE
FILTER
JTAG Reset
Register
Watchdog
Oscillator
CKSEL[3:0]
SUT[1:0]
60 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Figure 8-2. MCU Start-up, RESET Tied to VCC
VPOT
VCC
VRST
RESET
tTOUT
TIME-OUT
INTERNAL
RESET
VRST
RESET
tTOUT
TIME-OUT
INTERNAL
RESET
61
7593D–AVR–07/06
selected by the BODLEVEL Fuses. The trigger level has a hysteresis to ensure spike free
Brown-out Detection. The hysteresis on the detection level should be interpreted as V BOT+ =
VBOT + VHYST/2 and VBOT- = VBOT - VHYST/2.
Note: 1. VBOT may be below nominal minimum operating voltage for some devices. For devices where
this is the case, the device is tested down to VCC = VBOT during the production test. This guar-
antees that a Brown-Out Reset will occur before VCC drops to a voltage where correct
operation of the microcontroller is no longer guaranteed. The test is performed using
BODLEVEL = 110 for AT90USB64/128 and BODLEVEL = 101 for AT90USB64/128L.
When the BOD is enabled, and VCC decreases to a value below the trigger level (VBOT- in Figure
8-5), the Brown-out Reset is immediately activated. When VCC increases above the trigger level
(VBOT+ in Figure 8-5), the delay counter starts the MCU after the Time-out period tTOUT has
expired.
The BOD circuit will only detect a drop in VCC if the voltage stays below the trigger level for
longer than tBOD given in Table 8-1.
VCC VBOT+
VBOT-
RESET
TIME-OUT tTOUT
INTERNAL
RESET
62 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
8.0.6 Watchdog Reset
When the Watchdog times out, it will generate a short reset pulse of one CK cycle duration. On
the falling edge of this pulse, the delay timer starts counting the Time-out period tTOUT. Refer to
page 64 for details on operation of the Watchdog Timer.
CK
63
7593D–AVR–07/06
8.1 Internal Voltage Reference
AT90USB64/128 features an internal bandgap reference. This reference is used for Brown-out
Detection, and it can be used as an input to the Analog Comparator or the ADC.
64 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
• Selectable Time-out period from 16ms to 8s
• Possible Hardware fuse Watchdog always on (WDTON) for fail-safe mode
128kHz
OSCILLATOR
OSC/2K
OSC/4K
OSC/8K
OSC/16K
OSC/32K
OSC/64K
OSC/128K
OSC/256K
OSC/512K
OSC/1024K
WDP0
WDP1
WATCHDOG WDP2
RESET WDP3
WDE
MCU RESET
WDIF
INTERRUPT
WDIE
The Watchdog Timer (WDT) is a timer counting cycles of a separate on-chip 128 kHz oscillator.
The WDT gives an interrupt or a system reset when the counter reaches a given time-out value.
In normal operation mode, it is required that the system uses the WDR - Watchdog Timer Reset
- instruction to restart the counter before the time-out value is reached. If the system doesn't
restart the counter, an interrupt or system reset will be issued.
In Interrupt mode, the WDT gives an interrupt when the timer expires. This interrupt can be used
to wake the device from sleep-modes, and also as a general system timer. One example is to
limit the maximum time allowed for certain operations, giving an interrupt when the operation
has run longer than expected. In System Reset mode, the WDT gives a reset when the timer
expires. This is typically used to prevent system hang-up in case of runaway code. The third
mode, Interrupt and System Reset mode, combines the other two modes by first giving an inter-
rupt and then switch to System Reset mode. This mode will for instance allow a safe shutdown
by saving critical parameters before a system reset.
The Watchdog always on (WDTON) fuse, if programmed, will force the Watchdog Timer to Sys-
tem Reset mode. With the fuse programmed the System Reset mode bit (WDE) and Interrupt
mode bit (WDIE) are locked to 1 and 0 respectively. To further ensure program security, alter-
ations to the Watchdog set-up must follow timed sequences. The sequence for clearing WDE
and changing time-out configuration is as follows:
1. In the same operation, write a logic one to the Watchdog change enable bit (WDCE)
and WDE. A logic one must be written to WDE regardless of the previous value of the
WDE bit.
2. Within the next four clock cycles, write the WDE and Watchdog prescaler bits (WDP) as
desired, but with the WDCE bit cleared. This must be done in one operation.
65
7593D–AVR–07/06
The following code example shows one assembly and one C function for turning off the Watch-
dog Timer. The example assumes that interrupts are controlled (e.g. by disabling interrupts
globally) so that no interrupts will occur during the execution of these functions.
Note: 1. The example code assumes that the part specific header file is included.
Note: If the Watchdog is accidentally enabled, for example by a runaway pointer or brown-out
condition, the device will be reset and the Watchdog Timer will stay enabled. If the code is not
set up to handle the Watchdog, this might lead to an eternal loop of time-out resets. To avoid this
situation, the application software should always clear the Watchdog System Reset Flag
(WDRF) and the WDE control bit in the initialisation routine, even if the Watchdog is not in use.
66 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
The following code example shows one assembly and one C function for changing the time-out
value of the Watchdog Timer.
Note: 1. The example code assumes that the part specific header file is included.
Note: The Watchdog Timer should be reset before any change of the WDP bits, since a change
in the WDP bits can result in a time-out when switching to a shorter time-out period.
67
7593D–AVR–07/06
handling vector. Alternatively, WDIF is cleared by writing a logic one to the flag. When the I-bit in
SREG and WDIE are set, the Watchdog Time-out Interrupt is executed.
68 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
.
69
7593D–AVR–07/06
9. Interrupts
This section describes the specifics of the interrupt handling as performed in AT90USB64/128.
For a general explanation of the AVR interrupt handling, refer to “Reset and Interrupt Handling”
on page 16.
70 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Table 9-1. Reset and Interrupt Vectors (Continued)
Vector Program
No. Address(2) Source Interrupt Definition
29 $0038 ANALOG COMP Analog Comparator
30 $003A ADC ADC Conversion Complete
31 $003C EE READY EEPROM Ready
32 $003E TIMER3 CAPT Timer/Counter3 Capture Event
33 $0040 TIMER3 COMPA Timer/Counter3 Compare Match A
34 $0042 TIMER3 COMPB Timer/Counter3 Compare Match B
35 $0044 TIMER3 COMPC Timer/Counter3 Compare Match C
36 $0046 TIMER3 OVF Timer/Counter3 Overflow
37 $0048 TWI 2-wire Serial Interface
38 $004A SPM READY Store Program Memory Ready
Notes: 1. When the BOOTRST Fuse is programmed, the device will jump to the Boot Loader address at
reset, see “Memory Programming” on page 368.
2. When the IVSEL bit in MCUCR is set, Interrupt Vectors will be moved to the start of the Boot
Flash Section. The address of each Interrupt Vector will then be the address in this table
added to the start address of the Boot Flash Section.
Table 9-2 shows reset and Interrupt Vectors placement for the various combinations of
BOOTRST and IVSEL settings. If the program never enables an interrupt source, the Interrupt
Vectors are not used, and regular program code can be placed at these locations. This is also
the case if the Reset Vector is in the Application section while the Interrupt Vectors are in the
Boot section or vice versa.
71
7593D–AVR–07/06
Table 9-2. Reset and Interrupt Vectors Placement(1)
BOOTRST IVSEL Reset Address Interrupt Vectors Start Address
1 0 0x0000 0x0002
1 1 0x0000 Boot Reset Address + 0x0002
0 0 Boot Reset Address 0x0002
0 1 Boot Reset Address Boot Reset Address + 0x0002
Note: 1. The Boot Reset Address is shown in Table 28-8 on page 366. For the BOOTRST Fuse “1”
means unprogrammed while “0” means programmed.
72 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
The IVCE bit must be written to logic one to enable change of the IVSEL bit. IVCE is cleared by
hardware four cycles after it is written or when IVSEL is written. Setting the IVCE bit will disable
interrupts, as explained in the IVSEL description above. See Code Example below.
73
7593D–AVR–07/06
10. I/O-Ports
10.1 Introduction
All AVR ports have true Read-Modify-Write functionality when used as general digital I/O ports.
This means that the direction of one port pin can be changed without unintentionally changing
the direction of any other pin with the SBI and CBI instructions. The same applies when chang-
ing drive value (if configured as output) or enabling/disabling of pull-up resistors (if configured as
input). Each output buffer has symmetrical drive characteristics with both high sink and source
capability. The pin driver is strong enough to drive LED displays directly. All port pins have indi-
vidually selectable pull-up resistors with a supply-voltage invariant resistance. All I/O pins have
protection diodes to both VCC and Ground as indicated in Figure 10-1. Refer to “Electrical Char-
acteristics” on page 400 for a complete list of parameters.
All registers and bit references in this section are written in general form. A lower case “x” repre-
sents the numbering letter for the port, and a lower case “n” represents the bit number. However,
when using the register or bit defines in a program, the precise form must be used. For example,
PORTB3 for bit no. 3 in Port B, here documented generally as PORTxn. The physical I/O Regis-
ters and bit locations are listed in “Register Description for I/O-Ports” on page 92.
Three I/O memory address locations are allocated for each port, one each for the Data Register
– PORTx, Data Direction Register – DDRx, and the Port Input Pins – PINx. The Port Input Pins
I/O location is read only, while the Data Register and the Data Direction Register are read/write.
However, writing a logic one to a bit in the PINx Register, will result in a toggle in the correspond-
ing bit in the Data Register. In addition, the Pull-up Disable – PUD bit in MCUCR disables the
pull-up function for all pins in all ports when set.
Using the I/O port as General Digital I/O is described in “Ports as General Digital I/O” on page
75. Most port pins are multiplexed with alternate functions for the peripheral features on the
device. How each alternate function interferes with the port pin is described in “Alternate Port
Functions” on page 79. Refer to the individual module sections for a full description of the alter-
nate functions.
74 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Note that enabling the alternate function of some of the port pins does not affect the use of the
other pins in the port as general digital I/O.
PUD
Q D
DDxn
Q CLR
WDx
RESET
RDx
DATA BUS
1
Pxn Q D
PORTxn 0
Q CLR
RESET
WRx WPx
SLEEP RRx
SYNCHRONIZER
RPx
D Q D Q
PINxn
L Q Q
clk I/O
Note: 1. WRx, WPx, WDx, RRx, RPx, and RDx are common to all pins within the same port. clkI/O,
SLEEP, and PUD are common to all ports.
75
7593D–AVR–07/06
If PORTxn is written logic one when the pin is configured as an output pin, the port pin is driven
high (one). If PORTxn is written logic zero when the pin is configured as an output pin, the port
pin is driven low (zero).
76 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Figure 10-3. Synchronization when Reading an Externally Applied Pin value
SYSTEM CLK
SYNC LATCH
PINxn
t pd, max
t pd, min
Consider the clock period starting shortly after the first falling edge of the system clock. The latch
is closed when the clock is low, and goes transparent when the clock is high, as indicated by the
shaded region of the “SYNC LATCH” signal. The signal value is latched when the system clock
goes low. It is clocked into the PINxn Register at the succeeding positive clock edge. As indi-
cated by the two arrows tpd,max and tpd,min, a single signal transition on the pin will be delayed
between ½ and 1½ system clock period depending upon the time of assertion.
When reading back a software assigned pin value, a nop instruction must be inserted as indi-
cated in Figure 10-4. The out instruction sets the “SYNC LATCH” signal at the positive edge of
the clock. In this case, the delay tpd through the synchronizer is 1 system clock period.
SYSTEM CLK
r16 0xFF
SYNC LATCH
PINxn
t pd
The following code example shows how to set port B pins 0 and 1 high, 2 and 3 low, and define
the port pins from 4 to 7 as input with pull-ups assigned to port pins 6 and 7. The resulting pin
values are read back again, but as previously discussed, a nop instruction is included to be able
to read back the value recently assigned to some of the pins.
77
7593D–AVR–07/06
Assembly Code Example(1)
...
; Define pull-ups and set outputs high
; Define directions for port pins
ldi r16,(1<<PB7)|(1<<PB6)|(1<<PB1)|(1<<PB0)
ldi r17,(1<<DDB3)|(1<<DDB2)|(1<<DDB1)|(1<<DDB0)
out PORTB,r16
out DDRB,r17
; Insert nop for synchronization
nop
; Read port pins
in r16,PINB
...
C Code Example
unsigned char i;
...
/* Define pull-ups and set outputs high */
/* Define directions for port pins */
PORTB = (1<<PB7)|(1<<PB6)|(1<<PB1)|(1<<PB0);
DDRB = (1<<DDB3)|(1<<DDB2)|(1<<DDB1)|(1<<DDB0);
/* Insert nop for synchronization*/
__no_operation();
/* Read port pins */
i = PINB;
...
Note: 1. For the assembly program, two temporary registers are used to minimize the time from pull-
ups are set on pins 0, 1, 6, and 7, until the direction bits are correctly set, defining bit 2 and 3
as low and redefining bits 0 and 1 as strong high drivers.
78 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
ing inputs should be avoided to reduce current consumption in all other modes where the digital
inputs are enabled (Reset, Active mode and Idle mode).
The simplest method to ensure a defined level of an unused pin, is to enable the internal pull-up.
In this case, the pull-up will be disabled during reset. If low power consumption during reset is
important, it is recommended to use an external pull-up or pull-down. Connecting unused pins
directly to VCC or GND is not recommended, since this may cause excessive currents if the pin is
accidentally configured as an output.
PUOVxn
1
0
PUD
DDOExn
DDOVxn
1
0 Q D
DDxn
Q CLR
WDx
PVOExn RESET
RDx
PVOVxn
DATA BUS
1 1
Pxn
0 Q D 0
PORTxn
PTOExn
Q CLR
DIEOExn
WPx
DIEOVxn RESET
1 WRx
RRx
0 SLEEP
SYNCHRONIZER
RPx
SET
D Q D Q
PINxn
L CLR Q CLR Q
clk I/O
DIxn
AIOxn
Note: 1. WRx, WPx, WDx, RRx, RPx, and RDx are common to all pins within the same port. clkI/O,
SLEEP, and PUD are common to all ports. All other signals are unique for each pin.
79
7593D–AVR–07/06
Table 10-2 summarizes the function of the overriding signals. The pin and port indexes from Fig-
ure 10-5 are not shown in the succeeding tables. The overriding signals are generated internally
in the modules having the alternate function.
The following subsections shortly describe the alternate functions for each port, and relate the
overriding signals to the alternate function. Refer to the alternate function description for further
details.
80 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
10.3.1 MCU Control Register – MCUCR
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
JTD – – PUD – – IVSEL IVCE MCUCR
Read/Write R/W R R R/W R R R/W R/W
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Table 10-4 and Table 10-5 relates the alternate functions of Port A to the overriding signals
shown in Figure 10-5 on page 79.
81
7593D–AVR–07/06
Note: 1. ADA is short for ADdress Active and represents the time when address is output. See “Exter-
nal Memory Interface” on page 30 for details.
• OC0A/OC1C/PCINT7, Bit 7
OC0A, Output Compare Match A output: The PB7 pin can serve as an external output for the
Timer/Counter0 Output Compare. The pin has to be configured as an output (DDB7 set “one”) to
serve this function. The OC0A pin is also the output pin for the PWM mode timer function.
82 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
OC1C, Output Compare Match C output: The PB7 pin can serve as an external output for the
Timer/Counter1 Output Compare C. The pin has to be configured as an output (DDB7 set (one))
to serve this function. The OC1C pin is also the output pin for the PWM mode timer function.
PCINT7, Pin Change Interrupt source 7: The PB7 pin can serve as an external interrupt source.
• OC1B/PCINT6, Bit 6
OC1B, Output Compare Match B output: The PB6 pin can serve as an external output for the
Timer/Counter1 Output Compare B. The pin has to be configured as an output (DDB6 set (one))
to serve this function. The OC1B pin is also the output pin for the PWM mode timer function.
PCINT6, Pin Change Interrupt source 6: The PB7 pin can serve as an external interrupt source.
• OC1A/PCINT5, Bit 5
OC1A, Output Compare Match A output: The PB5 pin can serve as an external output for the
Timer/Counter1 Output Compare A. The pin has to be configured as an output (DDB5 set (one))
to serve this function. The OC1A pin is also the output pin for the PWM mode timer function.
PCINT5, Pin Change Interrupt source 5: The PB7 pin can serve as an external interrupt source.
• OC2A/PCINT4, Bit 4
OC2A, Output Compare Match output: The PB4 pin can serve as an external output for the
Timer/Counter2 Output Compare. The pin has to be configured as an output (DDB4 set (one)) to
serve this function. The OC2A pin is also the output pin for the PWM mode timer function.
PCINT4, Pin Change Interrupt source 4: The PB7 pin can serve as an external interrupt source.
83
7593D–AVR–07/06
PCINT1, Pin Change Interrupt source 1: The PB7 pin can serve as an external interrupt source.
84 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
10.3.4 Alternate Functions of Port C
The Port C alternate function is as follows:
Table 10-10 and Table 10-11 relate the alternate functions of Port C to the overriding signals
shown in Figure 10-5 on page 79.
85
7593D–AVR–07/06
Table 10-11. Overriding Signals for Alternate Functions in PC3..PC0
Signal
Name PC3/A11/T.3 PC2/A10 PC1/A9 PC0/A8
PUOE SRE • (XMM<5) SRE • (XMM<6) SRE • (XMM<7) SRE • (XMM<7)
PUOV 0 0 0 0
DDOE SRE • (XMM<5) SRE • (XMM<6) SRE • (XMM<7) SRE • (XMM<7)
DDOV 1 1 1 1
PVOE SRE • (XMM<5) SRE • (XMM<6) SRE • (XMM<7) SRE • (XMM<7)
PVOV A11 A10 A9 A8
DIEOE 0 0 0 0
DIEOV 0 0 0 0
DI T3 input – – –
AIO – – – –
• T0 – Port D, Bit 7
T0, Timer/Counter0 counter source.
• T1 – Port D, Bit 6
T1, Timer/Counter1 counter source.
86 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
• ICP1 – Port D, Bit 4
ICP1 – Input Capture Pin 1: The PD4 pin can act as an input capture pin for Timer/Counter1.
87
7593D–AVR–07/06
Table 10-13. Overriding Signals for Alternate Functions PD7..PD4
Signal Name PD7/T0 PD6/T1 PD5/XCK1 PD4/ICP1
PUOE 0 0 0 0
PUOV 0 0 0 0
DDOE 0 0 XCK1 OUTPUT ENABLE 0
DDOV 0 0 1 0
PVOE 0 0 XCK1 OUTPUT ENABLE 0
PVOV 0 0 XCK1 OUTPUT 0
DIEOE 0 0 0 0
DIEOV 0 0 0 0
DI T0 INPUT T1 INPUT XCK1 INPUT ICP1 INPUT
AIO – – – –
88 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
10.3.6 Alternate Functions of Port E
The Port E pins with alternate functions are shown in Table 10-15.
89
7593D–AVR–07/06
ALE is the external data memory Address latch enable.
HWB allows to execute the bootloader section after reset when tied to ground during external
reset pulse. The HWB mode of this pin is active only when the HWBE fuse is enable.
• RD – Port E, Bit 1
RD is the external data memory read control enable.
• WR – Port E, Bit 0
WR is the external data memory write control enable.
90 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
10.3.7 Alternate Functions of Port F
The Port F has an alternate function as analog input for the ADC as shown in Table 10-18. If
some Port F pins are configured as outputs, it is essential that these do not switch when a con-
version is in progress. This might corrupt the result of the conversion. If the JTAG interface is
enabled, the pull-up resistors on pins PF7(TDI), PF5(TMS), and PF4(TCK) will be activated even
if a Reset occurs.
91
7593D–AVR–07/06
Analog to Digital Converter, Channel 3..0.
92 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
10.4.2 Port A Data Direction Register – DDRA
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
DDA7 DDA6 DDA5 DDA4 DDA3 DDA2 DDA1 DDA0 DDRA
Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
93
7593D–AVR–07/06
10.4.10 Port D Data Register – PORTD
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
PORTD PORTD PORTD PORTD PORTD PORTD PORTD PORTD PORTD
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
94 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
10.4.18 Port F Input Pins Address – PINF
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
PINF7 PINF6 PINF5 PINF4 PINF3 PINF2 PINF1 PINF0 PINF
Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Initial Value N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A
95
7593D–AVR–07/06
11. External Interrupts
The External Interrupts are triggered by the INT7:0 pin or any of the PCINT23..0 pins. Observe
that, if enabled, the interrupts will trigger even if the INT7:0 or PCINT23..0 pins are configured as
outputs. This feature provides a way of generating a software interrupt.
The Pin change interrupt PCI0 will trigger if any enabled PCINT7:0 pin toggles. PCMSK0 Regis-
ter control which pins contribute to the pin change interrupts. Pin change interrupts on PCINT7
..0 are detected asynchronously. This implies that these interrupts can be used for waking the
part also from sleep modes other than Idle mode.
The External Interrupts can be triggered by a falling or rising edge or a low level. This is set up
as indicated in the specification for the External Interrupt Control Registers – EICRA (INT3:0)
and EICRB (INT7:4). When the external interrupt is enabled and is configured as level triggered,
the interrupt will trigger as long as the pin is held low. Note that recognition of falling or rising
edge interrupts on INT7:4 requires the presence of an I/O clock, described in “System Clock and
Clock Options” on page 39. Low level interrupts and the edge interrupt on INT3:0 are detected
asynchronously. This implies that these interrupts can be used for waking the part also from
sleep modes other than Idle mode. The I/O clock is halted in all sleep modes except Idle mode.
Note that if a level triggered interrupt is used for wake-up from Power-down, the required level
must be held long enough for the MCU to complete the wake-up to trigger the level interrupt. If
the level disappears before the end of the Start-up Time, the MCU will still wake up, but no inter-
rupt will be generated. The start-up time is defined by the SUT and CKSEL Fuses as described
in “System Clock and Clock Options” on page 39.
• Bits 7..0 – ISC31, ISC30 – ISC00, ISC00: External Interrupt 3 - 0 Sense Control Bits
The External Interrupts 3 - 0 are activated by the external pins INT3:0 if the SREG I-flag and the
corresponding interrupt mask in the EIMSK is set. The level and edges on the external pins that
activate the interrupts are defined in Table 11-1. Edges on INT3..INT0 are registered asynchro-
nously. Pulses on INT3:0 pins wider than the minimum pulse width given in Table 11-2 will
generate an interrupt. Shorter pulses are not guaranteed to generate an interrupt. If low level
interrupt is selected, the low level must be held until the completion of the currently executing
instruction to generate an interrupt. If enabled, a level triggered interrupt will generate an inter-
rupt request as long as the pin is held low. When changing the ISCn bit, an interrupt can occur.
Therefore, it is recommended to first disable INTn by clearing its Interrupt Enable bit in the
EIMSK Register. Then, the ISCn bit can be changed. Finally, the INTn interrupt flag should be
cleared by writing a logical one to its Interrupt Flag bit (INTFn) in the EIFR Register before the
interrupt is re-enabled.
96 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
• Bits 7..0 – ISC71, ISC70 - ISC41, ISC40: External Interrupt 7 - 4 Sense Control Bits
The External Interrupts 7 - 4 are activated by the external pins INT7:4 if the SREG I-flag and the
corresponding interrupt mask in the EIMSK is set. The level and edges on the external pins that
activate the interrupts are defined in Table 11-3. The value on the INT7:4 pins are sampled
before detecting edges. If edge or toggle interrupt is selected, pulses that last longer than one
clock period will generate an interrupt. Shorter pulses are not guaranteed to generate an inter-
rupt. Observe that CPU clock frequency can be lower than the XTAL frequency if the XTAL
divider is enabled. If low level interrupt is selected, the low level must be held until the comple-
tion of the currently executing instruction to generate an interrupt. If enabled, a level triggered
interrupt will generate an interrupt request as long as the pin is held low.
Note: 1. n = 7, 6, 5 or 4.
When changing the ISCn1/ISCn0 bits, the interrupt must be disabled by clearing its Interrupt
Enable bit in the EIMSK Register. Otherwise an interrupt can occur when the bits are changed.
97
7593D–AVR–07/06
INT7 INT6 INT5 INT4 INT3 INT2 INT1 IINT0 EIMSK
Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
98 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
corresponding Interrupt Vector. The flag is cleared when the interrupt routine is executed. Alter-
natively, the flag can be cleared by writing a logical one to it.
99
7593D–AVR–07/06
12. Timer/Counter0, Timer/Counter1, and Timer/Counter3 Prescalers
Timer/Counter0, 1, and 3 share the same prescaler module, but the Timer/Counters can have
different prescaler settings. The description below applies to all Timer/Counters. Tn is used as a
general name, n = 0, 1 or 3.
Tn D Q D Q D Q Tn_sync
(To Clock
Select Logic)
LE
clk I/O
The synchronization and edge detector logic introduces a delay of 2.5 to 3.5 system clock cycles
from an edge has been applied to the Tn pin to the counter is updated.
Enabling and disabling of the clock input must be done when Tn has been stable for at least one
system clock cycle, otherwise it is a risk that a false Timer/Counter clock pulse is generated.
100 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Each half period of the external clock applied must be longer than one system clock cycle to
ensure correct sampling. The external clock must be guaranteed to have less than half the sys-
tem clock frequency (fExtClk < fclk_I/O/2) given a 50/50% duty cycle. Since the edge detector uses
sampling, the maximum frequency of an external clock it can detect is half the sampling fre-
quency (Nyquist sampling theorem). However, due to variation of the system clock frequency
and duty cycle caused by Oscillator source (crystal, resonator, and capacitors) tolerances, it is
recommended that maximum frequency of an external clock source is less than fclk_I/O/2.5.
An external clock source can not be prescaled.
PSR10
Tn
Synchronization
Tn
Synchronization
CSn0 CSn0
CSn1 CSn1
CSn2 CSn2
101
7593D–AVR–07/06
13. 8-bit Timer/Counter0 with PWM
Timer/Counter0 is a general purpose 8-bit Timer/Counter module, with two independent Output
Compare Units, and with PWM support. It allows accurate program execution timing (event man-
agement) and wave generation. The main features are:
• Two Independent Output Compare Units
• Double Buffered Output Compare Registers
• Clear Timer on Compare Match (Auto Reload)
• Glitch Free, Phase Correct Pulse Width Modulator (PWM)
• Variable PWM Period
• Frequency Generator
• Three Independent Interrupt Sources (TOV0, OCF0A, and OCF0B)
13.1 Overview
A simplified block diagram of the 8-bit Timer/Counter is shown in Figure 13-1. For the actual
placement of I/O pins, refer to “Pinout AT90USB64/128-TQFP” on page 3. CPU accessible I/O
Registers, including I/O bits and I/O pins, are shown in bold. The device-specific I/O Register
and bit locations are listed in the “8-bit Timer/Counter Register Description” on page 112.
Edge
Tn
Detector
TOP BOTTOM
( From Prescaler )
Timer/Counter
TCNTn
= =0
OCnA
(Int.Req.)
Waveform
= Generation
OCnA
OCRnA
Fixed
OCnB
TOP
(Int.Req.)
Value
DATA BUS
Waveform
= Generation
OCnB
OCRnB
TCCRnA TCCRnB
13.1.1 Registers
The Timer/Counter (TCNT0) and Output Compare Registers (OCR0A and OCR0B) are 8-bit
registers. Interrupt request (abbreviated to Int.Req. in the figure) signals are all visible in the
Timer Interrupt Flag Register (TIFR0). All interrupts are individually masked with the Timer Inter-
rupt Mask Register (TIMSK0). TIFR0 and TIMSK0 are not shown in the figure.
The Timer/Counter can be clocked internally, via the prescaler, or by an external clock source on
the T0 pin. The Clock Select logic block controls which clock source and edge the Timer/Counter
uses to increment (or decrement) its value. The Timer/Counter is inactive when no clock source
is selected. The output from the Clock Select logic is referred to as the timer clock (clkT0).
102 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
The double buffered Output Compare Registers (OCR0A and OCR0B) are compared with the
Timer/Counter value at all times. The result of the compare can be used by the Waveform Gen-
erator to generate a PWM or variable frequency output on the Output Compare pins (OC0A and
OC0B). See “Output Compare Unit” on page 104. for details. The Compare Match event will also
set the Compare Flag (OCF0A or OCF0B) which can be used to generate an Output Compare
interrupt request.
13.1.2 Definitions
Many register and bit references in this section are written in general form. A lower case “n”
replaces the Timer/Counter number, in this case 0. A lower case “x” replaces the Output Com-
pare Unit, in this case Compare Unit A or Compare Unit B. However, when using the register or
bit defines in a program, the precise form must be used, i.e., TCNT0 for accessing
Timer/Counter0 counter value and so on.
The definitions in the table below are also used extensively throughout the document.
Clock Select
count Edge
Tn
clear clkTn Detector
TCNTn Control Logic
direction
( From Prescaler )
bottom top
103
7593D–AVR–07/06
clkTn Timer/Counter clock, referred to as clkT0 in the following.
top Signalize that TCNT0 has reached maximum value.
bottom Signalize that TCNT0 has reached minimum value (zero).
Depending of the mode of operation used, the counter is cleared, incremented, or decremented
at each timer clock (clkT0). clkT0 can be generated from an external or internal clock source,
selected by the Clock Select bits (CS02:0). When no clock source is selected (CS02:0 = 0) the
timer is stopped. However, the TCNT0 value can be accessed by the CPU, regardless of
whether clkT0 is present or not. A CPU write overrides (has priority over) all counter clear or
count operations.
The counting sequence is determined by the setting of the WGM01 and WGM00 bits located in
the Timer/Counter Control Register (TCCR0A) and the WGM02 bit located in the Timer/Counter
Control Register B (TCCR0B). There are close connections between how the counter behaves
(counts) and how waveforms are generated on the Output Compare outputs OC0A and OC0B.
For more details about advanced counting sequences and waveform generation, see “Modes of
Operation” on page 107.
The Timer/Counter Overflow Flag (TOV0) is set according to the mode of operation selected by
the WGM02:0 bits. TOV0 can be used for generating a CPU interrupt.
104 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Figure 13-3. Output Compare Unit, Block Diagram
DATA BUS
OCRnx TCNTn
= (8-bit Comparator )
OCFnx (Int.Req.)
top
bottom
Waveform Generator OCnx
FOCn
WGMn1:0 COMnX1:0
The OCR0x Registers are double buffered when using any of the Pulse Width Modulation
(PWM) modes. For the normal and Clear Timer on Compare (CTC) modes of operation, the dou-
ble buffering is disabled. The double buffering synchronizes the update of the OCR0x Compare
Registers to either top or bottom of the counting sequence. The synchronization prevents the
occurrence of odd-length, non-symmetrical PWM pulses, thereby making the output glitch-free.
The OCR0x Register access may seem complex, but this is not case. When the double buffering
is enabled, the CPU has access to the OCR0x Buffer Register, and if double buffering is dis-
abled the CPU will access the OCR0x directly.
105
7593D–AVR–07/06
generation. Similarly, do not write the TCNT0 value equal to BOTTOM when the counter is
down-counting.
The setup of the OC0x should be performed before setting the Data Direction Register for the
port pin to output. The easiest way of setting the OC0x value is to use the Force Output Com-
pare (FOC0x) strobe bits in Normal mode. The OC0x Registers keep their values even when
changing between Waveform Generation modes.
Be aware that the COM0x1:0 bits are not double buffered together with the compare value.
Changing the COM0x1:0 bits will take effect immediately.
COMnx1
COMnx0 Waveform
D Q
FOCn Generator
1
OCnx
OCnx Pin
0
D Q
DATA BUS
PORT
D Q
DDR
clk I/O
The general I/O port function is overridden by the Output Compare (OC0x) from the Waveform
Generator if either of the COM0x1:0 bits are set. However, the OC0x pin direction (input or out-
put) is still controlled by the Data Direction Register (DDR) for the port pin. The Data Direction
Register bit for the OC0x pin (DDR_OC0x) must be set as output before the OC0x value is visi-
ble on the pin. The port override function is independent of the Waveform Generation mode.
The design of the Output Compare pin logic allows initialization of the OC0x state before the out-
put is enabled. Note that some COM0x1:0 bit settings are reserved for certain modes of
operation. See “8-bit Timer/Counter Register Description” on page 112.
106 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
13.5.1 Compare Output Mode and Waveform Generation
The Waveform Generator uses the COM0x1:0 bits differently in Normal, CTC, and PWM modes.
For all modes, setting the COM0x1:0 = 0 tells the Waveform Generator that no action on the
OC0x Register is to be performed on the next Compare Match. For compare output actions in
the non-PWM modes refer to Table 13-1 on page 113. For fast PWM mode, refer to Table 13-2
on page 113, and for phase correct PWM refer to Table 13-3 on page 113.
A change of the COM0x1:0 bits state will have effect at the first Compare Match after the bits are
written. For non-PWM modes, the action can be forced to have immediate effect by using the
FOC0x strobe bits.
107
7593D–AVR–07/06
Figure 13-5. CTC Mode, Timing Diagram
TCNTn
OCn
(COMnx1:0 = 1)
(Toggle)
Period 1 2 3 4
An interrupt can be generated each time the counter value reaches the TOP value by using the
OCF0A Flag. If the interrupt is enabled, the interrupt handler routine can be used for updating
the TOP value. However, changing TOP to a value close to BOTTOM when the counter is run-
ning with none or a low prescaler value must be done with care since the CTC mode does not
have the double buffering feature. If the new value written to OCR0A is lower than the current
value of TCNT0, the counter will miss the Compare Match. The counter will then have to count to
its maximum value (0xFF) and wrap around starting at 0x00 before the Compare Match can
occur.
For generating a waveform output in CTC mode, the OC0A output can be set to toggle its logical
level on each Compare Match by setting the Compare Output mode bits to toggle mode
(COM0A1:0 = 1). The OC0A value will not be visible on the port pin unless the data direction for
the pin is set to output. The waveform generated will have a maximum frequency of fOC0 =
fclk_I/O/2 when OCR0A is set to zero (0x00). The waveform frequency is defined by the following
equation:
f clk_I/O
f OCnx = --------------------------------------------------
2 ⋅ N ⋅ ( 1 + OCRnx )
The N variable represents the prescale factor (1, 8, 64, 256, or 1024).
As for the Normal mode of operation, the TOV0 Flag is set in the same timer clock cycle that the
counter counts from MAX to 0x00.
108 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
PWM mode is shown in Figure 13-6. The TCNT0 value is in the timing diagram shown as a his-
togram for illustrating the single-slope operation. The diagram includes non-inverted and
inverted PWM outputs. The small horizontal line marks on the TCNT0 slopes represent Com-
pare Matches between OCR0x and TCNT0.
TCNTn
OCnx (COMnx1:0 = 2)
OCnx (COMnx1:0 = 3)
Period 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
The Timer/Counter Overflow Flag (TOV0) is set each time the counter reaches TOP. If the inter-
rupt is enabled, the interrupt handler routine can be used for updating the compare value.
In fast PWM mode, the compare unit allows generation of PWM waveforms on the OC0x pins.
Setting the COM0x1:0 bits to two will produce a non-inverted PWM and an inverted PWM output
can be generated by setting the COM0x1:0 to three: Setting the COM0A1:0 bits to one allows
the OC0A pin to toggle on Compare Matches if the WGM02 bit is set. This option is not available
for the OC0B pin (See Table 13-2 on page 113). The actual OC0x value will only be visible on
the port pin if the data direction for the port pin is set as output. The PWM waveform is gener-
ated by setting (or clearing) the OC0x Register at the Compare Match between OCR0x and
TCNT0, and clearing (or setting) the OC0x Register at the timer clock cycle the counter is
cleared (changes from TOP to BOTTOM).
The PWM frequency for the output can be calculated by the following equation:
f clk_I/O
f OCnxPWM = ------------------
N ⋅ 256
The N variable represents the prescale factor (1, 8, 64, 256, or 1024).
The extreme values for the OCR0A Register represents special cases when generating a PWM
waveform output in the fast PWM mode. If the OCR0A is set equal to BOTTOM, the output will
be a narrow spike for each MAX+1 timer clock cycle. Setting the OCR0A equal to MAX will result
in a constantly high or low output (depending on the polarity of the output set by the COM0A1:0
bits.)
A frequency (with 50% duty cycle) waveform output in fast PWM mode can be achieved by set-
ting OC0x to toggle its logical level on each Compare Match (COM0x1:0 = 1). The waveform
generated will have a maximum frequency of fOC0 = fclk_I/O/2 when OCR0A is set to zero. This
109
7593D–AVR–07/06
feature is similar to the OC0A toggle in CTC mode, except the double buffer feature of the Out-
put Compare unit is enabled in the fast PWM mode.
OCRnx Update
TCNTn
OCnx (COMnx1:0 = 2)
OCnx (COMnx1:0 = 3)
Period 1 2 3
The Timer/Counter Overflow Flag (TOV0) is set each time the counter reaches BOTTOM. The
Interrupt Flag can be used to generate an interrupt each time the counter reaches the BOTTOM
value.
In phase correct PWM mode, the compare unit allows generation of PWM waveforms on the
OC0x pins. Setting the COM0x1:0 bits to two will produce a non-inverted PWM. An inverted
PWM output can be generated by setting the COM0x1:0 to three: Setting the COM0A0 bits to
110 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
one allows the OC0A pin to toggle on Compare Matches if the WGM02 bit is set. This option is
not available for the OC0B pin (See Table 13-3 on page 113). The actual OC0x value will only
be visible on the port pin if the data direction for the port pin is set as output. The PWM wave-
form is generated by clearing (or setting) the OC0x Register at the Compare Match between
OCR0x and TCNT0 when the counter increments, and setting (or clearing) the OC0x Register at
Compare Match between OCR0x and TCNT0 when the counter decrements. The PWM fre-
quency for the output when using phase correct PWM can be calculated by the following
equation:
f clk_I/O
f OCnxPCPWM = ------------------
N ⋅ 510
The N variable represents the prescale factor (1, 8, 64, 256, or 1024).
The extreme values for the OCR0A Register represent special cases when generating a PWM
waveform output in the phase correct PWM mode. If the OCR0A is set equal to BOTTOM, the
output will be continuously low and if set equal to MAX the output will be continuously high for
non-inverted PWM mode. For inverted PWM the output will have the opposite logic values.
At the very start of period 2 in Figure 13-7 OCnx has a transition from high to low even though
there is no Compare Match. The point of this transition is to guarantee symmetry around BOT-
TOM. There are two cases that give a transition without Compare Match.
• OCR0A changes its value from MAX, like in Figure 13-7. When the OCR0A value is MAX the
OCn pin value is the same as the result of a down-counting Compare Match. To ensure
symmetry around BOTTOM the OCn value at MAX must correspond to the result of an up-
counting Compare Match.
• The timer starts counting from a value higher than the one in OCR0A, and for that reason
misses the Compare Match and hence the OCn change that would have happened on the
way up.
clkI/O
clkTn
(clkI/O /1)
TOVn
Figure 13-9 shows the same timing data, but with the prescaler enabled.
111
7593D–AVR–07/06
Figure 13-9. Timer/Counter Timing Diagram, with Prescaler (fclk_I/O/8)
clkI/O
clkTn
(clkI/O /8)
TOVn
Figure 13-10 shows the setting of OCF0B in all modes and OCF0A in all modes except CTC
mode and PWM mode, where OCR0A is TOP.
Figure 13-10. Timer/Counter Timing Diagram, Setting of OCF0x, with Prescaler (fclk_I/O/8)
clkI/O
clkTn
(clkI/O /8)
OCFnx
Figure 13-11 shows the setting of OCF0A and the clearing of TCNT0 in CTC mode and fast
PWM mode where OCR0A is TOP.
Figure 13-11. Timer/Counter Timing Diagram, Clear Timer on Compare Match mode, with Pres-
caler (fclk_I/O/8)
clkI/O
clkTn
(clkI/O /8)
TCNTn
TOP - 1 TOP BOTTOM BOTTOM + 1
(CTC)
OCRnx TOP
OCFnx
112 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Table 13-2 shows the COM0A1:0 bit functionality when the WGM01:0 bits are set to fast PWM
mode.
Note: 1. A special case occurs when OCR0A equals TOP and COM0A1 is set. In this case, the Com-
pare Match is ignored, but the set or clear is done at TOP. See “Fast PWM Mode” on page 108
for more details.
Table 13-3 shows the COM0A1:0 bit functionality when the WGM02:0 bits are set to phase cor-
rect PWM mode.
113
7593D–AVR–07/06
Note: 1. A special case occurs when OCR0A equals TOP and COM0A1 is set. In this case, the Com-
pare Match is ignored, but the set or clear is done at TOP. See “Phase Correct PWM Mode” on
page 110 for more details.
Table 13-2 shows the COM0B1:0 bit functionality when the WGM02:0 bits are set to fast PWM
mode.
Note: 1. A special case occurs when OCR0B equals TOP and COM0B1 is set. In this case, the Com-
pare Match is ignored, but the set or clear is done at TOP. See “Fast PWM Mode” on page 108
for more details.
Table 13-3 shows the COM0B1:0 bit functionality when the WGM02:0 bits are set to phase cor-
rect PWM mode.
114 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Note: 1. A special case occurs when OCR0B equals TOP and COM0B1 is set. In this case, the Com-
pare Match is ignored, but the set or clear is done at TOP. See “Phase Correct PWM Mode” on
page 110 for more details.
115
7593D–AVR–07/06
A FOC0A strobe will not generate any interrupt, nor will it clear the timer in CTC mode using
OCR0A as TOP.
The FOC0A bit is always read as zero.
If external pin modes are used for the Timer/Counter0, transitions on the T0 pin will clock the
counter even if the pin is configured as an output. This feature allows software control of the
counting.
116 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
The Timer/Counter Register gives direct access, both for read and write operations, to the
Timer/Counter unit 8-bit counter. Writing to the TCNT0 Register blocks (removes) the Compare
Match on the following timer clock. Modifying the counter (TCNT0) while the counter is running,
introduces a risk of missing a Compare Match between TCNT0 and the OCR0x Registers.
The Output Compare Register A contains an 8-bit value that is continuously compared with the
counter value (TCNT0). A match can be used to generate an Output Compare interrupt, or to
generate a waveform output on the OC0A pin.
The Output Compare Register B contains an 8-bit value that is continuously compared with the
counter value (TCNT0). A match can be used to generate an Output Compare interrupt, or to
generate a waveform output on the OC0B pin.
117
7593D–AVR–07/06
13.8.7 Timer/Counter 0 Interrupt Flag Register – TIFR0
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
– – – – – OCF0B OCF0A TOV0 TIFR0
Read/Write R R R R R R/W R/W R/W
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
118 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
14. 16-bit Timer/Counter (Timer/Counter1 and Timer/Counter3)
The 16-bit Timer/Counter unit allows accurate program execution timing (event management),
wave generation, and signal timing measurement. The main features are:
• True 16-bit Design (i.e., Allows 16-bit PWM)
• Three independent Output Compare Units
• Double Buffered Output Compare Registers
• One Input Capture Unit
• Input Capture Noise Canceler
• Clear Timer on Compare Match (Auto Reload)
• Glitch-free, Phase Correct Pulse Width Modulator (PWM)
• Variable PWM Period
• Frequency Generator
• External Event Counter
• Twenty independent interrupt sources (TOV1, OCF1A, OCF1B, OCF1C, ICF1, TOV3, OCF3A,
OCF3B, OCF3C, ICF3, TOV4, OCF4A, OCF4B, OCF4C, ICF4, TOV5, OCF5A, OCF5B, OCF5C and
ICF5)
14.1 Overview
Most register and bit references in this section are written in general form. A lower case “n”
replaces the Timer/Counter number, and a lower case “x” replaces the Output Compare unit
channel. However, when using the register or bit defines in a program, the precise form must be
used, i.e., TCNT1 for accessing Timer/Counter1 counter value and so on.
A simplified block diagram of the 16-bit Timer/Counter is shown in Figure 14-1. For the actual
placement of I/O pins, see “Pinout AT90USB64/128-TQFP” on page 3. CPU accessible I/O Reg-
isters, including I/O bits and I/O pins, are shown in bold. The device-specific I/O Register and bit
locations are listed in the “16-bit Timer/Counter (Timer/Counter1 and Timer/Counter3)” on page
119.
The Power Reduction Timer/Counter1 bit, PRTIM1, in “Power Reduction Register 0 - PRR0” on
page 56 must be written to zero to enable Timer/Counter1 module.
The Power Reduction Timer/Counter3 bit, PRTIM3, in “Power Reduction Register 1 - PRR1” on
page 57 must be written to zero to enable Timer/Counter3 module.
119
7593D–AVR–07/06
Figure 14-1. 16-bit Timer/Counter Block Diagram(1)
Count TOVn
Clear (Int.Req.)
Control Logic
Direction TCLK Clock Select
Edge
Tn
Detector
TOP BOTTOM
( From Prescaler )
Timer/Counter
TCNTn
= =0
OCFnA
(Int.Req.)
Waveform
= OCnA
Generation
OCRnA
Fixed OCFnB
TOP (Int.Req.)
Values
Waveform
= OCnB
Generation
DATABUS
OCRnB
OCFnC
(Int.Req.)
Waveform
= OCnC
Generation
OCRnC
( From Analog
Comparator Ouput )
ICFn (Int.Req.)
Edge Noise
ICRn
Detector Canceler
ICPn
Note: 1. Refer to Figure 1-1 on page 3, Table 10-6 on page 82, and Table 10-9 on page 85 for
Timer/Counter1 and 3 and 3 pin placement and description.
14.1.1 Registers
The Timer/Counter (TCNTn), Output Compare Registers (OCRnA/B/C), and Input Capture Reg-
ister (ICRn) are all 16-bit registers. Special procedures must be followed when accessing the 16-
bit registers. These procedures are described in the section “Accessing 16-bit Registers” on
page 121. The Timer/Counter Control Registers (TCCRnA/B/C) are 8-bit registers and have no
CPU access restrictions. Interrupt requests (shorten as Int.Req.) signals are all visible in the
Timer Interrupt Flag Register (TIFRn). All interrupts are individually masked with the Timer Inter-
rupt Mask Register (TIMSKn). TIFRn and TIMSKn are not shown in the figure since these
registers are shared by other timer units.
The Timer/Counter can be clocked internally, via the prescaler, or by an external clock source on
the Tn pin. The Clock Select logic block controls which clock source and edge the Timer/Counter
uses to increment (or decrement) its value. The Timer/Counter is inactive when no clock source
is selected. The output from the clock select logic is referred to as the timer clock (clkTn).
The double buffered Output Compare Registers (OCRnA/B/C) are compared with the
Timer/Counter value at all time. The result of the compare can be used by the Waveform Gener-
ator to generate a PWM or variable frequency output on the Output Compare pin (OCnA/B/C).
120 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
See “Output Compare Units” on page 128.. The compare match event will also set the Compare
Match Flag (OCFnA/B/C) which can be used to generate an Output Compare interrupt request.
The Input Capture Register can capture the Timer/Counter value at a given external (edge trig-
gered) event on either the Input Capture pin (ICPn) or on the Analog Comparator pins (See
“Analog Comparator” on page 313.) The Input Capture unit includes a digital filtering unit (Noise
Canceler) for reducing the chance of capturing noise spikes.
The TOP value, or maximum Timer/Counter value, can in some modes of operation be defined
by either the OCRnA Register, the ICRn Register, or by a set of fixed values. When using
OCRnA as TOP value in a PWM mode, the OCRnA Register can not be used for generating a
PWM output. However, the TOP value will in this case be double buffered allowing the TOP
value to be changed in run time. If a fixed TOP value is required, the ICRn Register can be used
as an alternative, freeing the OCRnA to be used as PWM output.
14.1.2 Definitions
The following definitions are used extensively throughout the document:
MAX The counter reaches its MAXimum when it becomes 0xFFFF (decimal 65535).
The counter reaches the TOP when it becomes equal to the highest value in the
count sequence. The TOP value can be assigned to be one of the fixed values:
TOP
0x00FF, 0x01FF, or 0x03FF, or to the value stored in the OCRnA or ICRn
Register. The assignment is dependent of the mode of operation.
121
7593D–AVR–07/06
Assembly Code Examples(1)
...
; Set TCNTn to 0x01FF
ldi r17,0x01
ldi r16,0xFF
out TCNTnH,r17
out TCNTnL,r16
; Read TCNTn into r17:r16
in r16,TCNTnL
in r17,TCNTnH
...
C Code Examples(1)
unsigned int i;
...
/* Set TCNTn to 0x01FF */
TCNTn = 0x1FF;
/* Read TCNTn into i */
i = TCNTn;
...
122 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
TIM16_ReadTCNTn:
; Save global interrupt flag
in r18,SREG
; Disable interrupts
cli
; Read TCNTn into r17:r16
in r16,TCNTnL
in r17,TCNTnH
; Restore global interrupt flag
out SREG,r18
ret
C Code Example(1)
unsigned int TIM16_ReadTCNTn( void )
{
unsigned char sreg;
unsigned int i;
/* Save global interrupt flag */
sreg = SREG;
/* Disable interrupts */
__disable_interrupt();
/* Read TCNTn into i */
i = TCNTn;
/* Restore global interrupt flag */
SREG = sreg;
return i;
}
Note: 1. See “About Code Examples” on page 8.
The assembly code example returns the TCNTn value in the r17:r16 register pair.
The following code examples show how to do an atomic write of the TCNTn Register contents.
Writing any of the OCRnA/B/C or ICRn Registers can be done by using the same principle.
123
7593D–AVR–07/06
TIM16_WriteTCNTn:
; Save global interrupt flag
in r18,SREG
; Disable interrupts
cli
; Set TCNTn to r17:r16
out TCNTnH,r17
out TCNTnL,r16
; Restore global interrupt flag
out SREG,r18
ret
C Code Example(1)
void TIM16_WriteTCNTn( unsigned int i )
{
unsigned char sreg;
unsigned int i;
/* Save global interrupt flag */
sreg = SREG;
/* Disable interrupts */
__disable_interrupt();
/* Set TCNTn to i */
TCNTn = i;
/* Restore global interrupt flag */
SREG = sreg;
}
Note: 1. See “About Code Examples” on page 8.
The assembly code example requires that the r17:r16 register pair contains the value to be writ-
ten to TCNTn.
124 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Figure 14-2. Counter Unit Block Diagram
DATA BUS (8-bit)
TOVn
(Int.Req.)
TEMP (8-bit)
Clock Select
Count Edge
Tn
TCNTnH (8-bit) TCNTnL (8-bit) Clear clkTn Detector
Control Logic
Direction
TCNTn (16-bit Counter)
( From Prescaler )
TOP BOTTOM
125
7593D–AVR–07/06
14.5 Input Capture Unit
The Timer/Counter incorporates an input capture unit that can capture external events and give
them a time-stamp indicating time of occurrence. The external signal indicating an event, or mul-
tiple events, can be applied via the ICPn pin or alternatively, for the Timer/Counter1 only, via the
Analog Comparator unit. The time-stamps can then be used to calculate frequency, duty-cycle,
and other features of the signal applied. Alternatively the time-stamps can be used for creating a
log of the events.
The Input Capture unit is illustrated by the block diagram shown in Figure 14-3. The elements of
the block diagram that are not directly a part of the input capture unit are gray shaded. The small
“n” in register and bit names indicates the Timer/Counter number.
TEMP (8-bit)
Analog
Comparator Noise Edge
ICFn (Int.Req.)
Canceler Detector
ICPn
Note: The Analog Comparator Output (ACO) can only trigger the Timer/Counter1 ICP – not
Timer/Counter3, 4 or 5.
When a change of the logic level (an event) occurs on the Input Capture Pin (ICPn), alternatively
on the analog Comparator output (ACO), and this change confirms to the setting of the edge
detector, a capture will be triggered. When a capture is triggered, the 16-bit value of the counter
(TCNTn) is written to the Input Capture Register (ICRn). The Input Capture Flag (ICFn) is set at
the same system clock as the TCNTn value is copied into ICRn Register. If enabled (TICIEn =
1), the input capture flag generates an input capture interrupt. The ICFn flag is automatically
cleared when the interrupt is executed. Alternatively the ICFn flag can be cleared by software by
writing a logical one to its I/O bit location.
Reading the 16-bit value in the Input Capture Register (ICRn) is done by first reading the low
byte (ICRnL) and then the high byte (ICRnH). When the low byte is read the high byte is copied
into the high byte Temporary Register (TEMP). When the CPU reads the ICRnH I/O location it
will access the TEMP Register.
126 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
The ICRn Register can only be written when using a Waveform Generation mode that utilizes
the ICRn Register for defining the counter’s TOP value. In these cases the Waveform Genera-
tion mode (WGMn3:0) bits must be set before the TOP value can be written to the ICRn
Register. When writing the ICRn Register the high byte must be written to the ICRnH I/O location
before the low byte is written to ICRnL.
For more information on how to access the 16-bit registers refer to “Accessing 16-bit Registers”
on page 121.
127
7593D–AVR–07/06
Register has been read. After a change of the edge, the Input Capture Flag (ICFn) must be
cleared by software (writing a logical one to the I/O bit location). For measuring frequency only,
the clearing of the ICFn Flag is not required (if an interrupt handler is used).
TEMP (8-bit)
OCRnxH Buf. (8-bit) OCRnxL Buf. (8-bit) TCNTnH (8-bit) TCNTnL (8-bit)
= (16-bit Comparator )
OCFnx (Int.Req.)
TOP
Waveform Generator OCnx
BOTTOM
WGMn3:0 COMnx1:0
The OCRnx Register is double buffered when using any of the twelve Pulse Width Modulation
(PWM) modes. For the Normal and Clear Timer on Compare (CTC) modes of operation, the
double buffering is disabled. The double buffering synchronizes the update of the OCRnx Com-
pare Register to either TOP or BOTTOM of the counting sequence. The synchronization
128 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
prevents the occurrence of odd-length, non-symmetrical PWM pulses, thereby making the out-
put glitch-free.
The OCRnx Register access may seem complex, but this is not case. When the double buffering
is enabled, the CPU has access to the OCRnx Buffer Register, and if double buffering is dis-
abled the CPU will access the OCRnx directly. The content of the OCR1x (Buffer or Compare)
Register is only changed by a write operation (the Timer/Counter does not update this register
automatically as the TCNT1 and ICR1 Register). Therefore OCR1x is not read via the high byte
temporary register (TEMP). However, it is a good practice to read the low byte first as when
accessing other 16-bit registers. Writing the OCRnx Registers must be done via the TEMP Reg-
ister since the compare of all 16 bits is done continuously. The high byte (OCRnxH) has to be
written first. When the high byte I/O location is written by the CPU, the TEMP Register will be
updated by the value written. Then when the low byte (OCRnxL) is written to the lower eight bits,
the high byte will be copied into the upper 8-bits of either the OCRnx buffer or OCRnx Compare
Register in the same system clock cycle.
For more information of how to access the 16-bit registers refer to “Accessing 16-bit Registers”
on page 121.
129
7593D–AVR–07/06
Secondly the COMnx1:0 bits control the OCnx pin output source. Figure 14-5 shows a simplified
schematic of the logic affected by the COMnx1:0 bit setting. The I/O Registers, I/O bits, and I/O
pins in the figure are shown in bold. Only the parts of the general I/O Port Control Registers
(DDR and PORT) that are affected by the COMnx1:0 bits are shown. When referring to the
OCnx state, the reference is for the internal OCnx Register, not the OCnx pin. If a system reset
occur, the OCnx Register is reset to “0”.
COMnx1
COMnx0 Waveform
D Q
FOCnx Generator
1
OCnx
OCnx Pin
0
DATA BUS D Q
PORT
D Q
DDR
clk I/O
The general I/O port function is overridden by the Output Compare (OCnx) from the Waveform
Generator if either of the COMnx1:0 bits are set. However, the OCnx pin direction (input or out-
put) is still controlled by the Data Direction Register (DDR) for the port pin. The Data Direction
Register bit for the OCnx pin (DDR_OCnx) must be set as output before the OCnx value is visi-
ble on the pin. The port override function is generally independent of the Waveform Generation
mode, but there are some exceptions. Refer to Table 14-1, Table 14-2 and Table 14-3 for
details.
The design of the Output Compare pin logic allows initialization of the OCnx state before the out-
put is enabled. Note that some COMnx1:0 bit settings are reserved for certain modes of
operation. See “16-bit Timer/Counter (Timer/Counter1 and Timer/Counter3)” on page 119.
The COMnx1:0 bits have no effect on the Input Capture unit.
130 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
A change of the COMnx1:0 bits state will have effect at the first compare match after the bits are
written. For non-PWM modes, the action can be forced to have immediate effect by using the
FOCnx strobe bits.
131
7593D–AVR–07/06
Figure 14-6. CTC Mode, Timing Diagram
OCnA Interrupt Flag Set
or ICFn Interrupt Flag Set
(Interrupt on TOP)
TCNTn
OCnA
(COMnA1:0 = 1)
(Toggle)
Period 1 2 3 4
An interrupt can be generated at each time the counter value reaches the TOP value by either
using the OCFnA or ICFn Flag according to the register used to define the TOP value. If the
interrupt is enabled, the interrupt handler routine can be used for updating the TOP value. How-
ever, changing the TOP to a value close to BOTTOM when the counter is running with none or a
low prescaler value must be done with care since the CTC mode does not have the double buff-
ering feature. If the new value written to OCRnA or ICRn is lower than the current value of
TCNTn, the counter will miss the compare match. The counter will then have to count to its max-
imum value (0xFFFF) and wrap around starting at 0x0000 before the compare match can occur.
In many cases this feature is not desirable. An alternative will then be to use the fast PWM mode
using OCRnA for defining TOP (WGMn3:0 = 15) since the OCRnA then will be double buffered.
For generating a waveform output in CTC mode, the OCnA output can be set to toggle its logical
level on each compare match by setting the Compare Output mode bits to toggle mode
(COMnA1:0 = 1). The OCnA value will not be visible on the port pin unless the data direction for
the pin is set to output (DDR_OCnA = 1). The waveform generated will have a maximum fre-
quency of fOCnA = fclk_I/O/2 when OCRnA is set to zero (0x0000). The waveform frequency is
defined by the following equation:
f clk_I/O
f OCnA = ---------------------------------------------------
2 ⋅ N ⋅ ( 1 + OCRnA )
The N variable represents the prescaler factor (1, 8, 64, 256, or 1024).
As for the Normal mode of operation, the TOVn Flag is set in the same timer clock cycle that the
counter counts from MAX to 0x0000.
132 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
The PWM resolution for fast PWM can be fixed to 8-, 9-, or 10-bit, or defined by either ICRn or
OCRnA. The minimum resolution allowed is 2-bit (ICRn or OCRnA set to 0x0003), and the max-
imum resolution is 16-bit (ICRn or OCRnA set to MAX). The PWM resolution in bits can be
calculated by using the following equation:
log ( TOP + 1 )
R FPWM = -----------------------------------
log ( 2 )
In fast PWM mode the counter is incremented until the counter value matches either one of the
fixed values 0x00FF, 0x01FF, or 0x03FF (WGMn3:0 = 5, 6, or 7), the value in ICRn (WGMn3:0 =
14), or the value in OCRnA (WGMn3:0 = 15). The counter is then cleared at the following timer
clock cycle. The timing diagram for the fast PWM mode is shown in Figure 14-7. The figure
shows fast PWM mode when OCRnA or ICRn is used to define TOP. The TCNTn value is in the
timing diagram shown as a histogram for illustrating the single-slope operation. The diagram
includes non-inverted and inverted PWM outputs. The small horizontal line marks on the TCNTn
slopes represent compare matches between OCRnx and TCNTn. The OCnx Interrupt Flag will
be set when a compare match occurs.
TCNTn
OCnx (COMnx1:0 = 2)
OCnx (COMnx1:0 = 3)
Period 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
The Timer/Counter Overflow Flag (TOVn) is set each time the counter reaches TOP. In addition
the OCnA or ICFn Flag is set at the same timer clock cycle as TOVn is set when either OCRnA
or ICRn is used for defining the TOP value. If one of the interrupts are enabled, the interrupt han-
dler routine can be used for updating the TOP and compare values.
When changing the TOP value the program must ensure that the new TOP value is higher or
equal to the value of all of the Compare Registers. If the TOP value is lower than any of the
Compare Registers, a compare match will never occur between the TCNTn and the OCRnx.
Note that when using fixed TOP values the unused bits are masked to zero when any of the
OCRnx Registers are written.
The procedure for updating ICRn differs from updating OCRnA when used for defining the TOP
value. The ICRn Register is not double buffered. This means that if ICRn is changed to a low
value when the counter is running with none or a low prescaler value, there is a risk that the new
ICRn value written is lower than the current value of TCNTn. The result will then be that the
counter will miss the compare match at the TOP value. The counter will then have to count to the
MAX value (0xFFFF) and wrap around starting at 0x0000 before the compare match can occur.
The OCRnA Register however, is double buffered. This feature allows the OCRnA I/O location
133
7593D–AVR–07/06
to be written anytime. When the OCRnA I/O location is written the value written will be put into
the OCRnA Buffer Register. The OCRnA Compare Register will then be updated with the value
in the Buffer Register at the next timer clock cycle the TCNTn matches TOP. The update is done
at the same timer clock cycle as the TCNTn is cleared and the TOVn Flag is set.
Using the ICRn Register for defining TOP works well when using fixed TOP values. By using
ICRn, the OCRnA Register is free to be used for generating a PWM output on OCnA. However,
if the base PWM frequency is actively changed (by changing the TOP value), using the OCRnA
as TOP is clearly a better choice due to its double buffer feature.
In fast PWM mode, the compare units allow generation of PWM waveforms on the OCnx pins.
Setting the COMnx1:0 bits to two will produce a non-inverted PWM and an inverted PWM output
can be generated by setting the COMnx1:0 to three (see Table on page 142). The actual OCnx
value will only be visible on the port pin if the data direction for the port pin is set as output
(DDR_OCnx). The PWM waveform is generated by setting (or clearing) the OCnx Register at
the compare match between OCRnx and TCNTn, and clearing (or setting) the OCnx Register at
the timer clock cycle the counter is cleared (changes from TOP to BOTTOM).
The PWM frequency for the output can be calculated by the following equation:
f clk_I/O
f OCnxPWM = -----------------------------------
N ⋅ ( 1 + TOP )
The N variable represents the prescaler divider (1, 8, 64, 256, or 1024).
The extreme values for the OCRnx Register represents special cases when generating a PWM
waveform output in the fast PWM mode. If the OCRnx is set equal to BOTTOM (0x0000) the out-
put will be a narrow spike for each TOP+1 timer clock cycle. Setting the OCRnx equal to TOP
will result in a constant high or low output (depending on the polarity of the output set by the
COMnx1:0 bits.)
A frequency (with 50% duty cycle) waveform output in fast PWM mode can be achieved by set-
ting OCnA to toggle its logical level on each compare match (COMnA1:0 = 1). This applies only
if OCR1A is used to define the TOP value (WGM13:0 = 15). The waveform generated will have
a maximum frequency of fOCnA = fclk_I/O/2 when OCRnA is set to zero (0x0000). This feature is
similar to the OCnA toggle in CTC mode, except the double buffer feature of the Output Com-
pare unit is enabled in the fast PWM mode.
134 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
0x0003), and the maximum resolution is 16-bit (ICRn or OCRnA set to MAX). The PWM resolu-
tion in bits can be calculated by using the following equation:
log ( TOP + 1 )
R PCPWM = -----------------------------------
log ( 2 )
In phase correct PWM mode the counter is incremented until the counter value matches either
one of the fixed values 0x00FF, 0x01FF, or 0x03FF (WGMn3:0 = 1, 2, or 3), the value in ICRn
(WGMn3:0 = 10), or the value in OCRnA (WGMn3:0 = 11). The counter has then reached the
TOP and changes the count direction. The TCNTn value will be equal to TOP for one timer clock
cycle. The timing diagram for the phase correct PWM mode is shown on Figure 14-8. The figure
shows phase correct PWM mode when OCRnA or ICRn is used to define TOP. The TCNTn
value is in the timing diagram shown as a histogram for illustrating the dual-slope operation. The
diagram includes non-inverted and inverted PWM outputs. The small horizontal line marks on
the TCNTn slopes represent compare matches between OCRnx and TCNTn. The OCnx Inter-
rupt Flag will be set when a compare match occurs.
TCNTn
OCnx (COMnx1:0 = 2)
OCnx (COMnx1:0 = 3)
Period 1 2 3 4
The Timer/Counter Overflow Flag (TOVn) is set each time the counter reaches BOTTOM. When
either OCRnA or ICRn is used for defining the TOP value, the OCnA or ICFn Flag is set accord-
ingly at the same timer clock cycle as the OCRnx Registers are updated with the double buffer
value (at TOP). The Interrupt Flags can be used to generate an interrupt each time the counter
reaches the TOP or BOTTOM value.
When changing the TOP value the program must ensure that the new TOP value is higher or
equal to the value of all of the Compare Registers. If the TOP value is lower than any of the
Compare Registers, a compare match will never occur between the TCNTn and the OCRnx.
Note that when using fixed TOP values, the unused bits are masked to zero when any of the
OCRnx Registers are written. As the third period shown in Figure 14-8 illustrates, changing the
TOP actively while the Timer/Counter is running in the phase correct mode can result in an
unsymmetrical output. The reason for this can be found in the time of update of the OCRnx Reg-
135
7593D–AVR–07/06
ister. Since the OCRnx update occurs at TOP, the PWM period starts and ends at TOP. This
implies that the length of the falling slope is determined by the previous TOP value, while the
length of the rising slope is determined by the new TOP value. When these two values differ the
two slopes of the period will differ in length. The difference in length gives the unsymmetrical
result on the output.
It is recommended to use the phase and frequency correct mode instead of the phase correct
mode when changing the TOP value while the Timer/Counter is running. When using a static
TOP value there are practically no differences between the two modes of operation.
In phase correct PWM mode, the compare units allow generation of PWM waveforms on the
OCnx pins. Setting the COMnx1:0 bits to two will produce a non-inverted PWM and an inverted
PWM output can be generated by setting the COMnx1:0 to three (See Table 14-3 on page 143).
The actual OCnx value will only be visible on the port pin if the data direction for the port pin is
set as output (DDR_OCnx). The PWM waveform is generated by setting (or clearing) the OCnx
Register at the compare match between OCRnx and TCNTn when the counter increments, and
clearing (or setting) the OCnx Register at compare match between OCRnx and TCNTn when
the counter decrements. The PWM frequency for the output when using phase correct PWM can
be calculated by the following equation:
f clk_I/O
f OCnxPCPWM = ----------------------------
2 ⋅ N ⋅ TOP
The N variable represents the prescaler divider (1, 8, 64, 256, or 1024).
The extreme values for the OCRnx Register represent special cases when generating a PWM
waveform output in the phase correct PWM mode. If the OCRnx is set equal to BOTTOM the
output will be continuously low and if set equal to TOP the output will be continuously high for
non-inverted PWM mode. For inverted PWM the output will have the opposite logic values. If
OCR1A is used to define the TOP value (WGM13:0 = 11) and COM1A1:0 = 1, the OC1A output
will toggle with a 50% duty cycle.
136 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
the maximum resolution is 16-bit (ICRn or OCRnA set to MAX). The PWM resolution in bits can
be calculated using the following equation:
log ( TOP + 1 )
R PFCPWM = -----------------------------------
log ( 2 )
In phase and frequency correct PWM mode the counter is incremented until the counter value
matches either the value in ICRn (WGMn3:0 = 8), or the value in OCRnA (WGMn3:0 = 9). The
counter has then reached the TOP and changes the count direction. The TCNTn value will be
equal to TOP for one timer clock cycle. The timing diagram for the phase correct and frequency
correct PWM mode is shown on Figure 14-9. The figure shows phase and frequency correct
PWM mode when OCRnA or ICRn is used to define TOP. The TCNTn value is in the timing dia-
gram shown as a histogram for illustrating the dual-slope operation. The diagram includes non-
inverted and inverted PWM outputs. The small horizontal line marks on the TCNTn slopes repre-
sent compare matches between OCRnx and TCNTn. The OCnx Interrupt Flag will be set when a
compare match occurs.
Figure 14-9. Phase and Frequency Correct PWM Mode, Timing Diagram
OCnA Interrupt Flag Set
or ICFn Interrupt Flag Set
(Interrupt on TOP)
OCRnx/TOP Updateand
TOVn Interrupt Flag Set
(Interrupt on Bottom)
TCNTn
OCnx (COMnx1:0 = 2)
OCnx (COMnx1:0 = 3)
Period 1 2 3 4
The Timer/Counter Overflow Flag (TOVn) is set at the same timer clock cycle as the OCRnx
Registers are updated with the double buffer value (at BOTTOM). When either OCRnA or ICRn
is used for defining the TOP value, the OCnA or ICFn Flag set when TCNTn has reached TOP.
The Interrupt Flags can then be used to generate an interrupt each time the counter reaches the
TOP or BOTTOM value.
When changing the TOP value the program must ensure that the new TOP value is higher or
equal to the value of all of the Compare Registers. If the TOP value is lower than any of the
Compare Registers, a compare match will never occur between the TCNTn and the OCRnx.
As Figure 14-9 shows the output generated is, in contrast to the phase correct mode, symmetri-
cal in all periods. Since the OCRnx Registers are updated at BOTTOM, the length of the rising
and the falling slopes will always be equal. This gives symmetrical output pulses and is therefore
frequency correct.
137
7593D–AVR–07/06
Using the ICRn Register for defining TOP works well when using fixed TOP values. By using
ICRn, the OCRnA Register is free to be used for generating a PWM output on OCnA. However,
if the base PWM frequency is actively changed by changing the TOP value, using the OCRnA as
TOP is clearly a better choice due to its double buffer feature.
In phase and frequency correct PWM mode, the compare units allow generation of PWM wave-
forms on the OCnx pins. Setting the COMnx1:0 bits to two will produce a non-inverted PWM and
an inverted PWM output can be generated by setting the COMnx1:0 to three (See Table 14-3 on
page 143). The actual OCnx value will only be visible on the port pin if the data direction for the
port pin is set as output (DDR_OCnx). The PWM waveform is generated by setting (or clearing)
the OCnx Register at the compare match between OCRnx and TCNTn when the counter incre-
ments, and clearing (or setting) the OCnx Register at compare match between OCRnx and
TCNTn when the counter decrements. The PWM frequency for the output when using phase
and frequency correct PWM can be calculated by the following equation:
f clk_I/O
f OCnxPFCPWM = ----------------------------
2 ⋅ N ⋅ TOP
The N variable represents the prescaler divider (1, 8, 64, 256, or 1024).
The extreme values for the OCRnx Register represents special cases when generating a PWM
waveform output in the phase correct PWM mode. If the OCRnx is set equal to BOTTOM the
output will be continuously low and if set equal to TOP the output will be set to high for non-
inverted PWM mode. For inverted PWM the output will have the opposite logic values. If OCR1A
is used to define the TOP value (WGM13:0 = 9) and COM1A1:0 = 1, the OC1A output will toggle
with a 50% duty cycle.
clkI/O
clkTn
(clkI/O /1)
OCFnx
Figure 14-11 shows the same timing data, but with the prescaler enabled.
138 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Figure 14-11. Timer/Counter Timing Diagram, Setting of OCFnx, with Prescaler (fclk_I/O/8)
clkI/O
clkTn
(clkI/O /8)
OCFnx
Figure 14-12 shows the count sequence close to TOP in various modes. When using phase and
frequency correct PWM mode the OCRnx Register is updated at BOTTOM. The timing diagrams
will be the same, but TOP should be replaced by BOTTOM, TOP-1 by BOTTOM+1 and so on.
The same renaming applies for modes that set the TOVn Flag at BOTTOM.
clkI/O
clkTn
(clkI/O /1)
TCNTn
TOP - 1 TOP BOTTOM BOTTOM + 1
(CTC and FPWM)
TCNTn
TOP - 1 TOP TOP - 1 TOP - 2
(PC and PFC PWM)
TOVn (FPWM)
and ICFn (if used
as TOP)
OCRnx
Old OCRnx Value New OCRnx Value
(Update at TOP)
Figure 14-13 shows the same timing data, but with the prescaler enabled.
139
7593D–AVR–07/06
Figure 14-13. Timer/Counter Timing Diagram, with Prescaler (fclk_I/O/8)
clkI/O
clkTn
(clkI/O/8)
TCNTn
TOP - 1 TOP BOTTOM BOTTOM + 1
(CTC and FPWM)
TOVn (FPWM)
and ICF n (if used
as TOP)
OCRnx
Old OCRnx Value New OCRnx Value
(Update at TOP)
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
COM1A COM1A COM1B COM1B COM1C COM1C WGM11 WGM1 TCCR1
1 0 1 0 1 0 0 A
Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
COM3A COM3A COM3B COM3B COM3C COM3C WGM3 WGM3 TCCR3
1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 A
Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
140 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
When the OCnA, OCnB or OCnC is connected to the pin, the function of the COMnx1:0 bits is
dependent of the WGMn3:0 bits setting. Table 14-1 shows the COMnx1:0 bit functionality when
the WGMn3:0 bits are set to a normal or a CTC mode (non-PWM).
141
7593D–AVR–07/06
.
Table 14-2 shows the COMnx1:0 bit functionality when the WGMn3:0 bits are set to the fast
PWM mode.
142 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Table 14-3. Compare Output Mode, Phase Correct and Phase and Frequency Correct PWM
COMnA1/COMnB/ COMnA0/COMnB0/
COMnC1 COMnC0 Description
Normal port operation, OCnA/OCnB/OCnC
0 0
disconnected.
WGM13:0 = 8, 9 10 or 11: Toggle OC1A on
Compare Match, OC1B and OC1C
0 1 disconnected (normal port operation). For all
other WGM1 settings, normal port operation,
OC1A/OC1B/OC1C disconnected.
Clear OCnA/OCnB/OCnC on compare
match when up-counting. Set
1 0
OCnA/OCnB/OCnC on compare match
when downcounting.
Set OCnA/OCnB/OCnC on compare match
when up-counting. Clear
1 1
OCnA/OCnB/OCnC on compare match
when downcounting.
Note: A special case occurs when OCRnA/OCRnB/OCRnC equals TOP and
COMnA1/COMnB1//COMnC1 is set. See “Phase Correct PWM Mode” on page 110. for more
details.
143
7593D–AVR–07/06
Table 14-4. Waveform Generation Mode Bit Description(1)
WGMn2 WGMn1 WGMn0 Timer/Counter Mode of Update of TOVn Flag
Mode WGMn3 (CTCn) (PWMn1) (PWMn0) Operation TOP OCRnx at Set on
0 0 0 0 0 Normal 0xFFFF Immediate MAX
1 0 0 0 1 PWM, Phase Correct, 8-bit 0x00FF TOP BOTTOM
2 0 0 1 0 PWM, Phase Correct, 9-bit 0x01FF TOP BOTTOM
3 0 0 1 1 PWM, Phase Correct, 10-bit 0x03FF TOP BOTTOM
4 0 1 0 0 CTC OCRnA Immediate MAX
5 0 1 0 1 Fast PWM, 8-bit 0x00FF TOP TOP
6 0 1 1 0 Fast PWM, 9-bit 0x01FF TOP TOP
7 0 1 1 1 Fast PWM, 10-bit 0x03FF TOP TOP
PWM, Phase and Frequency
8 1 0 0 0 ICRn BOTTOM BOTTOM
Correct
PWM, Phase and Frequency
9 1 0 0 1 OCRnA BOTTOM BOTTOM
Correct
10 1 0 1 0 PWM, Phase Correct ICRn TOP BOTTOM
11 1 0 1 1 PWM, Phase Correct OCRnA TOP BOTTOM
12 1 1 0 0 CTC ICRn Immediate MAX
13 1 1 0 1 (Reserved) – – –
14 1 1 1 0 Fast PWM ICRn TOP TOP
15 1 1 1 1 Fast PWM OCRnA TOP TOP
Note: 1. The CTCn and PWMn1:0 bit definition names are obsolete. Use the WGMn2:0 definitions. However, the functionality and
location of these bits are compatible with previous versions of the timer.
144 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
This bit selects which edge on the Input Capture Pin (ICPn) that is used to trigger a capture
event. When the ICESn bit is written to zero, a falling (negative) edge is used as trigger, and
when the ICESn bit is written to one, a rising (positive) edge will trigger the capture.
When a capture is triggered according to the ICESn setting, the counter value is copied into the
Input Capture Register (ICRn). The event will also set the Input Capture Flag (ICFn), and this
can be used to cause an Input Capture Interrupt, if this interrupt is enabled.
When the ICRn is used as TOP value (see description of the WGMn3:0 bits located in the
TCCRnA and the TCCRnB Register), the ICPn is disconnected and consequently the input cap-
ture function is disabled.
145
7593D–AVR–07/06
Table 14-5. Clock Select Bit Description
CSn2 CSn1 CSn0 Description
0 0 0 No clock source. (Timer/Counter stopped)
0 0 1 clkI/O/1 (No prescaling
0 1 0 clkI/O/8 (From prescaler)
0 1 1 clkI/O/64 (From prescaler)
1 0 0 clkI/O/256 (From prescaler)
1 0 1 clkI/O/1024 (From prescaler)
1 1 0 External clock source on Tn pin. Clock on falling edge
1 1 1 External clock source on Tn pin. Clock on rising edge
If external pin modes are used for the Timer/Countern, transitions on the Tn pin will clock the
counter even if the pin is configured as an output. This feature allows software control of the
counting.
146 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
TCNT1[15:8] TCNT1H
TCNT1[7:0] TCNT1L
Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
The two Timer/Counter I/O locations (TCNTnH and TCNTnL, combined TCNTn) give direct
access, both for read and for write operations, to the Timer/Counter unit 16-bit counter. To
ensure that both the high and low bytes are read and written simultaneously when the CPU
accesses these registers, the access is performed using an 8-bit temporary High Byte Register
(TEMP). This temporary register is shared by all the other 16-bit registers. See “Accessing 16-bit
Registers” on page 121.
Modifying the counter (TCNTn) while the counter is running introduces a risk of missing a com-
pare match between TCNTn and one of the OCRnx Registers.
Writing to the TCNTn Register blocks (removes) the compare match on the following timer clock
for all compare units.
147
7593D–AVR–07/06
14.10.13 Output Compare Register 3 B – OCR3BH and OCR3BL
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
OCR3B[15:8] OCR3BH
OCR3B[7:0] OCR3BL
Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
The Output Compare Registers contain a 16-bit value that is continuously compared with the
counter value (TCNTn). A match can be used to generate an Output Compare interrupt, or to
generate a waveform output on the OCnx pin.
The Output Compare Registers are 16-bit in size. To ensure that both the high and low bytes are
written simultaneously when the CPU writes to these registers, the access is performed using an
8-bit temporary High Byte Register (TEMP). This temporary register is shared by all the other
16-bit registers. See “Accessing 16-bit Registers” on page 121.
The Input Capture is updated with the counter (TCNTn) value each time an event occurs on the
ICPn pin (or optionally on the Analog Comparator output for Timer/Counter1). The Input Capture
can be used for defining the counter TOP value.
The Input Capture Register is 16-bit in size. To ensure that both the high and low bytes are read
simultaneously when the CPU accesses these registers, the access is performed using an 8-bit
temporary High Byte Register (TEMP). This temporary register is shared by all the other 16-bit
registers. See “Accessing 16-bit Registers” on page 121.
148 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
14.10.18 Timer/Counter3 Interrupt Mask Register – TIMSK3
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
– – ICIE3 – OCIE3 OCIE3B OCIE3A TOIE3 TIMSK3
C
Read/Write R R R/W R R/W R/W R/W R/W
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
149
7593D–AVR–07/06
This flag is set when a capture event occurs on the ICPn pin. When the Input Capture Register
(ICRn) is set by the WGMn3:0 to be used as the TOP value, the ICFn Flag is set when the
counter reaches the TOP value.
ICFn is automatically cleared when the Input Capture Interrupt Vector is executed. Alternatively,
ICFn can be cleared by writing a logic one to its bit location.
150 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
15. 8-bit Timer/Counter2 with PWM and Asynchronous Operation
Timer/Counter2 is a general purpose, single channel, 8-bit Timer/Counter module. The main
features are:
• Single Channel Counter
• Clear Timer on Compare Match (Auto Reload)
• Glitch-free, Phase Correct Pulse Width Modulator (PWM)
• Frequency Generator
• 10-bit Clock Prescaler
• Overflow and Compare Match Interrupt Sources (TOV2, OCF2A and OCF2B)
• Allows Clocking from External 32 kHz Watch Crystal Independent of the I/O Clock
15.1 Overview
A simplified block diagram of the 8-bit Timer/Counter is shown in Figure 15-1.. For the actual
placement of I/O pins, see “Pin Configurations” on page 3. CPU accessible I/O Registers, includ-
ing I/O bits and I/O pins, are shown in bold. The device-specific I/O Register and bit locations
are listed in the “8-bit Timer/Counter Register Description” on page 162.
The Power Reduction Timer/Counter2 bit, PRTIM2, in “Power Reduction Register 0 - PRR0” on
page 56 must be written to zero to enable Timer/Counter2 module.
Count TOVn
Clear (Int.Req.)
Control Logic
Direction clkTn TOSC1
T/C
Oscillator
Prescaler TOSC2
TOP BOTTOM
clkI/O
Timer/Counter
TCNTn
= =0
OCnA
(Int.Req.)
Waveform
= Generation
OCnA
OCRnA
Fixed
OCnB
TOP
(Int.Req.)
Value
DATA BUS
Waveform
= Generation
OCnB
OCRnB clkI/O
Synchronized Status flags
Synchronization Unit
clkASY
asynchronous mode
Status flags select (ASn)
ASSRn
TCCRnA TCCRnB
151
7593D–AVR–07/06
15.1.1 Registers
The Timer/Counter (TCNT2) and Output Compare Register (OCR2A and OCR2B) are 8-bit reg-
isters. Interrupt request (abbreviated to Int.Req.) signals are all visible in the Timer Interrupt Flag
Register (TIFR2). All interrupts are individually masked with the Timer Interrupt Mask Register
(TIMSK2). TIFR2 and TIMSK2 are not shown in the figure.
The Timer/Counter can be clocked internally, via the prescaler, or asynchronously clocked from
the TOSC1/2 pins, as detailed later in this section. The asynchronous operation is controlled by
the Asynchronous Status Register (ASSR). The Clock Select logic block controls which clock
source the Timer/Counter uses to increment (or decrement) its value. The Timer/Counter is inac-
tive when no clock source is selected. The output from the Clock Select logic is referred to as the
timer clock (clkT2).
The double buffered Output Compare Register (OCR2A and OCR2B) are compared with the
Timer/Counter value at all times. The result of the compare can be used by the Waveform Gen-
erator to generate a PWM or variable frequency output on the Output Compare pins (OC2A and
OC2B). See “Output Compare Unit” on page 153. for details. The compare match event will also
set the Compare Flag (OCF2A or OCF2B) which can be used to generate an Output Compare
interrupt request.
15.1.2 Definitions
Many register and bit references in this document are written in general form. A lower case “n”
replaces the Timer/Counter number, in this case 2. However, when using the register or bit
defines in a program, the precise form must be used, i.e., TCNT2 for accessing Timer/Counter2
counter value and so on.
The definitions in the table below are also used extensively throughout the section.
BOTTOM The counter reaches the BOTTOM when it becomes zero (0x00).
MAX The counter reaches its MAXimum when it becomes 0xFF (decimal 255).
TOP The counter reaches the TOP when it becomes equal to the highest
value in the count sequence. The TOP value can be assigned to be the
fixed value 0xFF (MAX) or the value stored in the OCR2A Register. The
assignment is dependent on the mode of operation.
152 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Figure 15-2. Counter Unit Block Diagram
TOVn
DATA BUS (Int.Req.)
TOSC1
count
T/C
clear clk Tn
TCNTn Control Logic Prescaler Oscillator
direction
TOSC2
153
7593D–AVR–07/06
Figure 15-3. Output Compare Unit, Block Diagram
DATA BUS
OCRnx TCNTn
= (8-bit Comparator )
OCFnx (Int.Req.)
top
bottom
Waveform Generator OCnx
FOCn
WGMn1:0 COMnX1:0
The OCR2x Register is double buffered when using any of the Pulse Width Modulation (PWM)
modes. For the Normal and Clear Timer on Compare (CTC) modes of operation, the double
buffering is disabled. The double buffering synchronizes the update of the OCR2x Compare
Register to either top or bottom of the counting sequence. The synchronization prevents the
occurrence of odd-length, non-symmetrical PWM pulses, thereby making the output glitch-free.
The OCR2x Register access may seem complex, but this is not case. When the double buffering
is enabled, the CPU has access to the OCR2x Buffer Register, and if double buffering is dis-
abled the CPU will access the OCR2x directly.
154 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
The setup of the OC2x should be performed before setting the Data Direction Register for the
port pin to output. The easiest way of setting the OC2x value is to use the Force Output Com-
pare (FOC2x) strobe bit in Normal mode. The OC2x Register keeps its value even when
changing between Waveform Generation modes.
Be aware that the COM2x1:0 bits are not double buffered together with the compare value.
Changing the COM2x1:0 bits will take effect immediately.
COMnx1
COMnx0 Waveform
D Q
FOCnx Generator
1
OCnx
OCnx Pin
0
D Q
DATA BUS
PORT
D Q
DDR
clk I/O
The general I/O port function is overridden by the Output Compare (OC2x) from the Waveform
Generator if either of the COM2x1:0 bits are set. However, the OC2x pin direction (input or out-
put) is still controlled by the Data Direction Register (DDR) for the port pin. The Data Direction
Register bit for the OC2x pin (DDR_OC2x) must be set as output before the OC2x value is visi-
ble on the pin. The port override function is independent of the Waveform Generation mode.
The design of the Output Compare pin logic allows initialization of the OC2x state before the out-
put is enabled. Note that some COM2x1:0 bit settings are reserved for certain modes of
operation. See “8-bit Timer/Counter Register Description” on page 162.
155
7593D–AVR–07/06
15.5.1 Compare Output Mode and Waveform Generation
The Waveform Generator uses the COM2x1:0 bits differently in normal, CTC, and PWM modes.
For all modes, setting the COM2x1:0 = 0 tells the Waveform Generator that no action on the
OC2x Register is to be performed on the next compare match. For compare output actions in the
non-PWM modes refer to Table 15-4 on page 163. For fast PWM mode, refer to Table 15-5 on
page 164, and for phase correct PWM refer to Table 15-6 on page 164.
A change of the COM2x1:0 bits state will have effect at the first compare match after the bits are
written. For non-PWM modes, the action can be forced to have immediate effect by using the
FOC2x strobe bits.
156 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Figure 15-5. CTC Mode, Timing Diagram
TCNTn
OCnx
(COMnx1:0 = 1)
(Toggle)
Period 1 2 3 4
An interrupt can be generated each time the counter value reaches the TOP value by using the
OCF2A Flag. If the interrupt is enabled, the interrupt handler routine can be used for updating
the TOP value. However, changing TOP to a value close to BOTTOM when the counter is run-
ning with none or a low prescaler value must be done with care since the CTC mode does not
have the double buffering feature. If the new value written to OCR2A is lower than the current
value of TCNT2, the counter will miss the compare match. The counter will then have to count to
its maximum value (0xFF) and wrap around starting at 0x00 before the compare match can
occur.
For generating a waveform output in CTC mode, the OC2A output can be set to toggle its logical
level on each compare match by setting the Compare Output mode bits to toggle mode
(COM2A1:0 = 1). The OC2A value will not be visible on the port pin unless the data direction for
the pin is set to output. The waveform generated will have a maximum frequency of fOC2A =
fclk_I/O/2 when OCR2A is set to zero (0x00). The waveform frequency is defined by the following
equation:
f clk_I/O
f OCnx = --------------------------------------------------
2 ⋅ N ⋅ ( 1 + OCRnx )
The N variable represents the prescale factor (1, 8, 32, 64, 128, 256, or 1024).
As for the Normal mode of operation, the TOV2 Flag is set in the same timer clock cycle that the
counter counts from MAX to 0x00.
157
7593D–AVR–07/06
In fast PWM mode, the counter is incremented until the counter value matches the TOP value.
The counter is then cleared at the following timer clock cycle. The timing diagram for the fast
PWM mode is shown in Figure 15-6. The TCNT2 value is in the timing diagram shown as a his-
togram for illustrating the single-slope operation. The diagram includes non-inverted and
inverted PWM outputs. The small horizontal line marks on the TCNT2 slopes represent compare
matches between OCR2x and TCNT2.
TCNTn
OCnx (COMnx1:0 = 2)
OCnx (COMnx1:0 = 3)
Period 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
The Timer/Counter Overflow Flag (TOV2) is set each time the counter reaches TOP. If the inter-
rupt is enabled, the interrupt handler routine can be used for updating the compare value.
In fast PWM mode, the compare unit allows generation of PWM waveforms on the OC2x pin.
Setting the COM2x1:0 bits to two will produce a non-inverted PWM and an inverted PWM output
can be generated by setting the COM2x1:0 to three. TOP is defined as 0xFF when WGM2:0 = 3,
and OCR2A when WGM2:0 = 7 (See Table 15-2 on page 163). The actual OC2x value will only
be visible on the port pin if the data direction for the port pin is set as output. The PWM wave-
form is generated by setting (or clearing) the OC2x Register at the compare match between
OCR2x and TCNT2, and clearing (or setting) the OC2x Register at the timer clock cycle the
counter is cleared (changes from TOP to BOTTOM).
The PWM frequency for the output can be calculated by the following equation:
f clk_I/O
f OCnxPWM = ------------------
N ⋅ 256
The N variable represents the prescale factor (1, 8, 32, 64, 128, 256, or 1024).
The extreme values for the OCR2A Register represent special cases when generating a PWM
waveform output in the fast PWM mode. If the OCR2A is set equal to BOTTOM, the output will
be a narrow spike for each MAX+1 timer clock cycle. Setting the OCR2A equal to MAX will result
in a constantly high or low output (depending on the polarity of the output set by the COM2A1:0
bits.)
A frequency (with 50% duty cycle) waveform output in fast PWM mode can be achieved by set-
ting OC2x to toggle its logical level on each compare match (COM2x1:0 = 1). The waveform
158 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
generated will have a maximum frequency of foc2 = fclk_I/O/2 when OCR2A is set to zero. This fea-
ture is similar to the OC2A toggle in CTC mode, except the double buffer feature of the Output
Compare unit is enabled in the fast PWM mode.
OCRnx Update
TCNTn
OCnx (COMnx1:0 = 2)
OCnx (COMnx1:0 = 3)
Period 1 2 3
The Timer/Counter Overflow Flag (TOV2) is set each time the counter reaches BOTTOM. The
Interrupt Flag can be used to generate an interrupt each time the counter reaches the BOTTOM
value.
In phase correct PWM mode, the compare unit allows generation of PWM waveforms on the
OC2x pin. Setting the COM2x1:0 bits to two will produce a non-inverted PWM. An inverted PWM
159
7593D–AVR–07/06
output can be generated by setting the COM2x1:0 to three. TOP is defined as 0xFF when
WGM2:0 = 3, and OCR2A when MGM2:0 = 7 (See Table 15-3 on page 163). The actual OC2x
value will only be visible on the port pin if the data direction for the port pin is set as output. The
PWM waveform is generated by clearing (or setting) the OC2x Register at the compare match
between OCR2x and TCNT2 when the counter increments, and setting (or clearing) the OC2x
Register at compare match between OCR2x and TCNT2 when the counter decrements. The
PWM frequency for the output when using phase correct PWM can be calculated by the follow-
ing equation:
f clk_I/O
f OCnxPCPWM = ------------------
N ⋅ 510
The N variable represents the prescale factor (1, 8, 32, 64, 128, 256, or 1024).
The extreme values for the OCR2A Register represent special cases when generating a PWM
waveform output in the phase correct PWM mode. If the OCR2A is set equal to BOTTOM, the
output will be continuously low and if set equal to MAX the output will be continuously high for
non-inverted PWM mode. For inverted PWM the output will have the opposite logic values.
At the very start of period 2 in Figure 15-7 OCnx has a transition from high to low even though
there is no Compare Match. The point of this transition is to guarantee symmetry around BOT-
TOM. There are two cases that give a transition without Compare Match.
• OCR2A changes its value from MAX, like in Figure 15-7. When the OCR2A value is MAX the
OCn pin value is the same as the result of a down-counting compare match. To ensure
symmetry around BOTTOM the OCn value at MAX must correspond to the result of an up-
counting Compare Match.
• The timer starts counting from a value higher than the one in OCR2A, and for that reason
misses the Compare Match and hence the OCn change that would have happened on the
way up.
clkI/O
clkTn
(clkI/O /1)
TOVn
160 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Figure 15-9 shows the same timing data, but with the prescaler enabled.
clkI/O
clkTn
(clkI/O /8)
TOVn
Figure 15-10 shows the setting of OCF2A in all modes except CTC mode.
Figure 15-10. Timer/Counter Timing Diagram, Setting of OCF2A, with Prescaler (fclk_I/O/8)
clkI/O
clkTn
(clkI/O /8)
OCFnx
Figure 15-11 shows the setting of OCF2A and the clearing of TCNT2 in CTC mode.
161
7593D–AVR–07/06
Figure 15-11. Timer/Counter Timing Diagram, Clear Timer on Compare Match mode, with Pres-
caler (fclk_I/O/8)
clkI/O
clkTn
(clkI/O /8)
TCNTn
TOP - 1 TOP BOTTOM BOTTOM + 1
(CTC)
OCRnx TOP
OCFnx
162 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Table 15-2 shows the COM2A1:0 bit functionality when the WGM21:0 bits are set to fast PWM
mode.
Note: 1. A special case occurs when OCR2A equals TOP and COM2A1 is set. In this case, the Com-
pare Match is ignored, but the set or clear is done at TOP. See “Fast PWM Mode” on page 157
for more details.
Table 15-3 shows the COM2A1:0 bit functionality when the WGM22:0 bits are set to phase cor-
rect PWM mode.
Note: 1. A special case occurs when OCR2A equals TOP and COM2A1 is set. In this case, the Com-
pare Match is ignored, but the set or clear is done at TOP. See “Phase Correct PWM Mode” on
page 159 for more details.
163
7593D–AVR–07/06
Table 15-5 shows the COM2B1:0 bit functionality when the WGM22:0 bits are set to fast PWM
mode.
Note: 1. A special case occurs when OCR2B equals TOP and COM2B1 is set. In this case, the Com-
pare Match is ignored, but the set or clear is done at TOP. See “Fast PWM Mode” on page 157
for more details.
Table 15-6 shows the COM2B1:0 bit functionality when the WGM22:0 bits are set to phase cor-
rect PWM mode.
Note: 1. A special case occurs when OCR2B equals TOP and COM2B1 is set. In this case, the Com-
pare Match is ignored, but the set or clear is done at TOP. See “Phase Correct PWM Mode” on
page 159 for more details.
164 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Table 15-7. Waveform Generation Mode Bit Description
Timer/Counter
Mode of Update of TOV Flag
Mode WGM2 WGM1 WGM0 Operation TOP OCRx at Set on(1)(2)
3 0 1 1 Fast PWM 0xFF TOP MAX
4 1 0 0 Reserved – – –
PWM, Phase
5 1 0 1 OCRA TOP BOTTOM
Correct
6 1 1 0 Reserved – – –
7 1 1 1 Fast PWM OCRA TOP TOP
165
7593D–AVR–07/06
• Bit 3 – WGM22: Waveform Generation Mode
See the description in the “Timer/Counter Control Register A – TCCR2A” on page 162.
If external pin modes are used for the Timer/Counter0, transitions on the T0 pin will clock the
counter even if the pin is configured as an output. This feature allows software control of the
counting.
The Timer/Counter Register gives direct access, both for read and write operations, to the
Timer/Counter unit 8-bit counter. Writing to the TCNT2 Register blocks (removes) the Compare
Match on the following timer clock. Modifying the counter (TCNT2) while the counter is running,
introduces a risk of missing a Compare Match between TCNT2 and the OCR2x Registers.
The Output Compare Register A contains an 8-bit value that is continuously compared with the
counter value (TCNT2). A match can be used to generate an Output Compare interrupt, or to
generate a waveform output on the OC2A pin.
166 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
The Output Compare Register B contains an 8-bit value that is continuously compared with the
counter value (TCNT2). A match can be used to generate an Output Compare interrupt, or to
generate a waveform output on the OC2B pin.
167
7593D–AVR–07/06
If a write is performed to any of the five Timer/Counter2 Registers while its update busy flag is
set, the updated value might get corrupted and cause an unintentional interrupt to occur.
The mechanisms for reading TCNT2, OCR2A, OCR2B, TCCR2A and TCCR2B are different.
When reading TCNT2, the actual timer value is read. When reading OCR2A, OCR2B, TCCR2A
and TCCR2B the value in the temporary storage register is read.
168 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
wake-up from Power-down or Standby mode, the user should be aware of the fact that this
Oscillator might take as long as one second to stabilize. The user is advised to wait for at
least one second before using Timer/Counter2 after power-up or wake-up from Power-down
or Standby mode. The contents of all Timer/Counter2 Registers must be considered lost after
a wake-up from Power-down or Standby mode due to unstable clock signal upon start-up, no
matter whether the Oscillator is in use or a clock signal is applied to the TOSC1 pin.
• Description of wake up from Power-save or ADC Noise Reduction mode when the timer is
clocked asynchronously: When the interrupt condition is met, the wake up process is started
on the following cycle of the timer clock, that is, the timer is always advanced by at least one
before the processor can read the counter value. After wake-up, the MCU is halted for four
cycles, it executes the interrupt routine, and resumes execution from the instruction following
SLEEP.
• Reading of the TCNT2 Register shortly after wake-up from Power-save may give an incorrect
result. Since TCNT2 is clocked on the asynchronous TOSC clock, reading TCNT2 must be
done through a register synchronized to the internal I/O clock domain. Synchronization takes
place for every rising TOSC1 edge. When waking up from Power-save mode, and the I/O
clock (clkI/O) again becomes active, TCNT2 will read as the previous value (before entering
sleep) until the next rising TOSC1 edge. The phase of the TOSC clock after waking up from
Power-save mode is essentially unpredictable, as it depends on the wake-up time. The
recommended procedure for reading TCNT2 is thus as follows:
a. Write any value to either of the registers OCR2x or TCCR2x.
b. Wait for the corresponding Update Busy Flag to be cleared.
c. Read TCNT2.
• During asynchronous operation, the synchronization of the Interrupt Flags for the
asynchronous timer takes 3 processor cycles plus one timer cycle. The timer is therefore
advanced by at least one before the processor can read the timer value causing the setting of
the Interrupt Flag. The Output Compare pin is changed on the timer clock and is not
synchronized to the processor clock.
169
7593D–AVR–07/06
When the TOIE2 bit is written to one and the I-bit in the Status Register is set (one), the
Timer/Counter2 Overflow interrupt is enabled. The corresponding interrupt is executed if an
overflow in Timer/Counter2 occurs, i.e., when the TOV2 bit is set in the Timer/Counter2 Interrupt
Flag Register – TIFR2.
170 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
15.10 Timer/Counter Prescaler
clkI/O clkT2S
10-BIT T/C PRESCALER
Clear
TOSC1
clkT2S/8
clkT2S/32
clkT2S/64
clkT2S/128
clkT2S/256
clkT2S/1024
AS2
PSRASY 0
CS20
CS21
CS22
The clock source for Timer/Counter2 is named clkT2S. clkT2S is by default connected to the main
system I/O clock clk IO. By setting the AS2 bit in ASSR, Timer/Counter2 is asynchronously
clocked from the TOSC1 pin. This enables use of Timer/Counter2 as a Real Time Counter
(RTC). When AS2 is set, pins TOSC1 and TOSC2 are disconnected from Port C. A crystal can
then be connected between the TOSC1 and TOSC2 pins to serve as an independent clock
source for Timer/Counter2. The Oscillator is optimized for use with a 32.768 kHz crystal. Apply-
ing an external clock source to TOSC1 is not recommended.
For Timer/Counter2, the possible prescaled selections are: clk T2S /8, clk T2S /32, clk T2S /64,
clkT2S/128, clkT2S/256, and clkT2S/1024. Additionally, clkT2S as well as 0 (stop) may be selected.
Setting the PSRASY bit in GTCCR resets the prescaler. This allows the user to operate with a
predictable prescaler.
171
7593D–AVR–07/06
16. Output Compare Modulator (OCM1C0A)
16.1 Overview
The Output Compare Modulator (OCM) allows generation of waveforms modulated with a carrier
frequency. The modulator uses the outputs from the Output Compare Unit C of the 16-bit
Timer/Counter1 and the Output Compare Unit of the 8-bit Timer/Counter0. For more details
about these Timer/Counters see “Timer/Counter0, Timer/Counter1, and Timer/Counter3 Pres-
calers” on page 100 and “8-bit Timer/Counter2 with PWM and Asynchronous Operation” on
page 151.
Timer/Counter 1 OC1C
Pin
OC1C /
Timer/Counter 0 OC0A OC0A / PB7
When the modulator is enabled, the two output compare channels are modulated together as
shown in the block diagram (Figure 16-1).
16.2 Description
The Output Compare unit 1C and Output Compare unit 2 shares the PB7 port pin for output. The
outputs of the Output Compare units (OC1C and OC0A) overrides the normal PORTB7 Register
when one of them is enabled (i.e., when COMnx1:0 is not equal to zero). When both OC1C and
OC0A are enabled at the same time, the modulator is automatically enabled.
The functional equivalent schematic of the modulator is shown on Figure 16-2. The schematic
includes part of the Timer/Counter units and the port B pin 7 output driver circuit.
COM1C1 Modulator
COM1C0
0
1
( From Waveform Generator ) D Q
1
OC1C
Pin
0
OC1C /
( From Waveform Generator ) D Q OC0A/ PB7
OC0A
D Q D Q
PORTB7 DDRB7
DATABUS
172 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
When the modulator is enabled the type of modulation (logical AND or OR) can be selected by
the PORTB7 Register. Note that the DDRB7 controls the direction of the port independent of the
COMnx1:0 bit setting.
clk I/O
OC1C
(FPWM Mode)
OC0A
(CTC Mode)
PB7
(PORTB7 = 0)
PB7
(PORTB7 = 1)
1 2 3
(Period)
In this example, Timer/Counter2 provides the carrier, while the modulating signal is generated
by the Output Compare unit C of the Timer/Counter1.
The resolution of the PWM signal (OC1C) is reduced by the modulation. The reduction factor is
equal to the number of system clock cycles of one period of the carrier (OC0A). In this example
the resolution is reduced by a factor of two. The reason for the reduction is illustrated in Figure
16-3 at the second and third period of the PB7 output when PORTB7 equals zero. The period 2
high time is one cycle longer than the period 3 high time, but the result on the PB7 output is
equal in both periods.
173
7593D–AVR–07/06
17. Serial Peripheral Interface – SPI
The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) allows high-speed synchronous data transfer between the
AT90USB64/128 and peripheral devices or between several AVR devices. The
AT90USB64/128 SPI includes the following features:
• Full-duplex, Three-wire Synchronous Data Transfer
• Master or Slave Operation
• LSB First or MSB First Data Transfer
• Seven Programmable Bit Rates
• End of Transmission Interrupt Flag
• Write Collision Flag Protection
• Wake-up from Idle Mode
• Double Speed (CK/2) Master SPI Mode
USART can also be used in Master SPI mode, see “USART in SPI Mode” on page 208.
The Power Reduction SPI bit, PRSPI, in “Power Reduction Register 0 - PRR0” on page 56 on
page 50 must be written to zero to enable SPI module.
DIVIDER
/2/4/8/16/32/64/128
SPI2X
SPI2X
Note: 1. Refer to Figure 1-1 on page 3, and Table 10-6 on page 82 for SPI pin placement.
The interconnection between Master and Slave CPUs with SPI is shown in Figure 17-2. The sys-
tem consists of two shift Registers, and a Master clock generator. The SPI Master initiates the
communication cycle when pulling low the Slave Select SS pin of the desired Slave. Master and
174 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Slave prepare the data to be sent in their respective shift Registers, and the Master generates
the required clock pulses on the SCK line to interchange data. Data is always shifted from Mas-
ter to Slave on the Master Out – Slave In, MOSI, line, and from Slave to Master on the Master In
– Slave Out, MISO, line. After each data packet, the Master will synchronize the Slave by pulling
high the Slave Select, SS, line.
When configured as a Master, the SPI interface has no automatic control of the SS line. This
must be handled by user software before communication can start. When this is done, writing a
byte to the SPI Data Register starts the SPI clock generator, and the hardware shifts the eight
bits into the Slave. After shifting one byte, the SPI clock generator stops, setting the end of
Transmission Flag (SPIF). If the SPI Interrupt Enable bit (SPIE) in the SPCR Register is set, an
interrupt is requested. The Master may continue to shift the next byte by writing it into SPDR, or
signal the end of packet by pulling high the Slave Select, SS line. The last incoming byte will be
kept in the Buffer Register for later use.
When configured as a Slave, the SPI interface will remain sleeping with MISO tri-stated as long
as the SS pin is driven high. In this state, software may update the contents of the SPI Data
Register, SPDR, but the data will not be shifted out by incoming clock pulses on the SCK pin
until the SS pin is driven low. As one byte has been completely shifted, the end of Transmission
Flag, SPIF is set. If the SPI Interrupt Enable bit, SPIE, in the SPCR Register is set, an interrupt
is requested. The Slave may continue to place new data to be sent into SPDR before reading
the incoming data. The last incoming byte will be kept in the Buffer Register for later use.
SHIFT
ENABLE
The system is single buffered in the transmit direction and double buffered in the receive direc-
tion. This means that bytes to be transmitted cannot be written to the SPI Data Register before
the entire shift cycle is completed. When receiving data, however, a received character must be
read from the SPI Data Register before the next character has been completely shifted in. Oth-
erwise, the first byte is lost.
In SPI Slave mode, the control logic will sample the incoming signal of the SCK pin. To ensure
correct sampling of the clock signal, the frequency of the SPI clock should never exceed fosc/4.
175
7593D–AVR–07/06
When the SPI is enabled, the data direction of the MOSI, MISO, SCK, and SS pins is overridden
according to Table 17-1. For more details on automatic port overrides, refer to “Alternate Port
Functions” on page 79.
Note: 1. See “Alternate Functions of Port B” on page 82 for a detailed description of how to define the
direction of the user defined SPI pins.
The following code examples show how to initialize the SPI as a Master and how to perform a
simple transmission. DDR_SPI in the examples must be replaced by the actual Data Direction
Register controlling the SPI pins. DD_MOSI, DD_MISO and DD_SCK must be replaced by the
actual data direction bits for these pins. E.g. if MOSI is placed on pin PB5, replace DD_MOSI
with DDB5 and DDR_SPI with DDRB.
176 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
SPI_MasterTransmit:
; Start transmission of data (r16)
out SPDR,r16
Wait_Transmit:
; Wait for transmission complete
sbis SPSR,SPIF
rjmp Wait_Transmit
ret
C Code Example(1)
void SPI_MasterInit(void)
{
/* Set MOSI and SCK output, all others input */
DDR_SPI = (1<<DD_MOSI)|(1<<DD_SCK);
/* Enable SPI, Master, set clock rate fck/16 */
SPCR = (1<<SPE)|(1<<MSTR)|(1<<SPR0);
}
177
7593D–AVR–07/06
The following code examples show how to initialize the SPI as a Slave and how to perform a
simple reception.
SPI_SlaveReceive:
; Wait for reception complete
sbis SPSR,SPIF
rjmp SPI_SlaveReceive
; Read received data and return
in r16,SPDR
ret
C Code Example(1)
void SPI_SlaveInit(void)
{
/* Set MISO output, all others input */
DDR_SPI = (1<<DD_MISO);
/* Enable SPI */
SPCR = (1<<SPE);
}
char SPI_SlaveReceive(void)
{
/* Wait for reception complete */
while(!(SPSR & (1<<SPIF)))
;
/* Return Data Register */
return SPDR;
}
178 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
means that it will not receive incoming data. Note that the SPI logic will be reset once the SS pin
is driven high.
The SS pin is useful for packet/byte synchronization to keep the slave bit counter synchronous
with the master clock generator. When the SS pin is driven high, the SPI slave will immediately
reset the send and receive logic, and drop any partially received data in the Shift Register.
179
7593D–AVR–07/06
and SPIF in SPSR will become set. The user will then have to set MSTR to re-enable SPI Mas-
ter mode.
180 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
When a serial transfer is complete, the SPIF Flag is set. An interrupt is generated if SPIE in
SPCR is set and global interrupts are enabled. If SS is an input and is driven low when the SPI is
in Master mode, this will also set the SPIF Flag. SPIF is cleared by hardware when executing the
corresponding interrupt handling vector. Alternatively, the SPIF bit is cleared by first reading the
SPI Status Register with SPIF set, then accessing the SPI Data Register (SPDR).
The SPI Data Register is a read/write register used for data transfer between the Register File
and the SPI Shift Register. Writing to the register initiates data transmission. Reading the regis-
ter causes the Shift Register Receive buffer to be read.
181
7593D–AVR–07/06
Table 17-5. CPOL Functionality
Leading Edge Trailing eDge SPI Mode
CPOL=0, CPHA=0 Sample (Rising) Setup (Falling) 0
CPOL=0, CPHA=1 Setup (Rising) Sample (Falling) 1
CPOL=1, CPHA=0 Sample (Falling) Setup (Rising) 2
CPOL=1, CPHA=1 Setup (Falling) Sample (Rising) 3
SCK (CPOL = 0)
mode 0
SCK (CPOL = 1)
mode 2
SAMPLE I
MOSI/MISO
CHANGE 0
MOSI PIN
CHANGE 0
MISO PIN
SS
MSB first (DORD = 0) MSB Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 LSB
LSB first (DORD = 1) LSB Bit 1 Bit 2 Bit 3 Bit 4 Bit 5 Bit 6 MSB
SCK (CPOL = 0)
mode 1
SCK (CPOL = 1)
mode 3
SAMPLE I
MOSI/MISO
CHANGE 0
MOSI PIN
CHANGE 0
MISO PIN
SS
MSB first (DORD = 0) MSB Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 LSB
LSB first (DORD = 1) LSB Bit 1 Bit 2 Bit 3 Bit 4 Bit 5 Bit 6 MSB
182 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
18. USART
The Universal Synchronous and Asynchronous serial Receiver and Transmitter (USART) is a
highly flexible serial communication device. The main features are:
• Full Duplex Operation (Independent Serial Receive and Transmit Registers)
• Asynchronous or Synchronous Operation
• Master or Slave Clocked Synchronous Operation
• High Resolution Baud Rate Generator
• Supports Serial Frames with 5, 6, 7, 8, or 9 Data Bits and 1 or 2 Stop Bits
• Odd or Even Parity Generation and Parity Check Supported by Hardware
• Data OverRun Detection
• Framing Error Detection
• Noise Filtering Includes False Start Bit Detection and Digital Low Pass Filter
• Three Separate Interrupts on TX Complete, TX Data Register Empty and RX Complete
• Multi-processor Communication Mode
• Double Speed Asynchronous Communication Mode
.
18.1 Overview
A simplified block diagram of the USART Transmitter is shown in Figure 18-1 on page 184. CPU
accessible I/O Registers and I/O pins are shown in bold.
183
7593D–AVR–07/06
Figure 18-1. USART Block Diagram(1)
Clock Generator
UBRR[H:L]
OSC
Transmitter
TX
UDR (Transmit)
CONTROL
PARITY
GENERATOR
DATA BUS
PIN
TRANSMIT SHIFT REGISTER TxD
CONTROL
Receiver
CLOCK RX
RECOVERY CONTROL
DATA PIN
RECEIVE SHIFT REGISTER RxD
RECOVERY CONTROL
PARITY
UDR (Receive)
CHECKER
Note: 1. See Figure 1-1 on page 3, Table 10-12 on page 86 and for USART pin placement.
The dashed boxes in the block diagram separate the three main parts of the USART (listed from
the top): Clock Generator, Transmitter and Receiver. Control Registers are shared by all units.
The Clock Generation logic consists of synchronization logic for external clock input used by
synchronous slave operation, and the baud rate generator. The XCKn (Transfer Clock) pin is
only used by synchronous transfer mode. The Transmitter consists of a single write buffer, a
serial Shift Register, Parity Generator and Control logic for handling different serial frame for-
mats. The write buffer allows a continuous transfer of data without any delay between frames.
The Receiver is the most complex part of the USART module due to its clock and data recovery
units. The recovery units are used for asynchronous data reception. In addition to the recovery
units, the Receiver includes a Parity Checker, Control logic, a Shift Register and a two level
receive buffer (UDRn). The Receiver supports the same frame formats as the Transmitter, and
can detect Frame Error, Data OverRun and Parity Errors.
184 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
for the XCKn pin (DDR_XCKn) controls whether the clock source is internal (Master mode) or
external (Slave mode). The XCKn pin is only active when using synchronous mode.
Figure 18-2 shows a block diagram of the clock generation logic.
Prescaling UBRR+1
/2 /4 /2
Down-Counter 0
1
0
OSC txclk
1
DDR_XCK
Sync Edge
xcki Register Detector 0
XCK UMSEL
xcko 1
Pin
DDR_XCK UCPOL 1
rxclk
0
Signal description:
txclk Transmitter clock (Internal Signal).
rxclk Receiver base clock (Internal Signal).
xcki Input from XCK pin (internal Signal). Used for synchronous slave
operation.
xcko Clock output to XCK pin (Internal Signal). Used for synchronous master
operation.
fOSC XTAL pin frequency (System Clock).
185
7593D–AVR–07/06
Table 18-1 contains equations for calculating the baud rate (in bits per second) and for calculat-
ing the UBRRn value for each mode of operation using an internally generated clock source.
f OSC
UBRRn = -------------------- – 1
8BAUD
f OSC
UBRRn = -------------------- – 1
2BAUD
Note: 1. The baud rate is defined to be the transfer rate in bit per second (bps)
BAUD Baud rate (in bits per second, bps)
fOSC System Oscillator clock frequency
UBRRn Contents of the UBRRHn and UBRRLn Registers, (0-4095)
Some examples of UBRRn values for some system clock frequencies are found in Table 18-9 on
page 205.
186 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
18.2.3 External Clock
External clocking is used by the synchronous slave modes of operation. The description in this
section refers to Figure 18-2 for details.
External clock input from the XCKn pin is sampled by a synchronization register to minimize the
chance of meta-stability. The output from the synchronization register must then pass through
an edge detector before it can be used by the Transmitter and Receiver. This process intro-
duces a two CPU clock period delay and therefore the maximum external XCKn clock frequency
is limited by the following equation:
f OSC
f XCK < -----------
4
Note that fosc depends on the stability of the system clock source. It is therefore recommended to
add some margin to avoid possible loss of data due to frequency variations.
UCPOL = 1 XCK
RxD / TxD
Sample
UCPOL = 0 XCK
RxD / TxD
Sample
The UCPOLn bit UCRSC selects which XCKn clock edge is used for data sampling and which is
used for data change. As Figure 18-3 shows, when UCPOLn is zero the data will be changed at
rising XCKn edge and sampled at falling XCKn edge. If UCPOLn is set, the data will be changed
at falling XCKn edge and sampled at rising XCKn edge.
187
7593D–AVR–07/06
A frame starts with the start bit followed by the least significant data bit. Then the next data bits,
up to a total of nine, are succeeding, ending with the most significant bit. If enabled, the parity bit
is inserted after the data bits, before the stop bits. When a complete frame is transmitted, it can
be directly followed by a new frame, or the communication line can be set to an idle (high) state.
Figure 18-4 illustrates the possible combinations of the frame formats. Bits inside brackets are
optional.
(IDLE) St 0 1 2 3 4 [5] [6] [7] [8] [P] Sp1 [Sp2] (St / IDLE)
P even = d n – 1 ⊕ … ⊕ d 3 ⊕ d 2 ⊕ d 1 ⊕ d 0 ⊕ 0
P odd = d n – 1 ⊕ … ⊕ d 3 ⊕ d 2 ⊕ d 1 ⊕ d 0 ⊕ 1
188 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
18.4 USART Initialization
The USART has to be initialized before any communication can take place. The initialization pro-
cess normally consists of setting the baud rate, setting frame format and enabling the
Transmitter or the Receiver depending on the usage. For interrupt driven USART operation, the
Global Interrupt Flag should be cleared (and interrupts globally disabled) when doing the
initialization.
Before doing a re-initialization with changed baud rate or frame format, be sure that there are no
ongoing transmissions during the period the registers are changed. The TXCn Flag can be used
to check that the Transmitter has completed all transfers, and the RXC Flag can be used to
check that there are no unread data in the receive buffer. Note that the TXCn Flag must be
cleared before each transmission (before UDRn is written) if it is used for this purpose.
The following simple USART initialization code examples show one assembly and one C func-
tion that are equal in functionality. The examples assume asynchronous operation using polling
(no interrupts enabled) and a fixed frame format. The baud rate is given as a function parameter.
For the assembly code, the baud rate parameter is assumed to be stored in the r17:r16
Registers.
189
7593D–AVR–07/06
18.5 Data Transmission – The USART Transmitter
The USART Transmitter is enabled by setting the Transmit Enable (TXEN) bit in the UCSRnB
Register. When the Transmitter is enabled, the normal port operation of the TxDn pin is overrid-
den by the USART and given the function as the Transmitter’s serial output. The baud rate,
mode of operation and frame format must be set up once before doing any transmissions. If syn-
chronous operation is used, the clock on the XCKn pin will be overridden and used as
transmission clock.
190 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
a transmit function that handles 9-bit characters. For the assembly code, the data to be sent is
assumed to be stored in registers R17:R16.
Notes: 1. These transmit functions are written to be general functions. They can be optimized if the con-
tents of the UCSRnB is static. For example, only the TXB8 bit of the UCSRnB Register is used
after initialization.
2. See “About Code Examples” on page 8.
The ninth bit can be used for indicating an address frame when using multi processor communi-
cation mode or for other protocol handling as for example synchronization.
191
7593D–AVR–07/06
UDRn in order to clear UDREn or disable the Data Register Empty interrupt, otherwise a new
interrupt will occur once the interrupt routine terminates.
The Transmit Complete (TXCn) Flag bit is set one when the entire frame in the Transmit Shift
Register has been shifted out and there are no new data currently present in the transmit buffer.
The TXCn Flag bit is automatically cleared when a transmit complete interrupt is executed, or it
can be cleared by writing a one to its bit location. The TXCn Flag is useful in half-duplex commu-
nication interfaces (like the RS-485 standard), where a transmitting application must enter
receive mode and free the communication bus immediately after completing the transmission.
When the Transmit Compete Interrupt Enable (TXCIEn) bit in UCSRnB is set, the USART
Transmit Complete Interrupt will be executed when the TXCn Flag becomes set (provided that
global interrupts are enabled). When the transmit complete interrupt is used, the interrupt han-
dling routine does not have to clear the TXCn Flag, this is done automatically when the interrupt
is executed.
192 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
bits of the data read from the UDRn will be masked to zero. The USART has to be initialized
before the function can be used.
193
7593D–AVR–07/06
Assembly Code Example(1)
USART_Receive:
; Wait for data to be received
sbis UCSRnA, RXCn
rjmp USART_Receive
; Get status and 9th bit, then data from buffer
in r18, UCSRnA
in r17, UCSRnB
in r16, UDRn
; If error, return -1
andi r18,(1<<FEn)|(1<<DORn)|(1<<UPEn)
breq USART_ReceiveNoError
ldi r17, HIGH(-1)
ldi r16, LOW(-1)
USART_ReceiveNoError:
; Filter the 9th bit, then return
lsr r17
andi r17, 0x01
ret
C Code Example(1)
unsigned int USART_Receive( void )
{
unsigned char status, resh, resl;
/* Wait for data to be received */
while ( !(UCSRnA & (1<<RXCn)) )
;
/* Get status and 9th bit, then data */
/* from buffer */
status = UCSRnA;
resh = UCSRnB;
resl = UDRn;
/* If error, return -1 */
if ( status & (1<<FEn)|(1<<DORn)|(1<<UPEn) )
return -1;
/* Filter the 9th bit, then return */
resh = (resh >> 1) & 0x01;
return ((resh << 8) | resl);
}
194 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
The Receive Complete (RXCn) Flag indicates if there are unread data present in the receive
buffer. This flag is one when unread data exist in the receive buffer, and zero when the receive
buffer is empty (i.e., does not contain any unread data). If the Receiver is disabled (RXENn = 0),
the receive buffer will be flushed and consequently the RXCn bit will become zero.
When the Receive Complete Interrupt Enable (RXCIEn) in UCSRnB is set, the USART Receive
Complete interrupt will be executed as long as the RXCn Flag is set (provided that global inter-
rupts are enabled). When interrupt-driven data reception is used, the receive complete routine
must read the received data from UDRn in order to clear the RXCn Flag, otherwise a new inter-
rupt will occur once the interrupt routine terminates.
195
7593D–AVR–07/06
The UPEn bit is set if the next character that can be read from the receive buffer had a Parity
Error when received and the Parity Checking was enabled at that point (UPMn1 = 1). This bit is
valid until the receive buffer (UDRn) is read.
196 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Figure 18-5. Start Bit Sampling
Sample
(U2X = 0) 0 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 1 2 3
Sample
(U2X = 1) 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 2
When the clock recovery logic detects a high (idle) to low (start) transition on the RxDn line, the
start bit detection sequence is initiated. Let sample 1 denote the first zero-sample as shown in
the figure. The clock recovery logic then uses samples 8, 9, and 10 for Normal mode, and sam-
ples 4, 5, and 6 for Double Speed mode (indicated with sample numbers inside boxes on the
figure), to decide if a valid start bit is received. If two or more of these three samples have logical
high levels (the majority wins), the start bit is rejected as a noise spike and the Receiver starts
looking for the next high to low-transition. If however, a valid start bit is detected, the clock recov-
ery logic is synchronized and the data recovery can begin. The synchronization process is
repeated for each start bit.
RxD BIT n
Sample
(U2X = 0) 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 1
Sample
(U2X = 1) 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1
The decision of the logic level of the received bit is taken by doing a majority voting of the logic
value to the three samples in the center of the received bit. The center samples are emphasized
on the figure by having the sample number inside boxes. The majority voting process is done as
follows: If two or all three samples have high levels, the received bit is registered to be a logic 1.
If two or all three samples have low levels, the received bit is registered to be a logic 0. This
majority voting process acts as a low pass filter for the incoming signal on the RxDn pin. The
recovery process is then repeated until a complete frame is received. Including the first stop bit.
Note that the Receiver only uses the first stop bit of a frame.
Figure 18-7 shows the sampling of the stop bit and the earliest possible beginning of the start bit
of the next frame.
197
7593D–AVR–07/06
Figure 18-7. Stop Bit Sampling and Next Start Bit Sampling
Sample
(U2X = 0) 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 0/1 0/1 0/1
Sample
(U2X = 1) 1 2 3 4 5 6 0/1
The same majority voting is done to the stop bit as done for the other bits in the frame. If the stop
bit is registered to have a logic 0 value, the Frame Error (FEn) Flag will be set.
A new high to low transition indicating the start bit of a new frame can come right after the last of
the bits used for majority voting. For Normal Speed mode, the first low level sample can be at
point marked (A) in Figure 18-7. For Double Speed mode the first low level must be delayed to
(B). (C) marks a stop bit of full length. The early start bit detection influences the operational
range of the Receiver.
Table 1.
( D + 1 )S ( D + 2 )S
R slow = ------------------------------------------- R fast = -----------------------------------
S – 1 + D ⋅ S + SF ( D + 1 )S + S M
198 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Table 18-2. Recommended Maximum Receiver Baud Rate Error for Normal Speed Mode
(U2Xn = 0)
D Recommended Max
# (Data+Parity Bit) Rslow (%) Rfast (%) Max Total Error (%) Receiver Error (%)
5 93.20 106.67 +6.67/-6.8 ± 3.0
6 94.12 105.79 +5.79/-5.88 ± 2.5
7 94.81 105.11 +5.11/-5.19 ± 2.0
8 95.36 104.58 +4.58/-4.54 ± 2.0
9 95.81 104.14 +4.14/-4.19 ± 1.5
10 96.17 103.78 +3.78/-3.83 ± 1.5
Table 18-3. Recommended Maximum Receiver Baud Rate Error for Double Speed Mode
(U2Xn = 1)
D Recommended Max
# (Data+Parity Bit) Rslow (%) Rfast (%) Max Total Error (%) Receiver Error (%)
5 94.12 105.66 +5.66/-5.88 ± 2.5
6 94.92 104.92 +4.92/-5.08 ± 2.0
7 95.52 104,35 +4.35/-4.48 ± 1.5
8 96.00 103.90 +3.90/-4.00 ± 1.5
9 96.39 103.53 +3.53/-3.61 ± 1.5
10 96.70 103.23 +3.23/-3.30 ± 1.0
The recommendations of the maximum receiver baud rate error was made under the assump-
tion that the Receiver and Transmitter equally divides the maximum total error.
There are two possible sources for the receivers baud rate error. The Receiver’s system clock
(XTAL) will always have some minor instability over the supply voltage range and the tempera-
ture range. When using a crystal to generate the system clock, this is rarely a problem, but for a
resonator the system clock may differ more than 2% depending of the resonators tolerance. The
second source for the error is more controllable. The baud rate generator can not always do an
exact division of the system frequency to get the baud rate wanted. In this case an UBRR value
that gives an acceptable low error can be used if possible.
199
7593D–AVR–07/06
nine data bits, then the ninth bit (RXB8n) is used for identifying address and data frames. When
the frame type bit (the first stop or the ninth bit) is one, the frame contains an address. When the
frame type bit is zero the frame is a data frame.
The Multi-processor Communication mode enables several slave MCUs to receive data from a
master MCU. This is done by first decoding an address frame to find out which MCU has been
addressed. If a particular slave MCU has been addressed, it will receive the following data
frames as normal, while the other slave MCUs will ignore the received frames until another
address frame is received.
The USART Transmit Data Buffer Register and USART Receive Data Buffer Registers share the
same I/O address referred to as USART Data Register or UDRn. The Transmit Data Buffer Reg-
200 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
ister (TXB) will be the destination for data written to the UDRn Register location. Reading the
UDRn Register location will return the contents of the Receive Data Buffer Register (RXB).
For 5-, 6-, or 7-bit characters the upper unused bits will be ignored by the Transmitter and set to
zero by the Receiver.
The transmit buffer can only be written when the UDREn Flag in the UCSRnA Register is set.
Data written to UDRn when the UDREn Flag is not set, will be ignored by the USART Transmit-
ter. When data is written to the transmit buffer, and the Transmitter is enabled, the Transmitter
will load the data into the Transmit Shift Register when the Shift Register is empty. Then the
data will be serially transmitted on the TxDn pin.
The receive buffer consists of a two level FIFO. The FIFO will change its state whenever the
receive buffer is accessed. Due to this behavior of the receive buffer, do not use Read-Modify-
Write instructions (SBI and CBI) on this location. Be careful when using bit test instructions
(SBIC and SBIS), since these also will change the state of the FIFO.
201
7593D–AVR–07/06
new start bit is detected. This bit is valid until the receive buffer (UDRn) is read. Always set this
bit to zero when writing to UCSRnA.
202 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
zero) will not become effective until ongoing and pending transmissions are completed, i.e.,
when the Transmit Shift Register and Transmit Buffer Register do not contain data to be trans-
mitted. When disabled, the Transmitter will no longer override the TxDn port.
Note: 1. See “USART in SPI Mode” on page 208 for full description of the Master SPI Mode (MSPIM)
operation
203
7593D–AVR–07/06
• Bit 3 – USBSn: Stop Bit Select
This bit selects the number of stop bits to be inserted by the Transmitter. The Receiver ignores
this setting.
204 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
These bits are reserved for future use. For compatibility with future devices, these bit must be
written to zero when UBRRH is written.
Table 18-9. Examples of UBRRn Settings for Commonly Used Oscillator Frequencies
fosc = 1.0000 MHz fosc = 1.8432 MHz fosc = 2.0000 MHz
Baud
U2Xn = 0 U2Xn = 1 U2Xn = 0 U2Xn = 1 U2Xn = 0 U2Xn = 1
Rate
(bps) UBRR Error UBRR Error UBRR Error UBRR Error UBRR Error UBRR Error
2400 25 0.2% 51 0.2% 47 0.0% 95 0.0% 51 0.2% 103 0.2%
4800 12 0.2% 25 0.2% 23 0.0% 47 0.0% 25 0.2% 51 0.2%
9600 6 -7.0% 12 0.2% 11 0.0% 23 0.0% 12 0.2% 25 0.2%
14.4k 3 8.5% 8 -3.5% 7 0.0% 15 0.0% 8 -3.5% 16 2.1%
19.2k 2 8.5% 6 -7.0% 5 0.0% 11 0.0% 6 -7.0% 12 0.2%
28.8k 1 8.5% 3 8.5% 3 0.0% 7 0.0% 3 8.5% 8 -3.5%
38.4k 1 -18.6% 2 8.5% 2 0.0% 5 0.0% 2 8.5% 6 -7.0%
57.6k 0 8.5% 1 8.5% 1 0.0% 3 0.0% 1 8.5% 3 8.5%
76.8k – – 1 -18.6% 1 -25.0% 2 0.0% 1 -18.6% 2 8.5%
115.2k – – 0 8.5% 0 0.0% 1 0.0% 0 8.5% 1 8.5%
230.4k – – – – – – 0 0.0% – – – –
250k – – – – – – – – – – 0 0.0%
(1)
Max. 62.5 kbps 125 kbps 115.2 kbps 230.4 kbps 125 kbps 250 kbps
1. UBRR = 0, Error = 0.0%
205
7593D–AVR–07/06
Table 18-10. Examples of UBRRn Settings for Commonly Used Oscillator Frequencies (Continued)
fosc = 3.6864 MHz fosc = 4.0000 MHz fosc = 7.3728 MHz
Baud
U2Xn = 0 U2Xn = 1 U2Xn = 0 U2Xn = 1 U2Xn = 0 U2Xn = 1
Rate
(bps) UBRR Error UBRR Error UBRR Error UBRR Error UBRR Error UBRR Error
2400 95 0.0% 191 0.0% 103 0.2% 207 0.2% 191 0.0% 383 0.0%
4800 47 0.0% 95 0.0% 51 0.2% 103 0.2% 95 0.0% 191 0.0%
9600 23 0.0% 47 0.0% 25 0.2% 51 0.2% 47 0.0% 95 0.0%
14.4k 15 0.0% 31 0.0% 16 2.1% 34 -0.8% 31 0.0% 63 0.0%
19.2k 11 0.0% 23 0.0% 12 0.2% 25 0.2% 23 0.0% 47 0.0%
28.8k 7 0.0% 15 0.0% 8 -3.5% 16 2.1% 15 0.0% 31 0.0%
38.4k 5 0.0% 11 0.0% 6 -7.0% 12 0.2% 11 0.0% 23 0.0%
57.6k 3 0.0% 7 0.0% 3 8.5% 8 -3.5% 7 0.0% 15 0.0%
76.8k 2 0.0% 5 0.0% 2 8.5% 6 -7.0% 5 0.0% 11 0.0%
115.2k 1 0.0% 3 0.0% 1 8.5% 3 8.5% 3 0.0% 7 0.0%
230.4k 0 0.0% 1 0.0% 0 8.5% 1 8.5% 1 0.0% 3 0.0%
250k 0 -7.8% 1 -7.8% 0 0.0% 1 0.0% 1 -7.8% 3 -7.8%
0.5M – – 0 -7.8% – – 0 0.0% 0 -7.8% 1 -7.8%
1M – – – – – – – – – – 0 -7.8%
(1)
Max. 230.4 kbps 460.8 kbps 250 kbps 0.5 Mbps 460.8 kbps 921.6 kbps
1. UBRR = 0, Error = 0.0%
206 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Table 18-11. Examples of UBRRn Settings for Commonly Used Oscillator Frequencies (Continued)
fosc = 8.0000 MHz fosc = 11.0592 MHz fosc = 14.7456 MHz
Baud
U2Xn = 0 U2Xn = 1 U2Xn = 0 U2Xn = 1 U2Xn = 0 U2Xn = 1
Rate
(bps) UBRR Error UBRR Error UBRR Error UBRR Error UBRR Error UBRR Error
2400 207 0.2% 416 -0.1% 287 0.0% 575 0.0% 383 0.0% 767 0.0%
4800 103 0.2% 207 0.2% 143 0.0% 287 0.0% 191 0.0% 383 0.0%
9600 51 0.2% 103 0.2% 71 0.0% 143 0.0% 95 0.0% 191 0.0%
14.4k 34 -0.8% 68 0.6% 47 0.0% 95 0.0% 63 0.0% 127 0.0%
19.2k 25 0.2% 51 0.2% 35 0.0% 71 0.0% 47 0.0% 95 0.0%
28.8k 16 2.1% 34 -0.8% 23 0.0% 47 0.0% 31 0.0% 63 0.0%
38.4k 12 0.2% 25 0.2% 17 0.0% 35 0.0% 23 0.0% 47 0.0%
57.6k 8 -3.5% 16 2.1% 11 0.0% 23 0.0% 15 0.0% 31 0.0%
76.8k 6 -7.0% 12 0.2% 8 0.0% 17 0.0% 11 0.0% 23 0.0%
115.2k 3 8.5% 8 -3.5% 5 0.0% 11 0.0% 7 0.0% 15 0.0%
230.4k 1 8.5% 3 8.5% 2 0.0% 5 0.0% 3 0.0% 7 0.0%
250k 1 0.0% 3 0.0% 2 -7.8% 5 -7.8% 3 -7.8% 6 5.3%
0.5M 0 0.0% 1 0.0% – – 2 -7.8% 1 -7.8% 3 -7.8%
1M – – 0 0.0% – – – – 0 -7.8% 1 -7.8%
(1)
Max. 0.5 Mbps 1 Mbps 691.2 kbps 1.3824 Mbps 921.6 kbps 1.8432 Mbps
1. UBRR = 0, Error = 0.0%
207
7593D–AVR–07/06
Table 18-12. Examples of UBRRn Settings for Commonly Used Oscillator Frequencies (Continued)
fosc = 16.0000 MHz fosc = 18.4320 MHz fosc = 20.0000 MHz
Baud
U2Xn = 0 U2Xn = 1 U2Xn = 0 U2Xn = 1 U2Xn = 0 U2Xn = 1
Rate
(bps) UBRR Error UBRR Error UBRR Error UBRR Error UBRR Error UBRR Error
2400 416 -0.1% 832 0.0% 479 0.0% 959 0.0% 520 0.0% 1041 0.0%
4800 207 0.2% 416 -0.1% 239 0.0% 479 0.0% 259 0.2% 520 0.0%
9600 103 0.2% 207 0.2% 119 0.0% 239 0.0% 129 0.2% 259 0.2%
14.4k 68 0.6% 138 -0.1% 79 0.0% 159 0.0% 86 -0.2% 173 -0.2%
19.2k 51 0.2% 103 0.2% 59 0.0% 119 0.0% 64 0.2% 129 0.2%
28.8k 34 -0.8% 68 0.6% 39 0.0% 79 0.0% 42 0.9% 86 -0.2%
38.4k 25 0.2% 51 0.2% 29 0.0% 59 0.0% 32 -1.4% 64 0.2%
57.6k 16 2.1% 34 -0.8% 19 0.0% 39 0.0% 21 -1.4% 42 0.9%
76.8k 12 0.2% 25 0.2% 14 0.0% 29 0.0% 15 1.7% 32 -1.4%
115.2k 8 -3.5% 16 2.1% 9 0.0% 19 0.0% 10 -1.4% 21 -1.4%
230.4k 3 8.5% 8 -3.5% 4 0.0% 9 0.0% 4 8.5% 10 -1.4%
250k 3 0.0% 7 0.0% 4 -7.8% 8 2.4% 4 0.0% 9 0.0%
0.5M 1 0.0% 3 0.0% – – 4 -7.8% – – 4 0.0%
1M 0 0.0% 1 0.0% – – – – – – – –
(1)
Max. 1 Mbps 2 Mbps 1.152 Mbps 2.304 Mbps 1.25 Mbps 2.5 Mbps
1. UBRR = 0, Error = 0.0%
19.1 Overview
Setting both UMSELn1:0 bits to one enables the USART in MSPIM logic. In this mode of opera-
tion the SPI master control logic takes direct control over the USART resources. These
resources include the transmitter and receiver shift register and buffers, and the baud rate gen-
erator. The parity generator and checker, the data and clock recovery logic, and the RX and TX
208 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
control logic is disabled. The USART RX and TX control logic is replaced by a common SPI
transfer control logic. However, the pin control logic and interrupt generation logic is identical in
both modes of operation.
The I/O register locations are the same in both modes. However, some of the functionality of the
control registers changes when using MSPIM.
Note: 1. The baud rate is defined to be the transfer rate in bit per second (bps)
BAUD Baud rate (in bits per second, bps)
fOSC System Oscillator clock frequency
UBRRn Contents of the UBRRnH and UBRRnL Registers, (0-4095)
209
7593D–AVR–07/06
ality is summarized in Table 19-2. Note that changing the setting of any of these bits will corrupt
all ongoing communication for both the Receiver and Transmitter.
XCK XCK
XCK XCK
210 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
tion, the Global Interrupt Flag should be cleared (and thus interrupts globally disabled) when
doing the initialization.
Note: To ensure immediate initialization of the XCKn output the baud-rate register (UBRRn) must be
zero at the time the transmitter is enabled. Contrary to the normal mode USART operation the
UBRRn must then be written to the desired value after the transmitter is enabled, but before the
first transmission is started. Setting UBRRn to zero before enabling the transmitter is not neces-
sary if the initialization is done immediately after a reset since UBRRn is reset to zero.
Before doing a re-initialization with changed baud rate, data mode, or frame format, be sure that
there is no ongoing transmissions during the period the registers are changed. The TXCn Flag
can be used to check that the Transmitter has completed all transfers, and the RXCn Flag can
be used to check that there are no unread data in the receive buffer. Note that the TXCn Flag
must be cleared before each transmission (before UDRn is written) if it is used for this purpose.
The following simple USART initialization code examples show one assembly and one C func-
tion that are equal in functionality. The examples assume polling (no interrupts enabled). The
baud rate is given as a function parameter. For the assembly code, the baud rate parameter is
assumed to be stored in the r17:r16 registers.
211
7593D–AVR–07/06
Assembly Code Example(1)
USART_Init:
clr r18
out UBRRnH,r18
out UBRRnL,r18
; Setting the XCKn port pin as output, enables master mode.
sbi XCKn_DDR, XCKn
; Set MSPI mode of operation and SPI data mode 0.
ldi r18, (1<<UMSELn1)|(1<<UMSELn0)|(0<<UCPHAn)|(0<<UCPOLn)
out UCSRnC,r18
; Enable receiver and transmitter.
ldi r18, (1<<RXENn)|(1<<TXENn)
out UCSRnB,r18
; Set baud rate.
; IMPORTANT: The Baud Rate must be set after the transmitter is
enabled!
out UBRRnH, r17
out UBRRnL, r18
ret
C Code Example(1)
void USART_Init( unsigned int baud )
{
UBRRn = 0;
/* Setting the XCKn port pin as output, enables master mode. */
XCKn_DDR |= (1<<XCKn);
/* Set MSPI mode of operation and SPI data mode 0. */
UCSRnC = (1<<UMSELn1)|(1<<UMSELn0)|(0<<UCPHAn)|(0<<UCPOLn);
/* Enable receiver and transmitter. */
UCSRnB = (1<<RXENn)|(1<<TXENn);
/* Set baud rate. */
/* IMPORTANT: The Baud Rate must be set after the transmitter is
enabled */
UBRRn = baud;
}
212 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
After initialization the USART is ready for doing data transfers. A data transfer is initiated by writ-
ing to the UDRn I/O location. This is the case for both sending and receiving data since the
transmitter controls the transfer clock. The data written to UDRn is moved from the transmit
buffer to the shift register when the shift register is ready to send a new frame.
Note: To keep the input buffer in sync with the number of data bytes transmitted, the UDRn register must
be read once for each byte transmitted. The input buffer operation is identical to normal USART
mode, i.e. if an overflow occurs the character last received will be lost, not the first data in the
buffer. This means that if four bytes are transferred, byte 1 first, then byte 2, 3, and 4, and the
UDRn is not read before all transfers are completed, then byte 3 to be received will be lost, and
not byte 1.
The following code examples show a simple USART in MSPIM mode transfer function based on
polling of the Data Register Empty (UDREn) Flag and the Receive Complete (RXCn) Flag. The
USART has to be initialized before the function can be used. For the assembly code, the data to
be sent is assumed to be stored in Register R16 and the data received will be available in the
same register (R16) after the function returns.
The function simply waits for the transmit buffer to be empty by checking the UDREn Flag,
before loading it with new data to be transmitted. The function then waits for data to be present
in the receive buffer by checking the RXCn Flag, before reading the buffer and returning the
value..
213
7593D–AVR–07/06
Note: 1. See “About Code Examples” on page 8.
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
RXCn TXCn UDREn - - - - - UCSRnA
Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R R R R R
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 0
214 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
19.6.3 USART MSPIM Control and Status Register n B - UCSRnB
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
RXCIEn TXCIEn UDRIE RXENn TXENn - - - UCSRnB
Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R R R
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 0
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
UMSELn1 UMSELn0 - - - UDORDn UCPHAn UCPOLn UCSRnC
Read/Write R/W R/W R R R R/W R/W R/W
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 0
215
7593D–AVR–07/06
These bits select the mode of operation of the USART as shown in Table 19-3. See “USART
Control and Status Register n C – UCSRnC” on page 203 for full description of the normal
USART operation. The MSPIM is enabled when both UMSELn bits are set to one. The
UDORDn, UCPHAn, and UCPOLn can be set in the same write operation where the MSPIM is
enabled.
216 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
• The USART in MSPIM mode receiver includes an additional buffer level.
• The SPI WCOL (Write Collision) bit is not included in USART in MSPIM mode.
• The SPI double speed mode (SPI2X) bit is not included. However, the same effect is
achieved by setting UBRRn accordingly.
• Interrupt timing is not compatible.
• Pin control differs due to the master only operation of the USART in MSPIM mode.
A comparison of the USART in MSPIM mode and the SPI pins is shown in Table 19-4 on page
217.
217
7593D–AVR–07/06
20. 2-wire Serial Interface
20.1 Features
• Simple Yet Powerful and Flexible Communication Interface, only two Bus Lines Needed
• Both Master and Slave Operation Supported
• Device can Operate as Transmitter or Receiver
• 7-bit Address Space Allows up to 128 Different Slave Addresses
• Multi-master Arbitration Support
• Up to 400 kHz Data Transfer Speed
• Slew-rate Limited Output Drivers
• Noise Suppression Circuitry Rejects Spikes on Bus Lines
• Fully Programmable Slave Address with General Call Support
• Address Recognition Causes Wake-up When AVR is in Sleep Mode
SDA
SCL
218 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
The Power Reduction TWI bit, PRTWI bit in “Power Reduction Register 0 - PRR0” on page 56
must be written to zero to enable the 2-wire Serial Interface.
SDA
SCL
Data Change
219
7593D–AVR–07/06
depicted below, START and STOP conditions are signalled by changing the level of the SDA
line when the SCL line is high.
SDA
SCL
SDA
SCL
1 2 7 8 9
START
220 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
20.3.4 Data Packet Format
All data packets transmitted on the TWI bus are nine bits long, consisting of one data byte and
an acknowledge bit. During a data transfer, the Master generates the clock and the START and
STOP conditions, while the Receiver is responsible for acknowledging the reception. An
Acknowledge (ACK) is signalled by the Receiver pulling the SDA line low during the ninth SCL
cycle. If the Receiver leaves the SDA line high, a NACK is signalled. When the Receiver has
received the last byte, or for some reason cannot receive any more bytes, it should inform the
Transmitter by sending a NACK after the final byte. The MSB of the data byte is transmitted first.
SDA from
Transmitter
SDA from
Receiver
SCL from
Master
1 2 7 8 9
STOP, REPEATED
SLA+R/W Data Byte START or Next
Data Byte
Addr MSB Addr LSB R/W ACK Data MSB Data LSB ACK
SDA
SCL
1 2 7 8 9 1 2 7 8 9
221
7593D–AVR–07/06
20.4 Multi-master Bus Systems, Arbitration and Synchronization
The TWI protocol allows bus systems with several masters. Special concerns have been taken
in order to ensure that transmissions will proceed as normal, even if two or more masters initiate
a transmission at the same time. Two problems arise in multi-master systems:
• An algorithm must be implemented allowing only one of the masters to complete the
transmission. All other masters should cease transmission when they discover that they have
lost the selection process. This selection process is called arbitration. When a contending
master discovers that it has lost the arbitration process, it should immediately switch to Slave
mode to check whether it is being addressed by the winning master. The fact that multiple
masters have started transmission at the same time should not be detectable to the slaves,
i.e. the data being transferred on the bus must not be corrupted.
• Different masters may use different SCL frequencies. A scheme must be devised to
synchronize the serial clocks from all masters, in order to let the transmission proceed in a
lockstep fashion. This will facilitate the arbitration process.
The wired-ANDing of the bus lines is used to solve both these problems. The serial clocks from
all masters will be wired-ANDed, yielding a combined clock with a high period equal to the one
from the Master with the shortest high period. The low period of the combined clock is equal to
the low period of the Master with the longest low period. Note that all masters listen to the SCL
line, effectively starting to count their SCL high and low time-out periods when the combined
SCL line goes high or low, respectively.
SCL from
Master A
SCL from
Master B
SCL Bus
Line
TBlow TBhigh
Arbitration is carried out by all masters continuously monitoring the SDA line after outputting
data. If the value read from the SDA line does not match the value the Master had output, it has
lost the arbitration. Note that a Master can only lose arbitration when it outputs a high SDA value
while another Master outputs a low value. The losing Master should immediately go to Slave
mode, checking if it is being addressed by the winning Master. The SDA line should be left high,
but losing masters are allowed to generate a clock signal until the end of the current data or
address packet. Arbitration will continue until only one Master remains, and this may take many
222 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
bits. If several masters are trying to address the same Slave, arbitration will continue into the
data packet.
SDA from
Master B
SDA Line
Synchronized
SCL Line
223
7593D–AVR–07/06
Figure 20-9. Overview of the TWI Module
SCL SDA
Slew-rate Spike Slew-rate Spike
Control Filter Control Filter
TWI Unit
Address Register Status Register Control Register
(TWAR) (TWSR) (TWCR)
224 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
225
7593D–AVR–07/06
The TWINT Flag is set in the following situations:
• After the TWI has transmitted a START/REPEATED START condition.
• After the TWI has transmitted SLA+R/W.
• After the TWI has transmitted an address byte.
• After the TWI has lost arbitration.
• After the TWI has been addressed by own slave address or general call.
• After the TWI has received a data byte.
• After a STOP or REPEATED START has been received while still addressed as a Slave.
• When a bus error has occurred due to an illegal START or STOP condition.
The TWCR is used to control the operation of the TWI. It is used to enable the TWI, to initiate a
Master access by applying a START condition to the bus, to generate a Receiver acknowledge,
to generate a stop condition, and to control halting of the bus while the data to be written to the
bus are written to the TWDR. It also indicates a write collision if data is attempted written to
TWDR while the register is inaccessible.
226 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
1. The device’s own slave address has been received.
2. A general call has been received, while the TWGCE bit in the TWAR is set.
3. A data byte has been received in Master Receiver or Slave Receiver mode.
By writing the TWEA bit to zero, the device can be virtually disconnected from the 2-wire Serial
Bus temporarily. Address recognition can then be resumed by writing the TWEA bit to one
again.
227
7593D–AVR–07/06
caler bits to zero when checking the Status bits. This makes status checking independent of
prescaler setting. This approach is used in this datasheet, unless otherwise noted.
To calculate bit rates, see “Bit Rate Generator Unit” on page 224. The value of TWPS1..0 is
used in the equation.
In Transmit mode, TWDR contains the next byte to be transmitted. In Receive mode, the TWDR
contains the last byte received. It is writable while the TWI is not in the process of shifting a byte.
This occurs when the TWI Interrupt Flag (TWINT) is set by hardware. Note that the Data Regis-
ter cannot be initialized by the user before the first interrupt occurs. The data in TWDR remains
stable as long as TWINT is set. While data is shifted out, data on the bus is simultaneously
shifted in. TWDR always contains the last byte present on the bus, except after a wake up from
a sleep mode by the TWI interrupt. In this case, the contents of TWDR is undefined. In the case
of a lost bus arbitration, no data is lost in the transition from Master to Slave. Handling of the
ACK bit is controlled automatically by the TWI logic, the CPU cannot access the ACK bit directly.
The TWAR should be loaded with the 7-bit Slave address (in the seven most significant bits of
TWAR) to which the TWI will respond when programmed as a Slave Transmitter or Receiver,
and not needed in the Master modes. In multimaster systems, TWAR must be set in masters
which can be addressed as Slaves by other Masters.
228 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
The LSB of TWAR is used to enable recognition of the general call address (0x00). There is an
associated address comparator that looks for the slave address (or general call address if
enabled) in the received serial address. If a match is found, an interrupt request is generated.
TWAR0
Address
Address Match
Bit 0
TWAMR0
Address Bit Comparator 0
229
7593D–AVR–07/06
state of the TWI bus. The application software can then decide how the TWI should behave in
the next TWI bus cycle by manipulating the TWCR and TWDR Registers.
Figure 20-11 is a simple example of how the application can interface to the TWI hardware. In
this example, a Master wishes to transmit a single data byte to a Slave. This description is quite
abstract, a more detailed explanation follows later in this section. A simple code example imple-
menting the desired behavior is also presented.
Indicates
4. TWINT set.
Hardware
1. The first step in a TWI transmission is to transmit a START condition. This is done by
writing a specific value into TWCR, instructing the TWI hardware to transmit a START
condition. Which value to write is described later on. However, it is important that the
TWINT bit is set in the value written. Writing a one to TWINT clears the flag. The TWI
will not start any operation as long as the TWINT bit in TWCR is set. Immediately after
the application has cleared TWINT, the TWI will initiate transmission of the START
condition.
2. When the START condition has been transmitted, the TWINT Flag in TWCR is set, and
TWSR is updated with a status code indicating that the START condition has success-
fully been sent.
3. The application software should now examine the value of TWSR, to make sure that
the START condition was successfully transmitted. If TWSR indicates otherwise, the
application software might take some special action, like calling an error routine.
Assuming that the status code is as expected, the application must load SLA+W into
TWDR. Remember that TWDR is used both for address and data. After TWDR has
been loaded with the desired SLA+W, a specific value must be written to TWCR,
instructing the TWI hardware to transmit the SLA+W present in TWDR. Which value to
write is described later on. However, it is important that the TWINT bit is set in the value
written. Writing a one to TWINT clears the flag. The TWI will not start any operation as
long as the TWINT bit in TWCR is set. Immediately after the application has cleared
TWINT, the TWI will initiate transmission of the address packet.
4. When the address packet has been transmitted, the TWINT Flag in TWCR is set, and
TWSR is updated with a status code indicating that the address packet has success-
fully been sent. The status code will also reflect whether a Slave acknowledged the
packet or not.
230 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
5. The application software should now examine the value of TWSR, to make sure that
the address packet was successfully transmitted, and that the value of the ACK bit was
as expected. If TWSR indicates otherwise, the application software might take some
special action, like calling an error routine. Assuming that the status code is as
expected, the application must load a data packet into TWDR. Subsequently, a specific
value must be written to TWCR, instructing the TWI hardware to transmit the data
packet present in TWDR. Which value to write is described later on. However, it is
important that the TWINT bit is set in the value written. Writing a one to TWINT clears
the flag. The TWI will not start any operation as long as the TWINT bit in TWCR is set.
Immediately after the application has cleared TWINT, the TWI will initiate transmission
of the data packet.
6. When the data packet has been transmitted, the TWINT Flag in TWCR is set, and
TWSR is updated with a status code indicating that the data packet has successfully
been sent. The status code will also reflect whether a Slave acknowledged the packet
or not.
7. The application software should now examine the value of TWSR, to make sure that
the data packet was successfully transmitted, and that the value of the ACK bit was as
expected. If TWSR indicates otherwise, the application software might take some spe-
cial action, like calling an error routine. Assuming that the status code is as expected,
the application must write a specific value to TWCR, instructing the TWI hardware to
transmit a STOP condition. Which value to write is described later on. However, it is
important that the TWINT bit is set in the value written. Writing a one to TWINT clears
the flag. The TWI will not start any operation as long as the TWINT bit in TWCR is set.
Immediately after the application has cleared TWINT, the TWI will initiate transmission
of the STOP condition. Note that TWINT is NOT set after a STOP condition has been
sent.
Even though this example is simple, it shows the principles involved in all TWI transmissions.
These can be summarized as follows:
• When the TWI has finished an operation and expects application response, the TWINT Flag
is set. The SCL line is pulled low until TWINT is cleared.
• When the TWINT Flag is set, the user must update all TWI Registers with the value relevant
for the next TWI bus cycle. As an example, TWDR must be loaded with the value to be
transmitted in the next bus cycle.
• After all TWI Register updates and other pending application software tasks have been
completed, TWCR is written. When writing TWCR, the TWINT bit should be set. Writing a
one to TWINT clears the flag. The TWI will then commence executing whatever operation
was specified by the TWCR setting.
In the following an assembly and C implementation of the example is given. Note that the code
below assumes that several definitions have been made, for example by using include-files.
231
7593D–AVR–07/06
Table 2.
Assembly Code Example C Example Comments
ldi r16, TWCR = (1<<TWINT)|(1<<TWSTA)|
(1<<TWINT)|(1<<TWSTA)| (1<<TWEN)
1 Send START condition
(1<<TWEN)
out TWCR, r16
wait1: while (!(TWCR & (1<<TWINT)))
in r16,TWCR ; Wait for TWINT Flag set. This
2 indicates that the START
sbrs r16,TWINT condition has been transmitted
rjmp wait1
in r16,TWSR if ((TWSR & 0xF8) != START) Check value of TWI Status
andi r16, 0xF8 ERROR(); Register. Mask prescaler bits. If
cpi r16, START status different from START go to
brne ERROR ERROR
3 ldi r16, SLA_W TWDR = SLA_W;
out TWDR, r16 TWCR = (1<<TWINT) | Load SLA_W into TWDR
(1<<TWEN); Register. Clear TWINT bit in
ldi r16, (1<<TWINT) | TWCR to start transmission of
(1<<TWEN) address
out TWCR, r16
wait2: while (!(TWCR & (1<<TWINT))) Wait for TWINT Flag set. This
in r16,TWCR ; indicates that the SLA+W has
4
sbrs r16,TWINT been transmitted, and
ACK/NACK has been received.
rjmp wait2
in r16,TWSR if ((TWSR & 0xF8) != Check value of TWI Status
andi r16, 0xF8 MT_SLA_ACK) Register. Mask prescaler bits. If
cpi r16, MT_SLA_ACK ERROR(); status different from
MT_SLA_ACK go to ERROR
brne ERROR
5 ldi r16, DATA TWDR = DATA;
out TWDR, r16 TWCR = (1<<TWINT) | Load DATA into TWDR Register.
ldi r16, (1<<TWINT) | (1<<TWEN); Clear TWINT bit in TWCR to start
(1<<TWEN) transmission of data
out TWCR, r16
wait3: while (!(TWCR & (1<<TWINT))) Wait for TWINT Flag set. This
in r16,TWCR ; indicates that the DATA has been
6
sbrs r16,TWINT transmitted, and ACK/NACK has
been received.
rjmp wait3
in r16,TWSR if ((TWSR & 0xF8) != Check value of TWI Status
andi r16, 0xF8 MT_DATA_ACK) Register. Mask prescaler bits. If
cpi r16, MT_DATA_ACK ERROR(); status different from
MT_DATA_ACK go to ERROR
brne ERROR
7
ldi r16, TWCR = (1<<TWINT)|(1<<TWEN)|
(1<<TWINT)|(1<<TWEN)| (1<<TWSTO);
Transmit STOP condition
(1<<TWSTO)
out TWCR, r16
232 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
20.8 Transmission Modes
The TWI can operate in one of four major modes. These are named Master Transmitter (MT),
Master Receiver (MR), Slave Transmitter (ST) and Slave Receiver (SR). Several of these
modes can be used in the same application. As an example, the TWI can use MT mode to write
data into a TWI EEPROM, MR mode to read the data back from the EEPROM. If other masters
are present in the system, some of these might transmit data to the TWI, and then SR mode
would be used. It is the application software that decides which modes are legal.
The following sections describe each of these modes. Possible status codes are described
along with figures detailing data transmission in each of the modes. These figures contain the
following abbreviations:
S: START condition
Rs: REPEATED START condition
R: Read bit (high level at SDA)
W: Write bit (low level at SDA)
A: Acknowledge bit (low level at SDA)
A: Not acknowledge bit (high level at SDA)
Data: 8-bit data byte
P: STOP condition
SLA: Slave Address
In Figure 20-13 to Figure 20-19, circles are used to indicate that the TWINT Flag is set. The
numbers in the circles show the status code held in TWSR, with the prescaler bits masked to
zero. At these points, actions must be taken by the application to continue or complete the TWI
transfer. The TWI transfer is suspended until the TWINT Flag is cleared by software.
When the TWINT Flag is set, the status code in TWSR is used to determine the appropriate soft-
ware action. For each status code, the required software action and details of the following serial
transfer are given in Table 20-3 to Table 20-6. Note that the prescaler bits are masked to zero in
these tables.
233
7593D–AVR–07/06
Figure 20-12. Data Transfer in Master Transmitter Mode
VCC
Device 1 Device 2
MASTER SLAVE Device 3 ........ Device n R1 R2
TRANSMITTER RECEIVER
SDA
SCL
TWEN must be set to enable the 2-wire Serial Interface, TWSTA must be written to one to trans-
mit a START condition and TWINT must be written to one to clear the TWINT Flag. The TWI will
then test the 2-wire Serial Bus and generate a START condition as soon as the bus becomes
free. After a START condition has been transmitted, the TWINT Flag is set by hardware, and the
status code in TWSR will be 0x08 (see Table 20-3). In order to enter MT mode, SLA+W must be
transmitted. This is done by writing SLA+W to TWDR. Thereafter the TWINT bit should be
cleared (by writing it to one) to continue the transfer. This is accomplished by writing the follow-
ing value to TWCR:
TWCR TWINT TWEA TWSTA TWSTO TWWC TWEN – TWIE
value 1 X 0 0 X 1 0 X
When SLA+W have been transmitted and an acknowledgement bit has been received, TWINT is
set again and a number of status codes in TWSR are possible. Possible status codes in Master
mode are 0x18, 0x20, or 0x38. The appropriate action to be taken for each of these status codes
is detailed in Table 20-3.
When SLA+W has been successfully transmitted, a data packet should be transmitted. This is
done by writing the data byte to TWDR. TWDR must only be written when TWINT is high. If not,
the access will be discarded, and the Write Collision bit (TWWC) will be set in the TWCR Regis-
ter. After updating TWDR, the TWINT bit should be cleared (by writing it to one) to continue the
transfer. This is accomplished by writing the following value to TWCR:
TWCR TWINT TWEA TWSTA TWSTO TWWC TWEN – TWIE
value 1 X 0 0 X 1 0 X
This scheme is repeated until the last byte has been sent and the transfer is ended by generat-
ing a STOP condition or a repeated START condition. A STOP condition is generated by writing
the following value to TWCR:
TWCR TWINT TWEA TWSTA TWSTO TWWC TWEN – TWIE
value 1 X 0 1 X 1 0 X
234 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
After a repeated START condition (state 0x10) the 2-wire Serial Interface can access the same
Slave again, or a new Slave without transmitting a STOP condition. Repeated START enables
the Master to switch between Slaves, Master Transmitter mode and Master Receiver mode with-
out losing control of the bus.
235
7593D–AVR–07/06
Figure 20-13. Formats and States in the Master Transmitter Mode
MT
Successfull
transmission S SLA W A DATA A P
to a slave
receiver
Next transfer
started with a RS SLA W
repeated start
condition
$10
Not acknowledge R
received after the A P
slave address
$20
MR
Not acknowledge
received after a data A P
byte
$30
$38 $38
To corresponding
$68 $78 $B0 states in slave mode
236 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Figure 20-14. Data Transfer in Master Receiver Mode
VCC
Device 1 Device 2
MASTER SLAVE Device 3 ........ Device n R1 R2
RECEIVER TRANSMITTER
SDA
SCL
TWEN must be written to one to enable the 2-wire Serial Interface, TWSTA must be written to
one to transmit a START condition and TWINT must be set to clear the TWINT Flag. The TWI
will then test the 2-wire Serial Bus and generate a START condition as soon as the bus
becomes free. After a START condition has been transmitted, the TWINT Flag is set by hard-
ware, and the status code in TWSR will be 0x08 (See Table 20-3). In order to enter MR mode,
SLA+R must be transmitted. This is done by writing SLA+R to TWDR. Thereafter the TWINT bit
should be cleared (by writing it to one) to continue the transfer. This is accomplished by writing
the following value to TWCR:
TWCR TWINT TWEA TWSTA TWSTO TWWC TWEN – TWIE
value 1 X 0 0 X 1 0 X
When SLA+R have been transmitted and an acknowledgement bit has been received, TWINT is
set again and a number of status codes in TWSR are possible. Possible status codes in Master
mode are 0x38, 0x40, or 0x48. The appropriate action to be taken for each of these status codes
is detailed in Table 20-4. Received data can be read from the TWDR Register when the TWINT
Flag is set high by hardware. This scheme is repeated until the last byte has been received.
After the last byte has been received, the MR should inform the ST by sending a NACK after the
last received data byte. The transfer is ended by generating a STOP condition or a repeated
START condition. A STOP condition is generated by writing the following value to TWCR:
TWCR TWINT TWEA TWSTA TWSTO TWWC TWEN – TWIE
value 1 X 0 1 X 1 0 X
After a repeated START condition (state 0x10) the 2-wire Serial Interface can access the same
Slave again, or a new Slave without transmitting a STOP condition. Repeated START enables
237
7593D–AVR–07/06
the Master to switch between Slaves, Master Transmitter mode and Master Receiver mode with-
out losing control over the bus.
0x48 SLA+R has been transmitted; No TWDR action or 1 0 1 X Repeated START will be transmitted
NOT ACK has been received No TWDR action or 0 1 1 X STOP condition will be transmitted and TWSTO Flag
will be reset
No TWDR action 1 1 1 X STOP condition followed by a START condition will be
transmitted and TWSTO Flag will be reset
0x50 Data byte has been received; Read data byte or 0 0 1 0 Data byte will be received and NOT ACK will be
ACK has been returned returned
Read data byte 0 0 1 1 Data byte will be received and ACK will be returned
0x58 Data byte has been received; Read data byte or 1 0 1 X Repeated START will be transmitted
NOT ACK has been returned Read data byte or 0 1 1 X STOP condition will be transmitted and TWSTO Flag
will be reset
Read data byte 1 1 1 X STOP condition followed by a START condition will be
transmitted and TWSTO Flag will be reset
238 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Figure 20-15. Formats and States in the Master Receiver Mode
MR
Successfull
reception S SLA R A DATA A DATA A P
from a slave
receiver
Next transfer
started with a RS SLA R
repeated start
condition
$10
Not acknowledge W
received after the A P
slave address
$48
MT
Arbitration lost in slave Other master Other master
address or data byte A or A continues A continues
$38 $38
To corresponding
$68 $78 $B0 states in slave mode
Device 1 Device 2
SLAVE MASTER Device 3 ........ Device n R1 R2
RECEIVER TRANSMITTER
SDA
SCL
To initiate the Slave Receiver mode, TWAR and TWCR must be initialized as follows:
TWAR TWA6 TWA5 TWA4 TWA3 TWA2 TWA1 TWA0 TWGCE
value Device’s Own Slave Address
239
7593D–AVR–07/06
The upper 7 bits are the address to which the 2-wire Serial Interface will respond when
addressed by a Master. If the LSB is set, the TWI will respond to the general call address (0x00),
otherwise it will ignore the general call address.
TWCR TWINT TWEA TWSTA TWSTO TWWC TWEN – TWIE
value 0 1 0 0 0 1 0 X
TWEN must be written to one to enable the TWI. The TWEA bit must be written to one to enable
the acknowledgement of the device’s own slave address or the general call address. TWSTA
and TWSTO must be written to zero.
When TWAR and TWCR have been initialized, the TWI waits until it is addressed by its own
slave address (or the general call address if enabled) followed by the data direction bit. If the
direction bit is “0” (write), the TWI will operate in SR mode, otherwise ST mode is entered. After
its own slave address and the write bit have been received, the TWINT Flag is set and a valid
status code can be read from TWSR. The status code is used to determine the appropriate soft-
ware action. The appropriate action to be taken for each status code is detailed in Table 20-5.
The Slave Receiver mode may also be entered if arbitration is lost while the TWI is in the Master
mode (see states 0x68 and 0x78).
If the TWEA bit is reset during a transfer, the TWI will return a “Not Acknowledge” (“1”) to SDA
after the next received data byte. This can be used to indicate that the Slave is not able to
receive any more bytes. While TWEA is zero, the TWI does not acknowledge its own slave
address. However, the 2-wire Serial Bus is still monitored and address recognition may resume
at any time by setting TWEA. This implies that the TWEA bit may be used to temporarily isolate
the TWI from the 2-wire Serial Bus.
In all sleep modes other than Idle mode, the clock system to the TWI is turned off. If the TWEA
bit is set, the interface can still acknowledge its own slave address or the general call address by
using the 2-wire Serial Bus clock as a clock source. The part will then wake up from sleep and
the TWI will hold the SCL clock low during the wake up and until the TWINT Flag is cleared (by
writing it to one). Further data reception will be carried out as normal, with the AVR clocks run-
ning as normal. Observe that if the AVR is set up with a long start-up time, the SCL line may be
held low for a long time, blocking other data transmissions.
Note that the 2-wire Serial Interface Data Register – TWDR does not reflect the last byte present
on the bus when waking up from these Sleep modes.
240 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
241
7593D–AVR–07/06
Figure 20-17. Formats and States in the Slave Receiver Mode
Reception of the own
slave address and one or S SLA W A DATA A DATA A P or S
more data bytes. All are
acknowledged
$88
$68
$98
$78
Device 1 Device 2
SLAVE MASTER Device 3 ........ Device n R1 R2
TRANSMITTER RECEIVER
SDA
SCL
242 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
To initiate the Slave Transmitter mode, TWAR and TWCR must be initialized as follows:
TWAR TWA6 TWA5 TWA4 TWA3 TWA2 TWA1 TWA0 TWGCE
value Device’s Own Slave Address
The upper seven bits are the address to which the 2-wire Serial Interface will respond when
addressed by a Master. If the LSB is set, the TWI will respond to the general call address (0x00),
otherwise it will ignore the general call address.
TWCR TWINT TWEA TWSTA TWSTO TWWC TWEN – TWIE
value 0 1 0 0 0 1 0 X
TWEN must be written to one to enable the TWI. The TWEA bit must be written to one to enable
the acknowledgement of the device’s own slave address or the general call address. TWSTA
and TWSTO must be written to zero.
When TWAR and TWCR have been initialized, the TWI waits until it is addressed by its own
slave address (or the general call address if enabled) followed by the data direction bit. If the
direction bit is “1” (read), the TWI will operate in ST mode, otherwise SR mode is entered. After
its own slave address and the write bit have been received, the TWINT Flag is set and a valid
status code can be read from TWSR. The status code is used to determine the appropriate soft-
ware action. The appropriate action to be taken for each status code is detailed in Table 20-6.
The Slave Transmitter mode may also be entered if arbitration is lost while the TWI is in the
Master mode (see state 0xB0).
If the TWEA bit is written to zero during a transfer, the TWI will transmit the last byte of the trans-
fer. State 0xC0 or state 0xC8 will be entered, depending on whether the Master Receiver
transmits a NACK or ACK after the final byte. The TWI is switched to the not addressed Slave
mode, and will ignore the Master if it continues the transfer. Thus the Master Receiver receives
all “1” as serial data. State 0xC8 is entered if the Master demands additional data bytes (by
transmitting ACK), even though the Slave has transmitted the last byte (TWEA zero and expect-
ing NACK from the Master).
While TWEA is zero, the TWI does not respond to its own slave address. However, the 2-wire
Serial Bus is still monitored and address recognition may resume at any time by setting TWEA.
This implies that the TWEA bit may be used to temporarily isolate the TWI from the 2-wire Serial
Bus.
In all sleep modes other than Idle mode, the clock system to the TWI is turned off. If the TWEA
bit is set, the interface can still acknowledge its own slave address or the general call address by
using the 2-wire Serial Bus clock as a clock source. The part will then wake up from sleep and
the TWI will hold the SCL clock will low during the wake up and until the TWINT Flag is cleared
(by writing it to one). Further data transmission will be carried out as normal, with the AVR clocks
running as normal. Observe that if the AVR is set up with a long start-up time, the SCL line may
be held low for a long time, blocking other data transmissions.
Note that the 2-wire Serial Interface Data Register – TWDR does not reflect the last byte present
on the bus when waking up from these sleep modes.
243
7593D–AVR–07/06
Table 20-6. Status Codes for Slave Transmitter Mode
0xA8 Own SLA+R has been received; Load data byte or X 0 1 0 Last data byte will be transmitted and NOT ACK should
ACK has been returned be received
Load data byte X 0 1 1 Data byte will be transmitted and ACK should be re-
ceived
0xB0 Arbitration lost in SLA+R/W as Load data byte or X 0 1 0 Last data byte will be transmitted and NOT ACK should
Master; own SLA+R has been be received
received; ACK has been returned Load data byte X 0 1 1 Data byte will be transmitted and ACK should be re-
ceived
0xB8 Data byte in TWDR has been Load data byte or X 0 1 0 Last data byte will be transmitted and NOT ACK should
transmitted; ACK has been be received
received Load data byte X 0 1 1 Data byte will be transmitted and ACK should be re-
ceived
0xC0 Data byte in TWDR has been No TWDR action or 0 0 1 0 Switched to the not addressed Slave mode;
transmitted; NOT ACK has been no recognition of own SLA or GCA
received No TWDR action or 0 0 1 1 Switched to the not addressed Slave mode;
own SLA will be recognized;
GCA will be recognized if TWGCE = “1”
No TWDR action or 1 0 1 0 Switched to the not addressed Slave mode;
no recognition of own SLA or GCA;
a START condition will be transmitted when the bus
becomes free
No TWDR action 1 0 1 1 Switched to the not addressed Slave mode;
own SLA will be recognized;
GCA will be recognized if TWGCE = “1”;
a START condition will be transmitted when the bus
becomes free
0xC8 Last data byte in TWDR has been No TWDR action or 0 0 1 0 Switched to the not addressed Slave mode;
transmitted (TWEA = “0”); ACK no recognition of own SLA or GCA
has been received No TWDR action or 0 0 1 1 Switched to the not addressed Slave mode;
own SLA will be recognized;
GCA will be recognized if TWGCE = “1”
No TWDR action or 1 0 1 0 Switched to the not addressed Slave mode;
no recognition of own SLA or GCA;
a START condition will be transmitted when the bus
becomes free
No TWDR action 1 0 1 1 Switched to the not addressed Slave mode;
own SLA will be recognized;
GCA will be recognized if TWGCE = “1”;
a START condition will be transmitted when the bus
becomes free
$B0
$C8
244 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Status 0xF8 indicates that no relevant information is available because the TWINT Flag is not
set. This occurs between other states, and when the TWI is not involved in a serial transfer.
Status 0x00 indicates that a bus error has occurred during a 2-wire Serial Bus transfer. A bus
error occurs when a START or STOP condition occurs at an illegal position in the format frame.
Examples of such illegal positions are during the serial transfer of an address byte, a data byte,
or an acknowledge bit. When a bus error occurs, TWINT is set. To recover from a bus error, the
TWSTO Flag must set and TWINT must be cleared by writing a logic one to it. This causes the
TWI to enter the not addressed Slave mode and to clear the TWSTO Flag (no other bits in
TWCR are affected). The SDA and SCL lines are released, and no STOP condition is
transmitted.
245
7593D–AVR–07/06
20.9 Multi-master Systems and Arbitration
If multiple masters are connected to the same bus, transmissions may be initiated simulta-
neously by one or more of them. The TWI standard ensures that such situations are handled in
such a way that one of the masters will be allowed to proceed with the transfer, and that no data
will be lost in the process. An example of an arbitration situation is depicted below, where two
masters are trying to transmit data to a Slave Receiver.
SDA
SCL
246 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Figure 20-22. Possible Status Codes Caused by Arbitration
START SLA Data STOP
Own No 38 TWI bus will be released and not addressed slave mode will be entered
Address / General Call
A START condition will be transmitted when the bus becomes free
received
Yes
Direction
Write 68/78 Data byte will be received and NOT ACK will be returned
Data byte will be received and ACK will be returned
Read Last data byte will be transmitted and NOT ACK should be received
B0 Data byte will be transmitted and ACK should be received
247
7593D–AVR–07/06
21. USB controller
21.1 Features
• Support full-speed and low-speed.
• Support ping-pong mode (dual bank)
• 832 bytes of DPRAM.
• 1 endpoint 64 bytes max (default control endpoint),
• 1 endpoints of 256 bytes max, (one or two banks),
• 5 endpoints of 64 bytes max, (one or two banks)
248 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Figure 21-1. USB controller Block Diagram overview
UVCC AVCC XTAL1
clk
USB Regulator PLL 2MHz PLL clock
UCAP
24x Prescaler
clk
48MHz
D- CPU
DPLL
Clock
Recovery
D+
USB
Interface
VBUS
On-Chip
USB DPRAM
UID
5.5
16 MHz
4.5
USB operationnal
Normal operation
with internal regulator
3.6 8 MHz
3.0
Extra power consumption
2.7
USB not operationnal
2 MHz
VCC min
249
7593D–AVR–07/06
21.3.1 Device mode
UCAP
1µF
VBUS VBUS
UDP D+
Rs=22
UDM D-
Rs=22
UVSS UVSS
UID UID
UCAP
1µF
VBUS VBUS
UDP D+
Rs=22
UDM D-
Rs=22
UVSS UVSS
UVSS
UID UID
250 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
21.3.1.2 Self Powered device
Figure 21-5. Typical Self powered application with 3.4V to 5.5V I/O
UCAP
1µF
VBUS VBUS
UDP D+
Rs=22
UDM D-
Rs=22
UVSS UVSS
UID UID
Figure 21-6. Typical Self powered application with 3.0V to 3.4 I/O
UCAP
1µF
VBUS VBUS
UDP D+
Rs=22
UDM D-
Rs=22
UVSS UVSS
UID UID
251
7593D–AVR–07/06
21.3.2 Host / OTG mode
1µF
UVCON
VBUS VBUS
UDM D+
Rs=22
UDP D-
Rs=22
UVSS UVSS
UID UID
External 5.0V
5V Power Supply
UCAP
1µF
UVCON
VBUS VBUS
UDP D+
Rs=22
UDM D-
Rs=22
UVSS UVSS
UID UID
252 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
21.4 General Operating Modes
21.4.1 Introduction
After a hardware reset, the USB controller is disabled. When enabled, the USB controller has to
run the Device Controller or the Host Controller. This is performed using the ID detection.
• If the ID pin is not connected to ground, the ID bit is set by hardware (internal pull up on the
UID pad) and the USB Device controller is selected.
• The ID bit is cleared by hardware when a low level has been detected on the ID pin. The
Device controller is then disabled and the Host controller enabled.
The software anyway has to select the mode (Host, Device) in order to access to the Device
controller registers or to the Host controller registers, which are multiplexed. For example, even
if the USB controller has detected a Device mode (pin ID high), the software shall select the
device mode (bit HOST cleared), otherwise it will access to the host registers. This is also true
for the Host mode.
Reset HW
RESET
USBE=1
ID=1 USBE=0
USBE=0 USBE=1
ID=0
Host
253
7593D–AVR–07/06
21.4.3 Interrupts
Two interrupts vectors are assigned to USB interface.
USB General
& OTG Interrupt
USB Host
Interrupt
Endpoint
Interrupt
USB Endpoint/Pipe
Interrupt Vector
Pipe
Interrupt
See Section 22.18, page 279 and Section 23.15, page 299 for more details on the Host and
Device interrupts.
254 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Figure 21-11. USB General interrupt vector sources
IDTI
USBINT.1
IDTE
USBCON.1
VBUSTI
USBINT.0
VBUSTE
USBCON.0
STOI
OTGINT.5
STOE
OTGIEN.5
HNPERRI
OTGINT.4
HNPERRE USB General
OTGIEN.4 Interrupt Vector
ROLEEXI
OTGINT.3
ROLEEXE
OTGIEN.3
BCERRI
OTGINT.2
BCERRE
OTGIEN.2
VBERRI
OTGINT.1
VBERRE
OTGIEN.1
SRPI
OTGINT.0
SRPE
OTGIEN.0
UPRSMI
UDINT.6
UPRSME
UDIEN.6
EORSMI
UDINT.5
EORSME
UDIEN.5
WAKEUPI
UDINT.4
WAKEUPE USB Device USB General
UDIEN.4 Interrupt Interrupt Vector
EORSTI
UDINT.3
EORSTE
UDIEN.3
SOFI
UDINT.2
SOFE
UDIEN.2
SUSPI
UDINT.0
SUSPE
UDIEN.0
HWUPI
UHINT.6
HWUPE
UHIEN.6
HSOFI
UHINT.5
HSOFE
UHIEN.5
RXRSMI
UHINT.4
RXRSME
UHIEN.4
USB Host
RSMEDI Interrupt
UHINT.3
RSMEDE
UHIEN.3
RSTI
UHINT.2
RSTE
UHIEN.2
DDISCI
UHINT.1
DDISCE Asynchronous Interrupt source
UHIEN.1 (allows the CPU to wake up from power down mode)
DCONNI
UHINT.0
DCONNE
UHIEN.0
255
7593D–AVR–07/06
Figure 21-12. USB Endpoint/Pipe Interrupt vector sources
Endpoint 6
Endpoint 5
Endpoint 4
Endpoint 3
Endpoint 2
Endpoint 1
Endpoint 0
OVERFI
UESTAX.6
UNDERFI
FLERRE
UESTAX.5
UEIENX.7
NAKINI
UEINTX.6
NAKINE
UEIENX.6
NAKOUTI
UEINTX.4
TXSTPE
Endpoint Interrupt
UEIENX.4
RXSTPI EPINT
UEINTX.3 UEINT.X
TXOUTE
UEIENX.3
RXOUTI
UEINTX.2
RXOUTE
UEIENX.2
STALLEDI
UEINTX.1
STALLEDE
UEIENX.1
TXINI
UEINTX.0
TXINE
UEIENX.0
USB Endpoint/P
Interrupt Vecto
PIPE 6
PIPE 5
PIPE 4
PIPE 3
PIPE 2
PIPE 1
OVERFI PIPE 0
UPSTAX.6
UNDERFI
FLERRE
UPSTAX.5
UPIEN.7
NAKEDI
UPINTX.6
NAKEDE
UPIEN.6
PERRI
UPINTX.4
PERRE
UPIEN.4
Pipe Interrupt
TXSTPI FLERRE
UPINTX.3 UPIEN.7
TXSTPE
UPIEN.3
TXOUTI
UPINTX.2
TXOUTE
UPIEN.2
RXSTALLI
UPINTX.1
RXSTALLE
UPIEN.1
RXINI
UPINTX.0
RXINE
UPIEN.0
256 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Figure 21-13. USB General and OTG Controller Interrupt System
IDTI
USBINT.1
IDTE
USBCON.1
VBUSTI
USBINT.0
VBUSTE
USBCON.0
STOI
OTGINT.5
STOE
OTGIEN.5
HNPERRI
OTGINT.4
HNPERRE USB General & OTG
OTGIEN.4 Interrupt Vector
ROLEEXI
OTGINT.3
ROLEEXE
OTGIEN.3
BCERRI
OTGINT.2
BCERRE
OTGIEN.2
VBERRI
OTGINT.1
VBERRE Asynchronous Interrupt source
OTGIEN.1 (allows the CPU to wake up from power down mode)
SRPI
OTGINT.0
SRPE
OTGIEN.0
There are 2 kind of interrupts: processing (i.e. their generation are part of the normal processing)
and exception (errors).
Processing interrupts are generated when:
• ID Pad detection (insert, remove)(IDTI)
• VBUS plug-in detection (insert, remove) (VBUSTI)
• SRP detected(SRPI)
• Role Exchanged(ROLEEXI)
Exception Interrupts are generated when:
• Drop on VBus Detected(VBERRI)
• Error during the B-Connection(BCERRI)
• HNP Error(HNPERRI)
• Time-out detected during Suspend mode(STOII)
257
7593D–AVR–07/06
• the HWUPI interrupt is triggered in the Host mode (HOST set).
• the IDTI interrupt is triggered
• the VBUSTI interrupt is triggered
UCAP USB
Regulator
DETACH
UDCON.0
LSM
UDCON.2
RPU
RPU
UDP
UDM
258 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
21.6.2 Host mode
When the USB interface is configured in device mode, internal Pull Down resistors are activated
on both UDP UDM lines and the interface detects the type of device connected.
5 5 5 5
4 Conflict
4 4 Lost memory
3
EPEN=0
4 3 (bigger size)
(ALLOC=1)
2 2 2 2
1 1 1 1
0 0 0 0
EPEN=1
ALLOC=1
• First, Pipe/Endpoint 0 to Pipe/Endpoint 5 are configured, in the growing order. The memory of
each is reserved in the DPRAM.
• Then, the Pipe/Endpoint 3 is disabled (EPEN=0), but its memory reservation is internally kept
by the controller.
• Its ALLOC bit is cleared: the Pipe/Endpoint 4 “slides” down, but the Pipe/Endpoint 5 does not
“slide”.
• Finally, if the firmware chooses to reconfigure the Pipe/Endpoint 3, with a bigger size. The
controller reserved the memory after the endpoint 2 memory and automatically “slide” the
Pipe/Endpoint 4. The Pipe/Endpoint 5 does not move and a memory conflict appear, in that
259
7593D–AVR–07/06
both Pipe/Endpoint 4 and 5 use a common area. The data of those endpoints are potentially
lost.
Note that:
• the data of Pipe/Endpoint 0 are never lost whatever the activation or deactivation of the
higher Pipe/Endpoint. Its data is lost if it is deactivated.
• Deactivate and reactivate the same Pipe/Endpoint with the same parameters does not lead
to a “slide” of the higher endpoints. For those endpoints, the data are preserved.
• CFGOK is set by hardware even in the case that there is a “conflict” in the memory allocation.
USBE=1
& DETACH=0
Idle mode & suspend
The SUSPI flag indicated that a suspend state has been detected on the USB bus. This flag
automatically put the USB pad in Idle. The detection of a non-idle event sets the WAKEUPI flag
and wakes-up the USB pad.
260 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
PAD status
Active Power Down Active
Moreover, the pad can also be put in the “idle” mode if the DETACH bit is set. It come back in
the active mode when the DETACH bit is cleared.
261
7593D–AVR–07/06
Figure 21-16. Plug-in Detection Input Block Diagram
VDD
VBus_pulsing
RPU
Session_valid
RPU
VBus_discharge
VSS
Pad logic
21.11 ID detection
The ID pin transition is detected thanks to the following architecture:
VDD
Internal Pull Up
RPU
1
UID
0 ID
UIMOD USBSTA.1
UHWCON.7
UIDE
UHWCON.6
The ID pin can be used to detect the USB mode (Peripheral or Host) or software selected. This
allows the UID pin to be used has general purpose I/O even when USB interface is enable.
When the UID pin is selected, by default, (no A-plug or B-plug), the macro is in the Peripheral
262 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
mode (internal pull-up). The IDTI interrupt is triggered when a A-plug (Host) is plugged or
unplugged. The interrupt is not triggered when a B-plug (Periph) is plugged or unplugged.
ID detection is independant of USB global interface enable.
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
UIMOD UIDE UVCONE UVREGE UHWCON
Read/Write R/W R/W R R/W R R R R/W
Initial Value 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
• 5 – Reserved
The value read from this bit is always 0. Do not set this bit.
• 3-1 – Reserved
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not set these bits.
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
USBE HOST FRZCLK OTGPADE - - IDTE VBUSTE USBCON
Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R R R/W R/W
Initial Value 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 0
263
7593D–AVR–07/06
Set to disable the clock inputs (the ”Resume Detection” is still active). This reduces the power
consumption. Clear to enable the clock inputs.
• 3-2 – Reserved
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not set these bits.
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
- - - - SPEED ID VBUS USBSTA
Read/Write R R R R R R R R
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 1 0 1 0
• 7-4 - Reserved
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not set these bits.
• 2 – Reserved
The value read from this bit is always 0. Do not set this bit.
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
- - - - - - IDTI VBUSTI USBINT
Read/Write R R R R R R R/W R/W
264 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
7-2 - Reserved
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not set these bits.
1 – IDTI: D Transition Interrupt Flag
Set by hardware when a transition (high to low, low to high) has been detected on the UID pin.
Shall be cleared by software.
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
- - HNPREQ SRPREQ SRPSEL VBUSHWC VBUSREQ VBUSRQC OTGCON
Read/Write R R R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
• 7-6 - Reserved
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not set these bits.
265
7593D–AVR–07/06
Set to deassert the UVCON pin in order to enable the VBUS power supply generation. This bit
shall be used when the controller is in the Host mode.
Cleared by hardware immediately after the set.
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
1 PAGE - - VALUE OTGTCON
Read/Write R R/W R/W R R R/W R/W R/W
Initial Value 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
• 7 – Reserved
This bit is reserved and always set.
• 4-3 - Reserved
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not set these bits.
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
- - STOE HNPERRE ROLEEXE BCERRE VBERRE SRPE OTGIEN
Read/Write R R R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
• 7-6 - Reserved
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not set these bits.
266 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
- - STOI HNPERRI ROLEEXI BCERRI VBERRI SRPI OTGINT
Read/Write R R R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
• 7-6 - Reserved
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not set these bits.
267
7593D–AVR–07/06
• Attach USB device
268 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
22. USB Device Operating modes
22.1 Introduction
The USB device controller supports full speed and low speed data transfers. In addition to the
default control endpoint, it provides six other endpoints, which can be configured in control, bulk,
interrupt or isochronous modes:
• Endpoint 0:programmable size FIFO up to 64 bytes, default control endpoint
• Endpoints 1 programmable size FIFO up to 256 bytes in ping-pong mode.
• Endpoints 2 to 6: programmable size FIFO up to 64 bytes in ping-pong mode.
The controller starts in the “idle” mode. In this mode, the pad consumption is reduced to the
minimum.
<any
other
USBE=0 state>
USBE=0 Idle
Reset USBE=1
UID=1
HW
RESET
269
7593D–AVR–07/06
22.4 Endpoint reset
An endpoint can be reset at any time by setting in the UERST register the bit corresponding to
the endpoint (EPRSTx). This resets:
• the internal state machine on that endpoint,
• the Rx and Tx banks are cleared and their internal pointers are restored,
• the UEINTX, UESTA0X and UESTA1X are restored to their reset value.
The data toggle field remains unchanged.
The other registers remain unchanged.
The endpoint configuration remains active and the endpoint is still enabled.
The endpoint reset may be associated with a clear of the data toggle command (RSTDT bit) as
an answer to the CLEAR_FEATURE USB command.
270 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Figure 22-2. Endpoint activation flow:
Endpoint
Activation
UECFG0X Configure:
EPDIR - the endpoint direction
EPTYPE - the endpoint type
... - the Not Yet Disable feature
Configure:
UECFG1X - the endpoint size
ALLOC - the bank parametrization
EPSIZE Allocation and reorganization of
EPBK the memory is made on-the-fly
As long as the endpoint is not correctly configured (CFGOK cleared), the hardware does not
acknowledge the packets sent by the host.
CFGOK is will not be sent if the Endpoint size parameter is bigger than the DPRAM size.
A clear of EPEN acts as an endpoint reset (see Section 22.4, page 270 for more details). It also
performs the next operation:
• The configuration of the endpoint is kept (EPSIZE, EPBK, ALLOC kept)
• It resets the data toggle field.
• The DPRAM memory associated to the endpoint is still reserved.
See Section 21.7, page 259 for more details about the memory allocation/reorganization.
271
7593D–AVR–07/06
ADDEN is cleared by hardware:
• after a power-up reset,
• when an USB reset is received,
• or when the macro is disabled (USBE cleared)
When this bit is cleared, the default device address 00h is used.
22.10 Detach
The reset value of the DETACH bit is 1.
It is possible to re-enumerate a device, simply by setting and clearing the DETACH bit.
• If the USB device controller is in full-speed mode, setting DETACH will disconnect the pull-up
on the D+ or D- pad (depending on full or low speed mode selected). Then, clearing DETACH
will connect the pull-up on the D+ or D- pad.
D+ D+
D- D-
Detach, then
EN=1 Attach EN=1
272 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
22.11 Remote Wake-up
The “Remote Wake-up” (or “upstream resume”) request is the only operation allowed to be sent
by the device on its own initiative. Anyway, to do that, the device should first have received a
DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP request from the host.
• First, the USB controller must have detected the “suspend” state of the line: the remote
wake-up can only be sent after a SUSPI interrupt has been triggered.
• The firmware has then the ability to set RMWKUP to send the “upstream resume” stream.
This will automatically be done by the controller after 5ms of inactivity on the USB line.
• When the controller starts to send the “upstream resume”, the UPRSMI interrupt is triggered
(if enabled). If SUSPI was set, SUSPI is cleared by hardware.
• RMWKUP is cleared by hardware at the end of the “upstream resume”.
• If the controller detects a good “End Of Resume” signal from the host, an EORSMI interrupt
is triggered (if enabled).
273
7593D–AVR–07/06
22.12.2 STALL handshake and Retry mechanism
The Retry mechanism has priority over the STALL handshake. A STALL handshake is sent if the
STALLRQ request bit is set and if there is no retry required.
RXOUTI HW SW HW SW
TXINI SW
274 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
22.13.2 Control Read
The next figure shows a control read transaction. The USB controller has to manage the simulta-
neous write requests from the CPU and the USB host:
SETUP DATA STATUS
RXOUTI HW SW
TXINI SW HW SW
Wr Enable
HOST
Wr Enable
CPU
Once the OUT status stage has been received, the USB controller waits for a SETUP request.
The SETUP request have priority over any other request and has to be ACK’ed. This means that
any other flag should be cleared and the fifo reset when a SETUP is received.
WARNING: the byte counter is reset when the OUT Zero Length Packet is received. The firm-
ware has to take care of this.
22.14.1 Overview
The Endpoint must be configured first.
Each time the current bank is full, the RXOUTI and the FIFOCON bits are set. This triggers an
interrupt if the RXOUTE bit is set. The firmware can acknowledge the USB interrupt by clearing
the RXOUTI bit. The Firmware read the data and clear the FIFOCON bit in order to free the cur-
rent bank. If the OUT Endpoint is composed of multiple banks, clearing the FIFOCON bit will
275
7593D–AVR–07/06
switch to the next bank. The RXOUTI and FIFOCON bits are then updated by hardware in
accordance with the status of the new bank.
RXOUTI shall always be cleared before clearing FIFOCON.
The RWAL bit always reflects the state of the current bank. This bit is set if the firmware can
read data from the bank, and cleared by hardware when the bank is empty.
HW HW
RXOUTI SW SW
DATA DATA
OUT ACK OUT ACK
(to bank 0) (to bank 1)
HW
HW
RXOUTI SW SW
22.14.2.1
The data are read by the CPU, following the next flow:
• When the bank is filled by the host, an endpoint interrupt (EPINTx) is triggered, if enabled
(RXOUTE set) and RXOUTI is set. The CPU can also poll RXOUTI or FIFOCON, depending
on the software architecture,
• The CPU acknowledges the interrupt by clearing RXOUTI,
• The CPU can read the number of byte (N) in the current bank (N=BYCT),
• The CPU can read the data from the current bank (“N” read of UEDATX),
• The CPU can free the bank by clearing FIFOCON when all the data is read, that is:
• after “N” read of UEDATX,
• as soon as RWAL is cleared by hardware.
If the endpoint uses 2 banks, the second one can be filled by the HOST while the current one is
being read by the CPU. Then, when the CPU clear FIFOCON, the next bank may be already
ready and RXOUTI is set immediately.
276 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
22.15 IN endpoint management
IN packets are sent by the USB device controller, upon an IN request from the host. All the data
can be written by the CPU, which acknowledge or not the bank when it is full.Overview
The Endpoint must be configured first.
The TXINI bit is set by hardware when the current bank becomes free. This triggers an interrupt
if the TXINE bit is set. The FIFOCON bit is set at the same time. The CPU writes into the FIFO
and clears the FIFOCON bit to allow the USB controller to send the data. If the IN Endpoint is
composed of multiple banks, this also switches to the next data bank. The TXINI and FIFOCON
bits are automatically updated by hardware regarding the status of the next bank.
TXINI shall always be cleared before clearing FIFOCON.
The RWAL bit always reflects the state of the current bank. This bit is set if the firmware can
write data to the bank, and cleared by hardware when the bank is full.
Example with 1 IN data bank
NAK DATA
IN ACK IN
(bank 0)
HW
TXINI SW SW
DATA DATA
IN ACK IN ACK
(bank 0) (bank 1)
HW
TXINI SW SW SW
FIFOCON write data from CPU SW write data from CPU SW write data from CPU
BANK 0 BANK 1 BANK0
The data are written by the CPU, following the next flow:
• When the bank is empty, an endpoint interrupt (EPINTx) is triggered, if enabled (TXINE set)
and TXINI is set. The CPU can also poll TXINI or FIFOCON, depending the software
architecture choice,
• The CPU acknowledges the interrupt by clearing TXINI,
• The CPU can write the data into the current bank (write in UEDATX),
• The CPU can free the bank by clearing FIFOCON when all the data are written, that is:
277
7593D–AVR–07/06
• after “N” write into UEDATX
• as soon as RWAL is cleared by hardware.
If the endpoint uses 2 banks, the second one can be read by the HOST while the current is
being written by the CPU. Then, when the CPU clears FIFOCON, the next bank may be already
ready (free) and TXINI is set immediately.
22.15.1.1 Abort
An “abort” stage can be produced by the host in some situations:
• In a control transaction: ZLP data OUT received during a IN stage,
• In an isochronous IN transaction: ZLP data OUT received on the OUT endpoint during a IN
stage on the IN endpoint
• ...
The KILLBK bit is used to kill the last “written” bank. The best way to manage this abort is to per-
form the following operations:
Table 22-1. Abort flow
Endpoint
Abort
No
Abort done
22.16.1 Underflow
An underflow can occur during IN stage if the host attempts to read a bank which is empty. In
this situation, the UNDERFI interrupt is triggered.
278 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
An underflow can also occur during OUT stage if the host send a packet while the banks are
already full. Typically, he CPU is not fast enough. The packet is lost.
It is not possible to have underflow error during OUT stage, in the CPU side, since the CPU
should read only if the bank is ready to give data (RXOUTI=1 or RWAL=1)
22.17 Overflow
In Control, Isochronous, Bulk or Interrupt Endpoint, an overflow can occur during OUT stage, if
the host attempts to write in a bank that is too small for the packet. In this situation, the OVERFI
interrupt is triggered (if enabled). The packet is hacknowledged and the RXOUTI interrupt is also
triggered (if enabled). The bank is filled with the first bytes of the packet.
It is not possible to have overflow error during IN stage, in the CPU side, since the CPU should
write only if the bank is ready to access data (TXINI=1 or RWAL=1).
22.18 Interrupts
The next figure shows all the interrupts sources:
There are 2 kind of interrupts: processing (i.e. their generation are part of the normal processing)
and exception (errors).
Processing interrupts are generated when:
• VBUS plug-in detection (insert, remove)(VBUSTI)
• Upstream resume(UPRSMI)
• End of resume(EORSMI)
• Wake up(WAKEUPI)
• End of reset (Speed Initialization)(EORSTI)
279
7593D–AVR–07/06
• Start of frame(SOFI, if FNCERR=0)
• Suspend detected after 3 ms of inactivity(SUSPI)
Exception Interrupts are generated when:
• CRC error in frame number of SOF(SOFI, FNCERR=1)
Endpoint 5
Endpoint 4
Endpoint 3
Endpoint 2
Endpoint 1
Endpoint 0
OVERFI
UESTAX.6
UNDERFI
FLERRE
UESTAX.5
UEIENX.7
NAKINI
UEINTX.6
NAKINE
UEIENX.6
NAKOUTI
UEINTX.4
TXSTPE
Endpoint Interrupt
UEIENX.4
RXSTPI EPINT
UEINTX.3 UEINT.X
TXOUTE
UEIENX.3
RXOUTI
UEINTX.2
RXOUTE
UEIENX.2
STALLEDI
UEINTX.1
STALLEDE
UEIENX.1
TXINI
UEINTX.0
TXINE
UEIENX.0
280 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
22.19 Registers
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
- - - - - LSM RMWKUP DETACH UDCON
Read/Write R R R R R R/W R/W R/W
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1
• 7-3 - Reserved
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not set these bits.
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
- UPRSMI EORSMI WAKEUPI EORSTI SOFI - SUSPI UDINT
Read/Write
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
• 7 - Reserved
The value read from this bits is always 0. Do not set this bit.
281
7593D–AVR–07/06
Shall be cleared by software. Setting by software has no effect.
• 1 - Reserved
The value read from this bits is always 0. Do not set this bit
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
- UPRSME EORSME WAKEUPE EORSTE SOFE - SUSPE UDIEN
Read/Write
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
• 7 - Reserved
The value read from this bits is always 0. Do not set this bit.
282 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Clear to disable the WAKEUPI interrupt.
• 1 - Reserved
The value read from this bits is always 0. Do not set this bit
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
ADDEN UADD6:0 UDADDR
Read/Write W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Initial Val- 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
ue
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
- - - - - FNUM10:8 UDFNUMH
Read/Write R R R R R R R R
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
• 7-3 - Reserved
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not set these bits.
283
7593D–AVR–07/06
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
FNUM7:0 UDFNUML
Read/Write R R R R R R R R
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
- - - FNCERR - - - - UDMFN
Read/W R
rite
Initial 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Value
• 7-5 - Reserved
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not set these bits.
• 3-0 - Reserved
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not set these bits.
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
- - - - - EPNUM2:0 UENUM
Read/Write R R R R R R/W R/W R/W
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
• 7-3 - Reserved
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not set these bits.
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
- EPRST6 EPRST5 EPRST4 EPRST3 EPRST2 EPRST1 EPRST0 UERST
Read/Write R R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
284 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
• 7 - Reserved
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not set these bits.
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
- - STALLRQ STALLRQC RSTDT - - EPEN UECONX
Read/Write R R W W W R R R/W
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
• 7-6 - Reserved
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not set these bits.
• 2 - Reserved
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not set these bits.
• 1 - Reserved
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not set these bits.
285
7593D–AVR–07/06
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
EPTYPE1:0 - - - - - EPDIR UECFG0X
Read/Write R/W R/W R R R R R R/W
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
• 5-4 - Reserved
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not set these bits.
• 1 - Reserved
The value read from this bits is always 0. Do not set this bit.
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
- EPSIZE2:0 EPBK1:0 ALLOC - UECFG1X
Read/Write R R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
• 7 - Reserved
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not set these bits.
286 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
• 1 - ALLOC - Endpoint Allocation Bit
Set this bit to allocate the endpoint memory.
Clear to free the endpoint memory.
See Section 22.7, page 270 for more details.
• 0 - Reserved
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not set these bits.
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
CFGOK OVERFI UNDERFI ZLPSEEN DTSEQ1:0 NBUSYBK1:0 UESTA0X
Read/Write R R/W R/W R/W R R R R
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
287
7593D–AVR–07/06
For IN transfer, it indicates the Toggle that will be used for the next packet to be sent. This is not
relative to the current bank.
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
- - - - - CTRLDIR CURRBK1:0 UESTA1X
Read/Write R R R R R R R R
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
• 7-3 - Reserved
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not set these bits.
• 1-0 - CURRBK1:0 - Current Bank (all endpoints except Control endpoint) Flag
Set by hardware to indicate the number of the current bank:
00b Bank0
01b Bank1
1xb Reserved.
Can not be set or cleared by software.
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
FIFOCON NAKINI RWAL NAKOUTI RXSTPI RXOUTI STALLEDI TXINI UEINTX
Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
288 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Set by hardware when a new OUT message is stored in the current bank, at the same time than
RXOUT or RXSTP.
Clear to free the current bank and to switch to the following bank. Setting by software has no
effect.
For IN Endpoint:
Set by hardware when the current bank is free, at the same time than TXIN.
Clear to send the FIFO data and to switch the bank. Setting by software has no effect.
289
7593D–AVR–07/06
• 1 - STALLEDI - STALLEDI Interrupt Flag
Set by hardware to signal that a STALL handshake has been sent, or that a CRC error has been
detected in a OUT isochronous endpoint.
Shall be cleared by software. Setting by software has no effect.
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
FLERRE NAKINE - NAKOUTE RXSTPE RXOUTE STALLEDE TXINE UEIENX
Read/Write R/W R/W R R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
• 5 - Reserved
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not set these bits.
290 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Clear to disable an endpoint interrupt (EPINTx) when TXINI is sent.
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
DAT D7 DAT D6 DAT D5 DAT D4 DAT D3 DAT D2 DAT D1 DAT D0 UEDATX
Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
- - - - - BYCT D10 BYCT D9 BYCT D8 UEBCHX
Read/Write R R R R R R R R
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
• 7-3 - Reserved
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not set these bits.
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
BYCT D7 BYCT D6 BYCT D5 BYCT D4 BYCT D3 BYCT D2 BYCT D1 BYCT D0 UEBCLX
Read/Write R R R R R R R R
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
- EPINT D6 EPINT D5 EPINT D4 EPINT D3 EPINT D2 EPINT D1 EPINT D0 UEINT
Read/Write R R R R R R R R
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
• 7 - Reserved
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not set these bits.
291
7593D–AVR–07/06
Cleared by hardware when the interrupt source is served.
292 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
23. USB Host Operating Modes
In the USB Host controller, a Pipe will be associated to a Device Endpoint, considering the
Device Configuration Descriptors.
23.2 Detach
The reset value of the DETACH bit is 1. Thus, the firmware has the responsibility of clearing this
bit before switching to the Host mode (HOST set).
Device
connection
Device
disconnection
Host
Ready
SOFE=0
SOFE=1 Host
Suspend
293
7593D–AVR–07/06
USB host controller state after an hardware reset is ‘Reset’. When the USB controller is enabled
and the USB Host controller is selected, the USB controller is in ‘Idle’ state. In this state, the
USB Host controller waits for the Device connection, with a minimum power consumption.
The USB Pad should be in Idle mode. The macro does not need to have the PLL activated to
enter in ‘Host Ready’ state.
The Host controller enters in Suspend state when the USB bus is in Suspend state, i.e. when the
Host controller doesn’t generate the Start of Frame. In this state, the USB consumption is mini-
mum. The Host controller exits to the Suspend state when starting to generate the SOF over the
USB line.
294 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Figure 23-3. Pipe activation flow:
Pipe
Activ ation
UPCONX Enablethepipe
PENABLE=1
UPCFG0X SelectthePipetype:
PTYPE * Type(Control,Bulk,Interrupt)
PTOKEN * Token(IN,OUT ,SET UP)
PEPNUM * Endpointnumber
UPCFG1X ConfigurethePipememory:
PSIZE * Pipesize
PBK * Numberofbanks
CFGMEM
CFGOK=1 No
Y es
ERROR
UPCFG2X
INT FRQ
(interruptonly) Configurethepollinginterval
forInterruptpipe
Pipeactiv ated
and f reezed
Once the Pipe is activated (EPEN set) and, the hardware is ready to send requests to the
Device.
When configured (CFGOK = 1), only the Pipe Token (PTOKEN) and the polling interval for Inter-
rupt pipe can be modified.
A Control type pipe supports only 1 bank. Any other value will lead to a configuration error
(CFGOK = 0).
A clear of PEN will reset the configuration of the Pipe. All the corresponding Pipe registers are
reset to there reset values. Please refers to the Memory Management chapter for more details.
Note: The firmware has to configure the Default Control Pipe with the following parameters:
• Type: Control
• Token: SETUP
• Data bank: 1
• Size: 64 Bytes
The firmware asks for 8 bytes of the Device Descriptor sending a GET_DESCRIPTOR request.
These bytes contains the MaxPacketSize of the Device default control endpoint and the firm-
ware re-configures the size of the Default Control Pipe with this size parameter.
295
7593D–AVR–07/06
23.7 USB Reset
The USB controller sends a USB Reset when the firmware set the RESET bit. The RSTI bit is
set by hardware when the USB Reset has been sent. This triggers an interrupt if the RSTE has
been set.
When a USB Reset has been sent, all the Pipe configuration and the memory allocation are
reset. The General Host interrupt enable register is left unchanged.
If the bus was previously in suspend mode (SOFEN = 0), the USB controller automatically
switches to the resume mode (HWUPI is set) and the SOFEN bit is set by hardware in order to
generate SOF immediately after the USB Reset.
Host
Ready
SOFE=0
SOFE=1 Host
or HWUP=1 Suspend
296 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
23.12 Control Pipe management
A Control transaction is composed of 3 phases:
• SETUP
• Data (IN or OUT)
• Status (OUT or IN)
The firmware has to change the Token for each phase.
The initial data toggle is set for the corresponding token (ONLY for Control Pipe):
• SETUP: Data0
• OUT: Data1
• IN: Data1 (expected data toggle)
297
7593D–AVR–07/06
If the OUT Pipe is composed of multiple banks, this also switches to the next data bank. The
TXOUT and FIFOCON bits are automatically updated by hardware regarding the status of the
next bank.
Example with 1 OUT data bank
DATA
OUT ACK OUT
(bank 0)
HW
TXOUT SW SW
FIFOCON SW SW
write data from CPU write data from CPU
BANK 0 BANK 0
DATA DATA
OUT ACK OUT ACK
(bank 0) (bank 1)
HW
TXOUT SW SW SW
FIFOCON SW SW
write data from CPU write data from CPU write data from CPU
BANK 0 BANK 1 BANK0
DATA DATA
OUT ACK OUT ACK
(bank 0) (bank 1)
HW
TXOUT SW SW SW
FIFOCON SW
write data from CPU write data from CPU SW write data from CPU
BANK 0 BANK 1 BANK0
298 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Each time the current bank is full, the RXIN and the FIFOCON bits are set. This triggers an inter-
rupt if the RXINE bit is set. The firmware can acknowledge the USB interrupt by clearing the
RXIN bit. The Firmware read the data and clear the FIFOCON bit in order to free the current
bank. If the IN Pipe is composed of multiple banks, clearing the FIFOCON bit will switch to the
next bank. The RXIN and FIFOCON bits are then updated by hardware in accordance with the
status of the new bank.
Example with 1 IN data bank
DATA DATA
IN ACK IN ACK
(to bank 0) (to bank 0)
HW HW
RXIN SW SW
FIFOCON SW
read data from CPU read data from CPU
BANK 0 BANK 0
DATA DATA
IN ACK IN ACK
(to bank 0) (to bank 1)
HW HW
RXIN SW SW
FIFOCON SW
read data from CPU read data from CPU
BANK 0 BANK 1
299
7593D–AVR–07/06
Figure 23-4. USB Host Controller Interrupt System
HWUPI
UHINT.6
HWUPE
UHIEN.6
HSOFI
UHINT.5
HSOFE
UHIEN.5
RXRSMI
UHINT.4
RXRSME
UHIEN.4
USB Host
RSMEDI Interrupt
UHINT.3
RSMEDE
UHIEN.3
RSTI
UHINT.2
RSTE
UHIEN.2
DDISCI
UHINT.1
DDISCE
UHIEN.1
DCONNI
UHINT.0
DCONNE
UHIEN.0
PIPE 5
PIPE 4
PIPE 3
PIPE 2
PIPE 1
OVERFI PIPE 0
UPSTAX.6
UNDERFI
FLERRE
UPSTAX.5
UPIEN.7
NAKEDI
UPINTX.6
NAKEDE
UPIEN.6
PERRI
UPINTX.4
PERRE Pipe Interrupt
UPIEN.4
TXSTPI FLERRE
UPINTX.3 UPIEN.7
TXSTPE
UPIEN.3
TXOUTI
UPINTX.2
TXOUTE
UPIEN.2
RXSTALLI
UPINTX.1
RXSTALLE
UPIEN.1
RXINI
UPINTX.0
RXINE
UPIEN.0
23.16 Registers
300 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
23.16.1 General USB Host registers
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
- - - - - RESUME RESET SOFEN UHCON
Read/Write R R R R R R/W R/W R/W
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
• 7-3 - Reserved
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not set these bits.
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
- HWUP HSOF RXRSMI RSMEDI RSTI DDISCI DCONNI UHINT
Read/Write R R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
• 7 - Reserved
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not set these bits.
• 6 - HWUP
Host Wake-Up Interrupt
Set by hardware when a non-idle state is detected on the USB bus.
Shall be clear by software to acknowledge the interrupt. Setting by software has no effect.
301
7593D–AVR–07/06
Set by hardware when an Upstream Resume has been received from the Device.
Shall be cleared by software. Setting by software has no effect.
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
HWUPE HSOFE RXRSME RSMEDE RSTE DDISCE DCONNE UHIEN
Read/Write R R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
• 7 - Reserved
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not set these bits.
302 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Set this bit to enable the RSTI interrupt.
Clear this bit to disable the RSTI interrupt.
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
HADDR6 HADDR5 HADDR4 HADDR3 HADDR2 HADDR1 HADDR0 HADDR6 UHADDR
Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
• 7 - Reserved
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not set these bits.
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
- - - - - FNUM10 FNUM9 FNUM8 UHFNUMH
Read/Write R R R R R R R R
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
• 7-4 - Reserved
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not set these bits.
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
FNUM7 FNUM6 FNUM5 FNUM4 FNUM3 FNUM2 FNUM1 FNUM0 UHFNUML
Read/Write R R R R R R R R
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
303
7593D–AVR–07/06
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
FLEN7 FLEN6 FLEN5 FLEN4 FLEN3 FLEN2 FLEN1 FLEN0 UHFLEN
Read/Write R R R R R R R R
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
PNUM2 PNUM1 PNUM0 UPNUM
Read/Write RW RW RW
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
• 7-3 - Reserved
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not set these bits.
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
- P6RST P5RST P4RST P3RST P2RST P1RST P0RST UPRST
Read/Write RW RW RW RW RW RW RW
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
• 7 - Reserved
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not set these bits.
304 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
• 1 - P1RST - Pipe 1 Reset
Set this bit to 1 and reset this bit to 0 to reset the Pipe 1.
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
- PFREEZE INMODE - RSTDT - - PEN UPCONX
Read/Write RW RW RW RW
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
• 7 - Reserved
The value read from this bit is always 0. Do not set this bit.
• 4 - Reserved
The value read from this bit is always 0. Do not set this bit.
• 2 - Reserved
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not set these bits.
• 1 - Reserved
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not set these bits.
305
7593D–AVR–07/06
Clear to disable and reset the Pipe.
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
PTYPE1 PTYPE0 PTOKEN1 PTOKEN0 PEPNUM3 PEPNUM2 PEPNUM1 PEPNUM0 UPCFG0X
Read/Write RW RW RW RW RW RW RW RW
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
- PSIZE2:0 PBK1:0 ALLOC - UPCFG1X
Read/Write R RW RW RW RW RW RW
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
• 7 - Reserved
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not set these bits.
306 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
- 110: 512
- 111: 1024
• ALLOC
Configure Pipe Memory
Set to configure the pipe memory with the characteristics.
Clear to update the memory allocation. Refer to the Memory Management chapter for more
details.
7 - Reserved
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not set these bits.
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
INTFRQ7 INTFRQ6 INTFRQ5 INTFRQ4 INTFRQ3 INTFRQ2 INTFRQ1 INTFRQ0 UPCFG2X
Read/Write RW RW RW RW RW RW RW RW
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
CFGOK OVERFI UNDERFI - DTSEQ1:0 NBUSYBK UPSTAX
Read/Write R RW RW R R R R
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
• 6 - OVERFI - Overflow
Set by hardware when a the current Pipe has received more data than the maximum length of
the current Pipe. An interrupt is triggered if the FLERRE bit is set.
Shall be cleared by software. Setting by software has no effect.
• 5 - UNDERFI - Underflow
307
7593D–AVR–07/06
Set by hardware when a transaction underflow occurs in the current isochronous or interrupt
Pipe. The Pipe can’t send the data flow required by the device. A ZLP will be sent instead. An
interrupt is triggered if the FLERRE bit is set.
Shall be cleared by software. Setting by software has no effect.
Note: the Host controller has to send a OUT packet, but the bank is empty. A ZLP will be sent
and the UNDERFI bit is set
underflow for interrupt Pipe:
• 4 - Reserved
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not set these bits.
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
INRQ7 INRQ6 INRQ5 INRQ4 INRQ3 INRQ2 INRQ1 INRQ0 UPINRQX
Read/Write RW RW RW RW RW RW RW RW
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
308 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
- COUNTER1:0 CRC16 TIMEOUT PID DATAPID DATATGL UPERRX
Read/Write RW RW RW RW RW RW RW
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
• 7-6 - Reserved
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not set these bits.
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
FIFOCON NAKEDI RWAL PERRI TXSTPI TXOUTI RXSTALLI RXINI UPINTX
Read/Write RW RW RW RW RW RW RW RW
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
309
7593D–AVR–07/06
For IN Pipe:
Set by hardware when a new IN message is stored in the current bank, at the same time than
RXIN.
Clear to free the current bank and to switch to the following bank. Setting by software has no
effect.
310 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Shall be cleared to handshake the interrupt. Setting by software has no effect.
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
FLERRE NAKEDE - PERRE TXSTPE TXOUTE RXSTALLE RXINE UPIENX
Read/Write RW RW RW RW RW RW RW
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
• 5 - Reserved
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not set these bits.
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
PDAT7 PDAT6 PDAT5 PDAT4 PDAT3 PDAT2 PDAT1 PDAT0 UPDATX
311
7593D–AVR–07/06
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Read/Write RW RW RW RW RW RW RW RW
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
- - - - - PBYCT10 PBYCT9 PBYCT8 UPBCHX
Read/Write R R R
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
• 7-3 - Reserved
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not set these bits.
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
PBYCT7 PBYCT6 PBYCT5 PBYCT4 PBYCT3 PBYCT2 PBYCT1 PBYCT0 UPBCLX
Read/Write R R R R R R R R
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
- PINT6 PINT5 PINT4 PINT3 PINT2 PINT1 PINT0 UPINT
Read/Write
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
• 7 - Reserved
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not set these bits.
312 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
24. Analog Comparator
The Analog Comparator compares the input values on the positive pin AIN0 and negative pin
AIN1. When the voltage on the positive pin AIN0 is higher than the voltage on the negative pin
AIN1, the Analog Comparator output, ACO, is set. The comparator’s output can be set to trigger
the Timer/Counter1 Input Capture function. In addition, the comparator can trigger a separate
interrupt, exclusive to the Analog Comparator. The user can select Interrupt triggering on com-
parator output rise, fall or toggle. A block diagram of the comparator and its surrounding logic is
shown in Figure 24-1.
The Power Reduction ADC bit, PRADC, in “Power Reduction Register 0 - PRR0” on page 56
must be disabled by writing a logical zero to be able to use the ADC input MUX.
ACBG
ACME
ADEN
ADC MULTIPLEXER
OUTPUT (1)
313
7593D–AVR–07/06
When this bit is written logic one, the power to the Analog Comparator is switched off. This bit
can be set at any time to turn off the Analog Comparator. This will reduce power consumption in
Active and Idle mode. When changing the ACD bit, the Analog Comparator Interrupt must be
disabled by clearing the ACIE bit in ACSR. Otherwise an interrupt can occur when the bit is
changed.
When changing the ACIS1/ACIS0 bits, the Analog Comparator Interrupt must be disabled by
clearing its Interrupt Enable bit in the ACSR Register. Otherwise an interrupt can occur when the
bits are changed.
314 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
24.1 Analog Comparator Multiplexed Input
It is possible to select any of the ADC15..0 pins to replace the negative input to the Analog Com-
parator. The ADC multiplexer is used to select this input, and consequently, the ADC must be
switched off to utilize this feature. If the Analog Comparator Multiplexer Enable bit (ACME in
ADCSRB) is set and the ADC is switched off (ADEN in ADCSRA is zero), and MUX2..0 in
ADMUX select the input pin to replace the negative input to the Analog Comparator, as shown in
Table 24-2. If ACME is cleared or ADEN is set, AIN1 is applied to the negative input to the Ana-
log Comparator.
315
7593D–AVR–07/06
25. Analog to Digital Converter - ADC
25.1 Features
• 10-bit Resolution
• 0.5 LSB Integral Non-linearity
• ± 2 LSB Absolute Accuracy
• 65 - 260 µs Conversion Time
• Up to 15 kSPS at Maximum Resolution
• Eight Multiplexed Single Ended Input Channels
• Seven Differential input channels
• Optional Left Adjustment for ADC Result Readout
• 0 - VCC ADC Input Voltage Range
• Selectable 2.56 V ADC Reference Voltage
• Free Running or Single Conversion Mode
• ADC Start Conversion by Auto Triggering on Interrupt Sources
• Interrupt on ADC Conversion Complete
• Sleep Mode Noise Canceler
The AT90USB64/128 features a 10-bit successive approximation ADC. The ADC is connected
to an 8-channel Analog Multiplexer which allows eight single-ended voltage inputs constructed
from the pins of Port A. The single-ended voltage inputs refer to 0V (GND).
The device also supports 16 differential voltage input combinations. Two of the differential inputs
(ADC1, ADC0 and ADC3, ADC2) are equipped with a programmable gain stage, providing
amplification steps of 0 dB (1x), 20 dB (10x), or 46 dB (200x) on the differential input voltage
before the A/D conversion. Seven differential analog input channels share a common negative
terminal (ADC1), while any other ADC input can be selected as the positive input terminal. If 1x
or 10x gain is used, 8-bit resolution can be expected. If 200x gain is used, 7-bit resolution can be
expected.
The ADC contains a Sample and Hold circuit which ensures that the input voltage to the ADC is
held at a constant level during conversion. A block diagram of the ADC is shown in Figure 25-1.
The ADC has a separate analog supply voltage pin, AVCC. AVCC must not differ more than ±
0.3V from VCC. See the paragraph “ADC Noise Canceler” on page 323 on how to connect this
pin.
Internal reference voltages of nominally 2.56V or AVCC are provided On-chip. The voltage refer-
ence may be externally decoupled at the AREF pin by a capacitor for better noise performance.
316 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Figure 25-1. Analog to Digital Converter Block Schematic
ADC CONVERSION
COMPLETE IRQ
INTERRUPT
FLAGS
ADTS[2:0]
8-BIT DATA BUS
ADIE
ADIF
15 0
ADC MULTIPLEXER ADC CTRL. & STATUS ADC DATA REGISTER
SELECT (ADMUX) REGISTER (ADCSRA) (ADCH/ADCL)
REFS1
REFS0
ADLAR
MUX4
MUX3
MUX2
MUX1
MUX0
ADEN
ADSC
ADATE
ADPS2
ADPS1
ADPS0
ADIF
ADC[9:0]
TRIGGER
SELECT
MUX DECODER
PRESCALER
CHANNEL SELECTION
START
INTERNAL
REFERENCE SAMPLE & HOLD
COMPARATOR
AREF 10-BIT DAC -
+
ADHSM
GND
BANDGAP
REFERENCE
ADC7
SINGLE ENDED / DIFFERENTIAL SELECTION
ADC6
POS. ADC MULTIPLEXER
ADC5 INPUT OUTPUT
MUX
ADC4
ADC3 DIFFERENTIAL
AMPLIFIER
+
ADC2
-
ADC1
ADC0
NEG.
INPUT
MUX
25.2 Operation
The ADC converts an analog input voltage to a 10-bit digital value through successive approxi-
mation. The minimum value represents GND and the maximum value represents the voltage on
317
7593D–AVR–07/06
the AREF pin minus 1 LSB. Optionally, AVCC or an internal 2.56V reference voltage may be con-
nected to the AREF pin by writing to the REFSn bits in the ADMUX Register. The internal
voltage reference may thus be decoupled by an external capacitor at the AREF pin to improve
noise immunity.
The analog input channel and differential gain are selected by writing to the MUX bits in
ADMUX. Any of the ADC input pins, as well as GND and a fixed bandgap voltage reference, can
be selected as single ended inputs to the ADC. A selection of ADC input pins can be selected as
positive and negative inputs to the differential amplifier.
The ADC is enabled by setting the ADC Enable bit, ADEN in ADCSRA. Voltage reference and
input channel selections will not go into effect until ADEN is set. The ADC does not consume
power when ADEN is cleared, so it is recommended to switch off the ADC before entering power
saving sleep modes.
The ADC generates a 10-bit result which is presented in the ADC Data Registers, ADCH and
ADCL. By default, the result is presented right adjusted, but can optionally be presented left
adjusted by setting the ADLAR bit in ADMUX.
If the result is left adjusted and no more than 8-bit precision is required, it is sufficient to read
ADCH. Otherwise, ADCL must be read first, then ADCH, to ensure that the content of the Data
Registers belongs to the same conversion. Once ADCL is read, ADC access to Data Registers
is blocked. This means that if ADCL has been read, and a conversion completes before ADCH is
read, neither register is updated and the result from the conversion is lost. When ADCH is read,
ADC access to the ADCH and ADCL Registers is re-enabled.
The ADC has its own interrupt which can be triggered when a conversion completes. The ADC
access to the Data Registers is prohibited between reading of ADCH and ADCL, the interrupt
will trigger even if the result is lost.
318 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Figure 25-2. ADC Auto Trigger Logic
ADTS[2:0]
PRESCALER
START CLKADC
ADIF ADATE
SOURCE 1
. CONVERSION
. LOGIC
.
. EDGE
SOURCE n DETECTOR
ADSC
Using the ADC Interrupt Flag as a trigger source makes the ADC start a new conversion as soon
as the ongoing conversion has finished. The ADC then operates in Free Running mode, con-
stantly sampling and updating the ADC Data Register. The first conversion must be started by
writing a logical one to the ADSC bit in ADCSRA. In this mode the ADC will perform successive
conversions independently of whether the ADC Interrupt Flag, ADIF is cleared or not.
If Auto Triggering is enabled, single conversions can be started by writing ADSC in ADCSRA to
one. ADSC can also be used to determine if a conversion is in progress. The ADSC bit will be
read as one during a conversion, independently of how the conversion was started.
ADEN
START Reset
7-BIT ADC PRESCALER
CK CK/128
CK/64
CK/32
CK/16
CK/2
CK/4
CK/8
ADPS0
ADPS1
ADPS2
By default, the successive approximation circuitry requires an input clock frequency between 50
kHz and 200 kHz to get maximum resolution. If a lower resolution than 10 bits is needed, the
input clock frequency to the ADC can be higher than 200 kHz to get a higher sample rate. Alter-
natively, setting the ADHSM bit in ADCSRB allows an increased ADC clock frequency at the
expense of higher power consumption.
The ADC module contains a prescaler, which generates an acceptable ADC clock frequency
from any CPU frequency above 100 kHz. The prescaling is set by the ADPS bits in ADCSRA.
The prescaler starts counting from the moment the ADC is switched on by setting the ADEN bit
319
7593D–AVR–07/06
in ADCSRA. The prescaler keeps running for as long as the ADEN bit is set, and is continuously
reset when ADEN is low.
When initiating a single ended conversion by setting the ADSC bit in ADCSRA, the conversion
starts at the following rising edge of the ADC clock cycle. See “Differential Channels” on page
321 for details on differential conversion timing.
A normal conversion takes 13 ADC clock cycles. The first conversion after the ADC is switched
on (ADEN in ADCSRA is set) takes 25 ADC clock cycles in order to initialize the analog circuitry.
The actual sample-and-hold takes place 1.5 ADC clock cycles after the start of a normal conver-
sion and 13.5 ADC clock cycles after the start of an first conversion. When a conversion is
complete, the result is written to the ADC Data Registers, and ADIF is set. In Single Conversion
mode, ADSC is cleared simultaneously. The software may then set ADSC again, and a new
conversion will be initiated on the first rising ADC clock edge.
When Auto Triggering is used, the prescaler is reset when the trigger event occurs. This assures
a fixed delay from the trigger event to the start of conversion. In this mode, the sample-and-hold
takes place two ADC clock cycles after the rising edge on the trigger source signal. Three addi-
tional CPU clock cycles are used for synchronization logic.
In Free Running mode, a new conversion will be started immediately after the conversion com-
pletes, while ADSC remains high. For a summary of conversion times, see Table 25-1.
Figure 25-4. ADC Timing Diagram, First Conversion (Single Conversion Mode)
Next
First Conversion Conversion
Cycle Number 1 2 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 1 2 3
ADC Clock
ADEN
ADSC
ADIF
MUX
MUX and REFS Conversion and REFS
Update Sample & Hold Complete Update
Cycle Number 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 1 2 3
ADC Clock
ADSC
ADIF
320 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Figure 25-6. ADC Timing Diagram, Auto Triggered Conversion
One Conversion Next Conversion
Cycle Number 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 1 2
ADC Clock
Trigger
Source
ADATE
ADIF
11 12 13 1 2 3 4
Cycle Number
ADC Clock
ADSC
ADIF
321
7593D–AVR–07/06
clock cycles due to the synchronization mechanism. In Free Running mode, a new conversion is
initiated immediately after the previous conversion completes, and since CKADC2 is high at this
time, all automatically started (i.e., all but the first) Free Running conversions will take 14 ADC
clock cycles.
If differential channels are used and conversions are started by Auto Triggering, the ADC must
be switched off between conversions. When Auto Triggering is used, the ADC prescaler is reset
before the conversion is started. Since the stage is dependent of a stable ADC clock prior to the
conversion, this conversion will not be valid. By disabling and then re-enabling the ADC between
each conversion (writing ADEN in ADCSRA to “0” then to “1”), only extended conversions are
performed. The result from the extended conversions will be valid. See “Prescaling and Conver-
sion Timing” on page 319 for timing details.
The gain stage is optimized for a bandwidth of 4 kHz at all gain settings. Higher frequencies may
be subjected to non-linear amplification. An external low-pass filter should be used if the input
signal contains higher frequency components than the gain stage bandwidth. Note that the ADC
clock frequency is independent of the gain stage bandwidth limitation. E.g. the ADC clock period
may be 6 µs, allowing a channel to be sampled at 12 kSPS, regardless of the bandwidth of this
channel.
322 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
The settling time and gain stage bandwidth is independent of the ADHSM bit setting.
323
7593D–AVR–07/06
a. Make sure that the ADC is enabled and is not busy converting. Single Conversion
mode must be selected and the ADC conversion complete interrupt must be
enabled.
b. Enter ADC Noise Reduction mode (or Idle mode). The ADC will start a conversion
once the CPU has been halted.
c. If no other interrupts occur before the ADC conversion completes, the ADC inter-
rupt will wake up the CPU and execute the ADC Conversion Complete interrupt
routine. If another interrupt wakes up the CPU before the ADC conversion is com-
plete, that interrupt will be executed, and an ADC Conversion Complete interrupt
request will be generated when the ADC conversion completes. The CPU will
remain in active mode until a new sleep command is executed.
Note that the ADC will not be automatically turned off when entering other sleep modes than Idle
mode and ADC Noise Reduction mode. The user is advised to write zero to ADEN before enter-
ing such sleep modes to avoid excessive power consumption.
If the ADC is enabled in such sleep modes and the user wants to perform differential conver-
sions, the user is advised to switch the ADC off and on after waking up from sleep to prompt an
extended conversion to get a valid result.
IIH
ADCn
1..100 kΩ
CS/H= 14 pF
IIL
VCC/2
324 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
25.6.2 Analog Noise Canceling Techniques
Digital circuitry inside and outside the device generates EMI which might affect the accuracy of
analog measurements. If conversion accuracy is critical, the noise level can be reduced by
applying the following techniques:
a. Keep analog signal paths as short as possible. Make sure analog tracks run over
the analog ground plane, and keep them well away from high-speed switching digi-
tal tracks.
b. The AVCC pin on the device should be connected to the digital VCC supply voltage
via an LC network as shown in Figure 25-9.
c. Use the ADC noise canceler function to reduce induced noise from the CPU.
d. If any ADC port pins are used as digital outputs, it is essential that these do not
switch while a conversion is in progress.
(AD0) PA0 51
VCC
52
GND 53
(ADC7) PF7 54
(ADC6) PF6 55
(ADC5) PF5 56
(ADC4) PF4 57
(ADC3) PF3 58
(ADC2) PF2 59
(ADC1) PF1 60
(ADC0) PF0 61
10μH
AREF 62
GND
63
AVCC
64
100nF
1
Analog Ground Plane
NC
325
7593D–AVR–07/06
• Offset: The deviation of the first transition (0x000 to 0x001) compared to the ideal transition
(at 0.5 LSB). Ideal value: 0 LSB.
Output Code
Ideal ADC
Actual ADC
Offset
Error
VREF Input Voltage
• Gain Error: After adjusting for offset, the Gain Error is found as the deviation of the last
transition (0x3FE to 0x3FF) compared to the ideal transition (at 1.5 LSB below maximum).
Ideal value: 0 LSB
Ideal ADC
Actual ADC
• Integral Non-linearity (INL): After adjusting for offset and gain error, the INL is the maximum
deviation of an actual transition compared to an ideal transition for any code. Ideal value: 0
LSB.
326 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Figure 25-12. Integral Non-linearity (INL)
Output Code
INL
Ideal ADC
Actual ADC
• Differential Non-linearity (DNL): The maximum deviation of the actual code width (the interval
between two adjacent transitions) from the ideal code width (1 LSB). Ideal value: 0 LSB.
1 LSB
DNL
0x000
• Quantization Error: Due to the quantization of the input voltage into a finite number of codes,
a range of input voltages (1 LSB wide) will code to the same value. Always ± 0.5 LSB.
• Absolute Accuracy: The maximum deviation of an actual (unadjusted) transition compared to
an ideal transition for any code. This is the compound effect of offset, gain error, differential
error, non-linearity, and quantization error. Ideal value: ± 0.5 LSB.
327
7593D–AVR–07/06
V IN ⋅ 1023
ADC = --------------------------
V REF
where VIN is the voltage on the selected input pin and VREF the selected voltage reference (see
Table 25-3 on page 330 and Table 25-4 on page 330). 0x000 represents analog ground, and
0x3FF represents the selected reference voltage minus one LSB.
If differential channels are used, the result is:
( V POS – V NEG ) ⋅ GAIN ⋅ 512
ADC = ------------------------------------------------------------------------
V REF
where VPOS is the voltage on the positive input pin, VNEG the voltage on the negative input pin,
GAIN the selected gain factor and VREF the selected voltage reference. The result is presented
in two’s complement form, from 0x200 (-512d) through 0x1FF (+511d). Note that if the user
wants to perform a quick polarity check of the result, it is sufficient to read the MSB of the result
(ADC9 in ADCH). If the bit is one, the result is negative, and if this bit is zero, the result is posi-
tive. Figure 25-14 shows the decoding of the differential input range.
Table 82 shows the resulting output codes if the differential input channel pair (ADCn - ADCm) is
selected with a reference voltage of VREF.
Output Code
0x1FF
0x000
0x200
328 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Example 1:
– ADMUX = 0xED (ADC3 - ADC2, 10x gain, 2.56V reference, left adjusted result)
– Voltage on ADC3 is 300 mV, voltage on ADC2 is 500 mV.
– ADCR = 512 * 10 * (300 - 500) / 2560 = -400 = 0x270
– ADCL will thus read 0x00, and ADCH will read 0x9C.
Writing zero to ADLAR right adjusts the result: ADCL = 0x70, ADCH = 0x02.
Example 2:
– ADMUX = 0xFB (ADC3 - ADC2, 1x gain, 2.56V reference, left adjusted result)
– Voltage on ADC3 is 300 mV, voltage on ADC2 is 500 mV.
– ADCR = 512 * 1 * (300 - 500) / 2560 = -41 = 0x029.
– ADCL will thus read 0x40, and ADCH will read 0x0A.
Writing zero to ADLAR right adjusts the result: ADCL = 0x00, ADCH = 0x29.
329
7593D–AVR–07/06
(ADIF in ADCSRA is set). The internal voltage reference options may not be used if an external
reference voltage is being applied to the AREF pin.
330 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Table 25-4. Input Channel and Gain Selections (Continued)
Single Ended Positive Differential Negative Differential
MUX4..0 Input Input Input Gain
01000 (ADC0 / ADC0 / 10x)
01001 ADC1 ADC0 10x
01010 (ADC0 / ADC0 / 200x)
01011 ADC1 ADC0 200x
01100 (Reserved - ADC2 / ADC2 / 10x)
01101 ADC3 ADC2 10x
01110 (ADC2 / ADC2 / 200x)
01111 ADC3 ADC2 200x
10000 ADC0 ADC1 1x
10001 (ADC1 / ADC1 / 1x)
10010 ADC2 ADC1 1x
N/A
10011 ADC3 ADC1 1x
10100 ADC4 ADC1 1x
10101 ADC5 ADC1 1x
10110 ADC6 ADC1 1x
10111 ADC7 ADC1 1x
11000 ADC0 ADC2 1x
11001 ADC1 ADC2 1x
11010 (ADC2 / ADC2 / 1x)
11011 ADC3 ADC2 1x
11100 ADC4 ADC2 1x
11101 ADC5 ADC2 1x
11110 1.1V (VBand Gap)
N/A
11111 0V (GND)
331
7593D–AVR–07/06
will take 25 ADC clock cycles instead of the normal 13. This first conversion performs initializa-
tion of the ADC.
ADSC will read as one as long as a conversion is in progress. When the conversion is complete,
it returns to zero. Writing zero to this bit has no effect.
25.8.3.1 ADLAR = 0
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8
– – – – – – ADC9 ADC8 ADCH
ADC7 ADC6 ADC5 ADC4 ADC3 ADC2 ADC1 ADC0 ADCL
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Read/Write R R R R R R R R
R R R R R R R R
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
332 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
25.8.3.2 ADLAR = 1
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8
ADC9 ADC8 ADC7 ADC6 ADC5 ADC4 ADC3 ADC2 ADCH
ADC1 ADC0 – – – – – – ADCL
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Read/Write R R R R R R R R
R R R R R R R R
Initial Value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
When an ADC conversion is complete, the result is found in these two registers. If differential
channels are used, the result is presented in two’s complement form.
When ADCL is read, the ADC Data Register is not updated until ADCH is read. Consequently, if
the result is left adjusted and no more than 8-bit precision (7 bit + sign bit for differential input
channels) is required, it is sufficient to read ADCH. Otherwise, ADCL must be read first, then
ADCH.
The ADLAR bit in ADMUX, and the MUXn bits in ADMUX affect the way the result is read from
the registers. If ADLAR is set, the result is left adjusted. If ADLAR is cleared (default), the result
is right adjusted.
333
7593D–AVR–07/06
Table 25-6. ADC Auto Trigger Source Selections
ADTS2 ADTS1 ADTS0 Trigger Source
1 0 0 Timer/Counter0 Overflow
1 0 1 Timer/Counter1 Compare Match B
1 1 0 Timer/Counter1 Overflow
1 1 1 Timer/Counter1 Capture Event
334 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
26. JTAG Interface and On-chip Debug System
26.0.1 Features
• JTAG (IEEE std. 1149.1 Compliant) Interface
• Boundary-scan Capabilities According to the IEEE std. 1149.1 (JTAG) Standard
• Debugger Access to:
– All Internal Peripheral Units
– Internal and External RAM
– The Internal Register File
– Program Counter
– EEPROM and Flash Memories
• Extensive On-chip Debug Support for Break Conditions, Including
– AVR Break Instruction
– Break on Change of Program Memory Flow
– Single Step Break
– Program Memory Break Points on Single Address or Address Range
– Data Memory Break Points on Single Address or Address Range
• Programming of Flash, EEPROM, Fuses, and Lock Bits through the JTAG Interface
• On-chip Debugging Supported by AVR Studio®
26.1 Overview
The AVR IEEE std. 1149.1 compliant JTAG interface can be used for
• Testing PCBs by using the JTAG Boundary-scan capability
• Programming the non-volatile memories, Fuses and Lock bits
• On-chip debugging
A brief description is given in the following sections. Detailed descriptions for Programming via
the JTAG interface, and using the Boundary-scan Chain can be found in the sections “Program-
ming via the JTAG Interface” on page 387 and “IEEE 1149.1 (JTAG) Boundary-scan” on page
341, respectively. The On-chip Debug support is considered being private JTAG instructions,
and distributed within ATMEL and to selected third party vendors only.
Figure 26-1 shows a block diagram of the JTAG interface and the On-chip Debug system. The
TAP Controller is a state machine controlled by the TCK and TMS signals. The TAP Controller
selects either the JTAG Instruction Register or one of several Data Registers as the scan chain
(Shift Register) between the TDI – input and TDO – output. The Instruction Register holds JTAG
instructions controlling the behavior of a Data Register.
The ID-Register, Bypass Register, and the Boundary-scan Chain are the Data Registers used
for board-level testing. The JTAG Programming Interface (actually consisting of several physical
and virtual Data Registers) is used for serial programming via the JTAG interface. The Internal
Scan Chain and Break Point Scan Chain are used for On-chip debugging only.
335
7593D–AVR–07/06
• TDI: Test Data In. Serial input data to be shifted in to the Instruction Register or Data Register
(Scan Chains).
• TDO: Test Data Out. Serial output data from Instruction Register or Data Register.
The IEEE std. 1149.1 also specifies an optional TAP signal; TRST – Test ReSeT – which is not
provided.
When the JTAGEN Fuse is unprogrammed, these four TAP pins are normal port pins, and the
TAP controller is in reset. When programmed, the input TAP signals are internally pulled high
and the JTAG is enabled for Boundary-scan and programming. The device is shipped with this
fuse programmed.
For the On-chip Debug system, in addition to the JTAG interface pins, the RESET pin is moni-
tored by the debugger to be able to detect external reset sources. The debugger can also pull
the RESET pin low to reset the whole system, assuming only open collectors on the reset line
are used in the application.
DEVICE BOUNDARY
TDI
JTAG PROGRAMMING
TDO TAP INTERFACE
TCK CONTROLLER
TMS
AVR CPU
INTERNAL
FLASH Address SCAN PC
INSTRUCTION MEMORY Data CHAIN Instruction
REGISTER
ID
REGISTER BREAKPOINT
UNIT
M FLOW CONTROL
U BYPASS
UNIT
X REGISTER DIGITAL
ANALOG
PERIPHERAL Analog inputs
PERIPHERIAL
UNITS
UNITS
BREAKPOINT
SCAN CHAIN
JTAG / AVR CORE
COMMUNICATION
ADDRESS INTERFACE
DECODER OCD STATUS
AND CONTROL
I/O PORT n
336 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Figure 26-2. TAP Controller State Diagram
1 Test-Logic-Reset
0 1 1 1
Run-Test/Idle Select-DR Scan Select-IR Scan
0 0
1 1
Capture-DR Capture-IR
0 0
Shift-DR 0 Shift-IR 0
1 1
1 1
Exit1-DR Exit1-IR
0 0
Pause-DR 0 Pause-IR 0
1 1
0 0
Exit2-DR Exit2-IR
1 1
Update-DR Update-IR
1 0 1 0
337
7593D–AVR–07/06
• Apply the TMS sequence 1, 1, 0 to re-enter the Run-Test/Idle state. The instruction is latched
onto the parallel output from the Shift Register path in the Update-IR state. The Exit-IR,
Pause-IR, and Exit2-IR states are only used for navigating the state machine.
• At the TMS input, apply the sequence 1, 0, 0 at the rising edges of TCK to enter the Shift
Data Register – Shift-DR state. While in this state, upload the selected Data Register
(selected by the present JTAG instruction in the JTAG Instruction Register) from the TDI input
at the rising edge of TCK. In order to remain in the Shift-DR state, the TMS input must be
held low during input of all bits except the MSB. The MSB of the data is shifted in when this
state is left by setting TMS high. While the Data Register is shifted in from the TDI pin, the
parallel inputs to the Data Register captured in the Capture-DR state is shifted out on the
TDO pin.
• Apply the TMS sequence 1, 1, 0 to re-enter the Run-Test/Idle state. If the selected Data
Register has a latched parallel-output, the latching takes place in the Update-DR state. The
Exit-DR, Pause-DR, and Exit2-DR states are only used for navigating the state machine.
As shown in the state diagram, the Run-Test/Idle state need not be entered between selecting
JTAG instruction and using Data Registers, and some JTAG instructions may select certain
functions to be performed in the Run-Test/Idle, making it unsuitable as an Idle state.
Note: Independent of the initial state of the TAP Controller, the Test-Logic-Reset state can always be
entered by holding TMS high for five TCK clock periods.
For detailed information on the JTAG specification, refer to the literature listed in “Bibliography”
on page 340.
338 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
• 2 single Program Memory Break Points + 1 Data Memory Break Point with mask (“range
Break Point”).
A debugger, like the AVR Studio, may however use one or more of these resources for its inter-
nal purpose, leaving less flexibility to the end-user.
A list of the On-chip Debug specific JTAG instructions is given in “On-chip Debug Specific JTAG
Instructions” on page 339.
The JTAGEN Fuse must be programmed to enable the JTAG Test Access Port. In addition, the
OCDEN Fuse must be programmed and no Lock bits must be set for the On-chip debug system
to work. As a security feature, the On-chip debug system is disabled when either of the LB1 or
LB2 Lock bits are set. Otherwise, the On-chip debug system would have provided a back-door
into a secured device.
The AVR Studio enables the user to fully control execution of programs on an AVR device with
On-chip Debug capability, AVR In-Circuit Emulator, or the built-in AVR Instruction Set Simulator.
AVR Studio® supports source level execution of Assembly programs assembled with Atmel Cor-
poration’s AVR Assembler and C programs compiled with third party vendors’ compilers.
AVR Studio runs under Microsoft® Windows® 95/98/2000 and Microsoft Windows NT®.
For a full description of the AVR Studio, please refer to the AVR Studio User Guide. Only high-
lights are presented in this document.
All necessary execution commands are available in AVR Studio, both on source level and on
disassembly level. The user can execute the program, single step through the code either by
tracing into or stepping over functions, step out of functions, place the cursor on a statement and
execute until the statement is reached, stop the execution, and reset the execution target. In
addition, the user can have an unlimited number of code Break Points (using the BREAK
instruction) and up to two data memory Break Points, alternatively combined as a mask (range)
Break Point.
339
7593D–AVR–07/06
26.7 On-chip Debug Related Register in I/O Memory
The OCDR Register provides a communication channel from the running program in the micro-
controller to the debugger. The CPU can transfer a byte to the debugger by writing to this
location. At the same time, an internal flag; I/O Debug Register Dirty – IDRD – is set to indicate
to the debugger that the register has been written. When the CPU reads the OCDR Register the
7 LSB will be from the OCDR Register, while the MSB is the IDRD bit. The debugger clears the
IDRD bit when it has read the information.
In some AVR devices, this register is shared with a standard I/O location. In this case, the OCDR
Register can only be accessed if the OCDEN Fuse is programmed, and the debugger enables
access to the OCDR Register. In all other cases, the standard I/O location is accessed.
Refer to the debugger documentation for further information on how to use this register.
26.9 Bibliography
For more information about general Boundary-scan, the following literature can be consulted:
• IEEE: IEEE Std. 1149.1-1990. IEEE Standard Test Access Port and Boundary-scan
Architecture, IEEE, 1993.
• Colin Maunder: The Board Designers Guide to Testable Logic Circuits, Addison-Wesley,
1992.
340 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
27. IEEE 1149.1 (JTAG) Boundary-scan
27.1 Features
• JTAG (IEEE std. 1149.1 compliant) Interface
• Boundary-scan Capabilities According to the JTAG Standard
• Full Scan of all Port Functions as well as Analog Circuitry having Off-chip Connections
• Supports the Optional IDCODE Instruction
• Additional Public AVR_RESET Instruction to Reset the AVR
341
7593D–AVR–07/06
27.3.1 Bypass Register
The Bypass Register consists of a single Shift Register stage. When the Bypass Register is
selected as path between TDI and TDO, the register is reset to 0 when leaving the Capture-DR
controller state. The Bypass Register can be used to shorten the scan chain on a system when
the other devices are to be tested.
MSB LSB
Bit 31 28 27 12 11 1 0
27.3.2.1 Version
Version is a 4-bit number identifying the revision of the component. The JTAG version number
follows the revision of the device. Revision A is 0x0, revision B is 0x1 and so on.
27.3.2.3 Manufacturer ID
The Manufacturer ID is a 11-bit code identifying the manufacturer. The JTAG manufacturer ID
for ATMEL is listed in Table 27-2.
342 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Figure 27-2. Reset Register
To
TDO
ClockDR · AVR_RESET
343
7593D–AVR–07/06
The active states are:
• Capture-DR: Data in the IDCODE Register is sampled into the Boundary-scan Chain.
• Shift-DR: The IDCODE scan chain is shifted by the TCK input.
344 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
27.5.2 MCU Status Register – MCUSR
The MCU Status Register provides information on which reset source caused an MCU reset.
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
– – – JTRF WDRF BORF EXTRF PORF MCUSR
Read/Write R R R R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Initial Value 0 0 0 See Bit Description
345
7593D–AVR–07/06
Figure 27-3. Boundary-scan Cell for Bi-directional Port Pin with Pull-up Function.
ShiftDR To Next Cell EXTEST Vcc
FF1 LD1 0
0
D Q D Q 1
1
G
346 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Figure 27-4. General Port Pin Schematic Diagram
See Boundary-scan
Description for Details!
PUExn PUD
Q D
DDxn
Q CLR
WDx
RESET
OCxn
RDx
DATA BUS
Pxn Q D
ODxn PORTxn
Q CLR
IDxn WRx
RESET
SLEEP RRx
SYNCHRONIZER
RPx
D Q D Q
PINxn
L Q Q
CLK I/O
FF1
0
D Q
1
From ClockDR
Previous
Cell
347
7593D–AVR–07/06
27.7 AT90USB64/128 Boundary-scan Order
Table 27-3 shows the Scan order between TDI and TDO when the Boundary-scan chain is
selected as data path. Bit 0 is the LSB; the first bit scanned in, and the first bit scanned out. The
scan order follows the pin-out order as far as possible. Therefore, the bits of Port A and Port Fis
scanned in the opposite bit order of the other ports. Exceptions from the rules are the Scan
chains for the analog circuits, which constitute the most significant bits of the scan chain regard-
less of which physical pin they are connected to. In Figure 27-3, PXn. Data corresponds to FF0,
PXn. Control corresponds to FF1, PXn. Bit 4, 5, 6 and 7 of Port F is not in the scan chain, since
these pins constitute the TAP pins when the JTAG is enabled. The USB pads are not included in
the boundary-scan.
348 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Table 27-3. AT90USB64/128 Boundary-scan Order (Continued)
Bit Number Signal Name Module
62 RSTT Reset Logic (Observe Only)
61 PD0.Data
60 PD0.Control
59 PD1.Data
58 PD1.Control
57 PD2.Data
56 PD2.Control
55 PD3.Data
54 PD3.Control
Port D
53 PD4.Data
52 PD4.Control
51 PD5.Data
50 PD5.Control
49 PD6.Data
48 PD6.Control
47 PD7.Data
46 PD7.Control
45 PE0.Data
44 PE0.Control
Port E
43 PE1.Data
42 PE1.Control
349
7593D–AVR–07/06
Table 27-3. AT90USB64/128 Boundary-scan Order (Continued)
Bit Number Signal Name Module
41 PC0.Data
40 PC0.Control
39 PC1.Data
38 PC1.Control
37 PC2.Data
36 PC2.Control
35 PC3.Data
34 PC3.Control
Port C
33 PC4.Data
32 PC4.Control
31 PC5.Data
30 PC5.Control
29 PC6.Data
28 PC6.Control
27 PC7.Data
26 PC7.Control
25 PE2.Data
Port E
24 PE2.Control
23 PA7.Data
22 PA7.Control
21 PA6.Data
20 PA6.Control
19 PA5.Data
18 PA5.Control
17 PA4.Data
16 PA4.Control
Port A
15 PA3.Data
14 PA3.Control
13 PA2.Data
12 PA2.Control
11 PA1.Data
10 PA1.Control
9 PA0.Data
8 PA0.Control
350 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Table 27-3. AT90USB64/128 Boundary-scan Order (Continued)
Bit Number Signal Name Module
7 PF3.Data
6 PF3.Control
5 PF2.Data
4 PF2.Control
Port F
3 PF1.Data
2 PF1.Control
1 PF0.Data
0 PF0.Control
351
7593D–AVR–07/06
28. Boot Loader Support – Read-While-Write Self-Programming
The Boot Loader Support provides a real Read-While-Write Self-Programming mechanism for
downloading and uploading program code by the MCU itself. This feature allows flexible applica-
tion software updates controlled by the MCU using a Flash-resident Boot Loader program. The
Boot Loader program can use any available data interface and associated protocol to read code
and write (program) that code into the Flash memory, or read the code from the program mem-
ory. The program code within the Boot Loader section has the capability to write into the entire
Flash, including the Boot Loader memory. The Boot Loader can thus even modify itself, and it
can also erase itself from the code if the feature is not needed anymore. The size of the Boot
Loader memory is configurable with fuses and the Boot Loader has two separate sets of Boot
Lock bits which can be set independently. This gives the user a unique flexibility to select differ-
ent levels of protection. General information on SPM and ELPM is provided in See “AVR CPU
Core” on page 10.
352 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
sections that are configurable by the BOOTSZ Fuses as described above, the Flash is also
divided into two fixed sections, the Read-While-Write (RWW) section and the No Read-While-
Write (NRWW) section. The limit between the RWW- and NRWW sections is given in Table 28-
1 and Figure 28-1 on page 354. The main difference between the two sections is:
• When erasing or writing a page located inside the RWW section, the NRWW section can be
read during the operation.
• When erasing or writing a page located inside the NRWW section, the CPU is halted during
the entire operation.
Note that the user software can never read any code that is located inside the RWW section dur-
ing a Boot Loader software operation. The syntax “Read-While-Write section” refers to which
section that is being programmed (erased or written), not which section that actually is being
read during a Boot Loader software update.
353
7593D–AVR–07/06
Figure 28-1. Read-While-Write vs. No Read-While-Write
Read-While-Write
(RWW) Section
Z-pointer
Addresses NRWW
Z-pointer Section
Addresses RWW No Read-While-Write
Section (NRWW) Section
CPU is Halted
During the Operation
Code Located in
NRWW Section
Can be Read During
the Operation
354 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Figure 28-2. Memory Sections
Program Memory Program Memory
BOOTSZ = '11' BOOTSZ = '10'
0x0000 0x0000
Read-While-Write Section
Read-While-Write Section
Application Flash Section Application Flash Section
No Read-While-Write Section
No Read-While-Write Section
End RWW End RWW
Start NRWW Start NRWW
End Application
End Application Start Boot Loader
Start Boot Loader Boot Loader Flash Section
Boot Loader Flash Section
Flashend Flashend
Read-While-Write Section
Application Flash Section Application Flash Section
No Read-While-Write Section
End RWW
Start NRWW Start NRWW, Start Boot Loader
Application Flash Section
End Application
Boot Loader Flash Section
Start Boot Loader
Boot Loader Flash Section
Flashend Flashend
Note: 1. The parameters in the figure above are given in Table 28-8 on page 366.
355
7593D–AVR–07/06
Table 28-2. Boot Lock Bit0 Protection Modes (Application Section)(1)
BLB0 Mode BLB02 BLB01 Protection
No restrictions for SPM or (E)LPM accessing the
1 1 1
Application section.
2 1 0 SPM is not allowed to write to the Application section.
SPM is not allowed to write to the Application section, and
(E)LPM executing from the Boot Loader section is not
3 0 0 allowed to read from the Application section. If Interrupt
Vectors are placed in the Boot Loader section, interrupts
are disabled while executing from the Application section.
(E)LPM executing from the Boot Loader section is not
allowed to read from the Application section. If Interrupt
4 0 1
Vectors are placed in the Boot Loader section, interrupts
are disabled while executing from the Application section.
Note: 1. “1” means unprogrammed, “0” means programmed
Table 28-3. Boot Lock Bit1 Protection Modes (Boot Loader Section)(1)
BLB1 Mode BLB12 BLB11 Protection
No restrictions for SPM or (E)LPM accessing the Boot
1 1 1
Loader section.
2 1 0 SPM is not allowed to write to the Boot Loader section.
SPM is not allowed to write to the Boot Loader section,
and (E)LPM executing from the Application section is not
allowed to read from the Boot Loader section. If Interrupt
3 0 0
Vectors are placed in the Application section, interrupts
are disabled while executing from the Boot Loader
section.
(E)LPM executing from the Application section is not
allowed to read from the Boot Loader section. If Interrupt
4 0 1 Vectors are placed in the Application section, interrupts
are disabled while executing from the Boot Loader
section.
Note: 1. “1” means unprogrammed, “0” means programmed
356 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
is programmed, the Reset Vector will always point to the Boot Loader Reset and the fuse can
only be changed through the serial or parallel programming interface.
357
7593D–AVR–07/06
Figure 28-3. Boot Process Description
RESET
tSHRH tHHRH
ALE/HWB
HWBE ?
Ext. Hardware
Conditions ?
BOOTRST ?
358 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
after SIGRD and SPMEN are set will have no effect. This operation is reserved for future use
and should not be used.
359
7593D–AVR–07/06
Note: Only one SPM instruction should be active at any time.
Since the Flash is organized in pages (see Table 29-11 on page 373), the Program Counter can
be treated as having two different sections. One section, consisting of the least significant bits, is
addressing the words within a page, while the most significant bits are addressing the pages.
This is shown in Figure 28-4. Note that the Page Erase and Page Write operations are
addressed independently. Therefore it is of major importance that the Boot Loader software
addresses the same page in both the Page Erase and Page Write operation. Once a program-
ming operation is initiated, the address is latched and the Z-pointer can be used for other
operations.
The (E)LPM instruction use the Z-pointer to store the address. Since this instruction addresses
the Flash byte-by-byte, also bit Z0 of the Z-pointer is used.
PCMSB PAGEMSB
PROGRAM COUNTER PCPAGE PCWORD
01
02
PAGEEND
360 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Note: 1. The different variables used in Figure 28-4 are listed in Table 28-10 on page 367.
361
7593D–AVR–07/06
The page address must be written to PCPAGE. Other bits in the Z-pointer must be written to
zero during this operation.
• Page Write to the RWW section: The NRWW section can be read during the Page Write.
• Page Write to the NRWW section: The CPU is halted during the operation.
See Table 28-2 and Table 28-3 for how the different settings of the Boot Loader bits affect the
Flash access.
If bits 5..2 in R0 are cleared (zero), the corresponding Boot Lock bit will be programmed if an
SPM instruction is executed within four cycles after BLBSET and SPMEN are set in SPMCSR.
The Z-pointer is don’t care during this operation, but for future compatibility it is recommended to
load the Z-pointer with 0x0001 (same as used for reading the lOck bits). For future compatibility it
is also recommended to set bits 7, 6, 1, and 0 in R0 to “1” when writing the Lock bits. When pro-
gramming the Lock bits the entire Flash can be read during the operation.
362 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
is recommended that the user checks the status bit (EEPE) in the EECR Register and verifies
that the bit is cleared before writing to the SPMCSR Register.
The algorithm for reading the Fuse Low byte is similar to the one described above for reading
the Lock bits. To read the Fuse Low byte, load the Z-pointer with 0x0000 and set the BLBSET
and SPMEN bits in SPMCSR. When an (E)LPM instruction is executed within three cycles after
the BLBSET and SPMEN bits are set in the SPMCSR, the value of the Fuse Low byte (FLB) will
be loaded in the destination register as shown below. Refer to Table 29-5 on page 370 for a
detailed description and mapping of the Fuse Low byte.
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Rd FLB7 FLB6 FLB5 FLB4 FLB3 FLB2 FLB1 FLB0
Similarly, when reading the Fuse High byte, load 0x0003 in the Z-pointer. When an (E)LPM
instruction is executed within three cycles after the BLBSET and SPMEN bits are set in the
SPMCSR, the value of the Fuse High byte (FHB) will be loaded in the destination register as
shown below. Refer to Table 29-4 on page 370 for detailed description and mapping of the Fuse
High byte.
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Rd FHB7 FHB6 FHB5 FHB4 FHB3 FHB2 FHB1 FHB0
When reading the Extended Fuse byte, load 0x0002 in the Z-pointer. When an (E)LPM instruc-
tion is executed within three cycles after the BLBSET and SPMEN bits are set in the SPMCSR,
the value of the Extended Fuse byte (EFB) will be loaded in the destination register as shown
below. Refer to Table 29-3 on page 369 for detailed description and mapping of the Extended
Fuse byte.
Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Rd – – – – – EFB2 EFB1 EFB0
Fuse and Lock bits that are programmed, will be read as zero. Fuse and Lock bits that are
unprogrammed, will be read as one.
363
7593D–AVR–07/06
instruction is executed within three CPU cycles. When SIGRD and SPMEN are cleared, LPM will
work as described in the Instruction set Manual.
364 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
; (at least the Do_spm sub routine). Only code inside NRWW section can
; be read during Self-Programming (Page Erase and Page Write).
;-registers used: r0, r1, temp1 (r16), temp2 (r17), looplo (r24),
; loophi (r25), spmcrval (r20)
; storing and restoring of registers is not included in the routine
; register usage can be optimized at the expense of code size
;-It is assumed that either the interrupt table is moved to the Boot
; loader section or that the interrupts are disabled.
.equ PAGESIZEB = PAGESIZE*2 ;PAGESIZEB is page size in BYTES, not words
.org SMALLBOOTSTART
Write_page:
; Page Erase
ldi spmcrval, (1<<PGERS) | (1<<SPMEN)
call Do_spm
365
7593D–AVR–07/06
ret
; re-enable the RWW section
ldi spmcrval, (1<<RWWSRE) | (1<<SPMEN)
call Do_spm
rjmp Return
Do_spm:
; check for previous SPM complete
Wait_spm:
in temp1, SPMCSR
sbrc temp1, SPMEN
rjmp Wait_spm
; input: spmcrval determines SPM action
; disable interrupts if enabled, store status
in temp2, SREG
cli
; check that no EEPROM write access is present
Wait_ee:
sbic EECR, EEPE
rjmp Wait_ee
; SPM timed sequence
out SPMCSR, spmcrval
spm
; restore SREG (to enable interrupts if originally enabled)
out SREG, temp2
ret
Reset Address
Flash Section
Flash Section
Loader Section)
BOOTSZ1
BOOTSZ0
Boot Size
Boot Loader
Application
Application
Device
(Start Boot
Section
Pages
Boot
End
Note: 1. The different BOOTSZ Fuse configurations are shown in Figure 28-2
366 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Note: 1. For details about these two section, see “NRWW – No Read-While-Write Section” on page
353 and “RWW – Read-While-Write Section” on page 353.
Table 28-10.
Explanation of different variables used in Figure 28-4 and the mapping to the Z-
pointer
Corresponding
Variable Z-value Description(1)
Most significant bit in the Program Counter. (The
PCMSB 16
Program Counter is 17 bits PC[16:0])
Most significant bit which is used to address the
PAGEMSB 6 words within one page (128 words in a page requires
seven bits PC [6:0]).
Bit in Z-pointer that is mapped to PCMSB. Because
ZPCMSB Z17
Z0 is not used, the ZPCMSB equals PCMSB + 1.
Bit in Z-pointer that is mapped to PCMSB. Because
ZPAGEMSB Z7 Z0 is not used, the ZPAGEMSB equals PAGEMSB +
1.
Program Counter page address: Page select, for
PCPAGE PC[16:7] Z17:Z8
Page Erase and Page Write
Program Counter word address: Word select, for
PCWORD PC[6:0] Z7:Z1 filling temporary buffer (must be zero during Page
Write operation)
Most significant bit in the program counter. (The program
PCMSB 15
counter is 16 bits PC[15:0])
367
7593D–AVR–07/06
29. Memory Programming
368 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Table 29-2. Lock Bit Protection Modes(1)(2) (Continued)
Memory Lock Bits Protection Type
BLB1 Mode BLB12 BLB11
No restrictions for SPM or (E)LPM accessing the Boot
1 1 1
Loader section.
2 1 0 SPM is not allowed to write to the Boot Loader section.
SPM is not allowed to write to the Boot Loader section,
and (E)LPM executing from the Application section is not
allowed to read from the Boot Loader section. If Interrupt
3 0 0
Vectors are placed in the Application section, interrupts
are disabled while executing from the Boot Loader
section.
(E)LPM executing from the Application section is not
allowed to read from the Boot Loader section. If Interrupt
4 0 1 Vectors are placed in the Application section, interrupts
are disabled while executing from the Boot Loader
section.
Notes: 1. Program the Fuse bits and Boot Lock bits before programming the LB1 and LB2.
2. “1” means unprogrammed, “0” means programmed
369
7593D–AVR–07/06
Table 29-4. Fuse High Byte
Fuse High Byte Bit No Description Default Value
1 (unprogrammed, OCD
OCDEN(4) 7 Enable OCD
disabled)
0 (programmed, JTAG
JTAGEN 6 Enable JTAG
enabled)
Enable Serial Program and Data 0 (programmed, SPI prog.
SPIEN(1) 5
Downloading enabled)
WDTON(3) 4 Watchdog Timer always on 1 (unprogrammed)
EEPROM memory is preserved 1 (unprogrammed,
EESAVE 3
through the Chip Erase EEPROM not preserved)
Select Boot Size (see Table 29-6
BOOTSZ1 2 0 (programmed)(2)
for details)
Select Boot Size (see Table 29-6
BOOTSZ0 1 0 (programmed)(2)
for details)
BOOTRST 0 Select Reset Vector 1 (unprogrammed)
Note: 1. The SPIEN Fuse is not accessible in serial programming mode.
2. The default value of BOOTSZ1..0 results in maximum Boot Size. See Table 28-8 on page 366
for details.
3. See “Watchdog Timer Control Register - WDTCSR” on page 67 for details.
4. Never ship a product with the OCDEN Fuse programmed regardless of the setting of Lock bits
and JTAGEN Fuse. A programmed OCDEN Fuse enables some parts of the clock system to
be running in all sleep modes. This may increase the power consumption.
Table 29-5. Fuse Low Byte
Fuse Low Byte Bit No Description Default Value
(4)
CKDIV8 7 Divide clock by 8 0 (programmed)
(3)
CKOUT 6 Clock output 1 (unprogrammed)
SUT1 5 Select start-up time 1 (unprogrammed)(1)
SUT0 4 Select start-up time 0 (programmed)(1)
CKSEL3 3 Select Clock source 0 (programmed)(2)
CKSEL2 2 Select Clock source 0 (programmed)(2)
CKSEL1 1 Select Clock source 1 (unprogrammed)(2)
CKSEL0 0 Select Clock source 0 (programmed)(2)
Note: 1. The default value of SUT1..0 results in maximum start-up time for the default clock source.
See Table 8-1 on page 60 for details.
2. The default setting of CKSEL3..0 results in internal RC Oscillator @ 8 MHz. See Table 6-1 on
page 40 for details.
3. The CKOUT Fuse allow the system clock to be output on PORTC7. See “Clock Output Buffer”
on page 48 for details.
4. See “System Clock Prescaler” on page 48 for details.
The status of the Fuse bits is not affected by Chip Erase. Note that the Fuse bits are locked if
Lock bit1 (LB1) is programmed. Program the Fuse bits before programming the Lock bits.
370 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
29.2.1 Latching of Fuses
The fuse values are latched when the device enters programming mode and changes of the
fuse values will have no effect until the part leaves Programming mode. This does not apply to
the EESAVE Fuse which will take effect once it is programmed. The fuses are also latched on
Power-up in Normal mode.
371
7593D–AVR–07/06
Figure 29-1. Parallel Programming(1)
+5V
RDY/BSY PD1
VCC
OE PD2 +5V
WR PD3
AVCC
BS1 PD4
XA1 PD6
PAGEL PD7
+12 V RESET
BS2 PA0
XTAL1
GND
372 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
,
Table 29-11. No. of Words in a Page and No. of Pages in the Flash
No. of
Flash Size Page Size PCWORD Pages PCPAGE PCMSB
128K words (256K bytes) 128 words PC[6:0] 1024 PC[16:7] 16
373
7593D–AVR–07/06
Table 29-12. No. of Words in a Page and No. of Pages in the EEPROM
No. of
EEPROM Size Page Size PCWORD Pages PCPAGE EEAMSB
4K bytes 8 bytes EEA[2:0] 512 EEA[11:3] 11
374 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
29.6.4 Programming the Flash
The Flash is organized in pages, see Table 29-11 on page 373. When programming the Flash,
the program data is latched into a page buffer. This allows one page of program data to be pro-
grammed simultaneously. The following procedure describes how to program the entire Flash
memory:
A. Load Command “Write Flash”
1. Set XA1, XA0 to “10”. This enables command loading.
2. Set BS1 to “0”.
3. Set DATA to “0001 0000”. This is the command for Write Flash.
4. Give XTAL1 a positive pulse. This loads the command.
B. Load Address Low byte (Address bits 7..0)
1. Set XA1, XA0 to “00”. This enables address loading.
2. Set BS2, BS1 to “00”. This selects the address low byte.
3. Set DATA = Address low byte (0x00 - 0xFF).
4. Give XTAL1 a positive pulse. This loads the address low byte.
C. Load Data Low Byte
1. Set XA1, XA0 to “01”. This enables data loading.
2. Set DATA = Data low byte (0x00 - 0xFF).
3. Give XTAL1 a positive pulse. This loads the data byte.
D. Load Data High Byte
1. Set BS1 to “1”. This selects high data byte.
2. Set XA1, XA0 to “01”. This enables data loading.
3. Set DATA = Data high byte (0x00 - 0xFF).
4. Give XTAL1 a positive pulse. This loads the data byte.
E. Latch Data
1. Set BS1 to “1”. This selects high data byte.
2. Give PAGEL a positive pulse. This latches the data bytes. (See Figure 29-3 for signal
waveforms)
F. Repeat B through E until the entire buffer is filled or until all data within the page is loaded.
While the lower bits in the address are mapped to words within the page, the higher bits address
the pages within the FLASH. This is illustrated in Figure 29-2 on page 376. Note that if less than
eight bits are required to address words in the page (pagesize < 256), the most significant bit(s)
in the address low byte are used to address the page when performing a Page Write.
G. Load Address High byte (Address bits15..8)
1. Set XA1, XA0 to “00”. This enables address loading.
2. Set BS2, BS1 to “01”. This selects the address high byte.
3. Set DATA = Address high byte (0x00 - 0xFF).
4. Give XTAL1 a positive pulse. This loads the address high byte.
H. Load Address Extended High byte (Address bits 23..16)
1. Set XA1, XA0 to “00”. This enables address loading.
2. Set BS2, BS1 to “10”. This selects the address extended high byte.
375
7593D–AVR–07/06
3. Set DATA = Address extended high byte (0x00 - 0xFF).
4. Give XTAL1 a positive pulse. This loads the address high byte.
I. Program Page
1. Set BS2, BS1 to “00”
2. Give WR a negative pulse. This starts programming of the entire page of data.
RDY/BSY goes low.
3. Wait until RDY/BSY goes high (See Figure 29-3 for signal waveforms).
J. Repeat B through I until the entire Flash is programmed or until all data has been
programmed.
K. End Page Programming
1. 1. Set XA1, XA0 to “10”. This enables command loading.
2. Set DATA to “0000 0000”. This is the command for No Operation.
3. Give XTAL1 a positive pulse. This loads the command, and the internal write signals
are reset.
01
02
PAGEEND
Note: 1. PCPAGE and PCWORD are listed in Table 29-11 on page 373.
376 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Figure 29-3. Programming the Flash Waveforms(1)
F
A B C D E B C D E G H I
0x10 ADDR. LOW DATA LOW DATA HIGH XX ADDR. LOW DATA LOW DATA HIGH XX ADDR. HIGH ADDR. EXT.H XX
DATA
XA1
XA0
BS1
BS2
XTAL1
WR
RDY/BSY
RESET +12V
OE
PAGEL
Note: 1. “XX” is don’t care. The letters refer to the programming description above.
377
7593D–AVR–07/06
Figure 29-4. Programming the EEPROM Waveforms
K
A G B C E B C E L
0x11 ADDR. HIGH ADDR. LOW DATA XX ADDR. LOW DATA XX
DATA
XA1
XA0
BS1
XTAL1
WR
RDY/BSY
RESET +12V
OE
PAGEL
BS2
378 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
29.6.9 Programming the Fuse High Bits
The algorithm for programming the Fuse High bits is as follows (refer to “Programming the
Flash” on page 375 for details on Command and Data loading):
1. A: Load Command “0100 0000”.
2. C: Load Data Low Byte. Bit n = “0” programs and bit n = “1” erases the Fuse bit.
3. Set BS2, BS1 to “01”. This selects high data byte.
4. Give WR a negative pulse and wait for RDY/BSY to go high.
5. Set BS2, BS1 to “00”. This selects low data byte.
A C A C A C
0x40 DATA XX 0x40 DATA XX 0x40 DATA XX
DATA
XA1
XA0
BS1
BS2
XTAL1
WR
RDY/BSY
RESET +12V
OE
PAGEL
379
7593D–AVR–07/06
29.6.12 Reading the Fuse and Lock Bits
The algorithm for reading the Fuse and Lock bits is as follows (refer to “Programming the Flash”
on page 375 for details on Command loading):
1. A: Load Command “0000 0100”.
2. Set OE to “0”, and BS2, BS1 to “00”. The status of the Fuse Low bits can now be read
at DATA (“0” means programmed).
3. Set OE to “0”, and BS2, BS1 to “11”. The status of the Fuse High bits can now be read
at DATA (“0” means programmed).
4. Set OE to “0”, and BS2, BS1 to “10”. The status of the Extended Fuse bits can now be
read at DATA (“0” means programmed).
5. Set OE to “0”, and BS2, BS1 to “01”. The status of the Lock bits can now be read at
DATA (“0” means programmed).
6. Set OE to “1”.
Figure 29-6. Mapping Between BS1, BS2 and the Fuse and Lock Bits During Read
0
Extended Fuse Byte 1
DATA
BS2
Lock Bits 0
1
BS1
Fuse High Byte 1
BS2
380 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
29.6.15 Parallel Programming Characteristics
Figure 29-7. Parallel Programming Timing, Including some General Timing Requirements
tXLWL
tXHXL
XTAL1
tDVXH tXLDX
Data & Contol
(DATA, XA0/1, BS1, BS2)
tBVPH tPLBX t BVWL
tWLBX
PAGEL tPHPL
tWLWH
WR tPLWL
WLRL
RDY/BSY
tWLRH
Figure 29-8. Parallel Programming Timing, Loading Sequence with Timing Requirements(1)
LOAD ADDRESS LOAD DATA LOAD DATA LOAD DATA LOAD ADDRESS
(LOW BYTE) (LOW BYTE) (HIGH BYTE) (LOW BYTE)
t XLXH tXLPH
tPLXH
XTAL1
BS1
PAGEL
DATA ADDR0 (Low Byte) DATA (Low Byte) DATA (High Byte) ADDR1 (Low Byte)
XA0
XA1
Note: 1. The timing requirements shown in Figure 29-7 (i.e., tDVXH, tXHXL, and tXLDX) also apply to load-
ing operation.
Figure 29-9. Parallel Programming Timing, Reading Sequence (within the Same Page) with
Timing Requirements(1)
LOAD ADDRESS READ DATA READ DATA LOAD ADDRESS
(LOW BYTE) (LOW BYTE) (HIGH BYTE) (LOW BYTE)
tXLOL
XTAL1
tBVDV
BS1
tOLDV
OE
tOHDZ
DATA ADDR0 (Low Byte) DATA (Low Byte) DATA (High Byte) ADDR1 (Low Byte)
XA0
XA1
381
7593D–AVR–07/06
Note: 1. The timing requirements shown in Figure 29-7 (i.e., tDVXH, tXHXL, and tXLDX) also apply to read-
ing operation.
Notes: 1. tWLRH is valid for the Write Flash, Write EEPROM, Write Fuse bits and Write Lock bits
commands.
2. tWLRH_CE is valid for the Chip Erase command.
382 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
29.8 Serial Programming Pin Mapping
+1.8 - 5.5V
VCC
+1.8 - 5.5V(2)
PDI
AVCC
PDO
SCK
XTAL1
RESET
GND
Notes: 1. If the device is clocked by the internal Oscillator, it is no need to connect a clock source to the
XTAL1 pin.
2. VCC - 0.3V < AVCC < VCC + 0.3V, however, AVCC should always be within 1.8 - 5.5V
When programming the EEPROM, an auto-erase cycle is built into the self-timed programming
operation (in the Serial mode ONLY) and there is no need to first execute the Chip Erase
instruction. The Chip Erase operation turns the content of every memory location in both the
Program and EEPROM arrays into 0xFF.
Depending on CKSEL Fuses, a valid clock must be present. The minimum low and high periods
for the serial clock (SCK) input are defined as follows:
Low: > 2 CPU clock cycles for fck < 12 MHz, 3 CPU clock cycles for fck >= 12 MHz
High: > 2 CPU clock cycles for fck < 12 MHz, 3 CPU clock cycles for fck >= 12 MHz
383
7593D–AVR–07/06
1. Power-up sequence:
Apply power between VCC and GND while RESET and SCK are set to “0”. In some sys-
tems, the programmer can not guarantee that SCK is held low during power-up. In this
case, RESET must be given a positive pulse of at least two CPU clock cycles duration
after SCK has been set to “0”.
2. Wait for at least 20 ms and enable serial programming by sending the Programming
Enable serial instruction to pin PDI.
3. The serial programming instructions will not work if the communication is out of syn-
chronization. When in sync. the second byte (0x53), will echo back when issuing the
third byte of the Programming Enable instruction. Whether the echo is correct or not, all
four bytes of the instruction must be transmitted. If the 0x53 did not echo back, give
RESET a positive pulse and issue a new Programming Enable command.
4. The Flash is programmed one page at a time. The memory page is loaded one byte at
a time by supplying the 7 LSB of the address and data together with the Load Program
Memory Page instruction. To ensure correct loading of the page, the data low byte must
be loaded before data high byte is applied for a given address. The Program Memory
Page is stored by loading the Write Program Memory Page instruction with the address
lines 15..8. Before issuing this command, make sure the instruction Load Extended
Address Byte has been used to define the MSB of the address. The extended address
byte is stored until the command is re-issued, i.e., the command needs only be issued
for the first page, and when crossing the 64KWord boundary. If polling (RDY/BSY) is not
used, the user must wait at least tWD_FLASH before issuing the next page. (See Table 29-
15.) Accessing the serial programming interface before the Flash write operation com-
pletes can result in incorrect programming.
5. The EEPROM array is programmed one byte at a time by supplying the address and
data together with the appropriate Write instruction. An EEPROM memory location is
first automatically erased before new data is written. If polling is not used, the user must
wait at least tWD_EEPROM before issuing the next byte. (See Table 29-15.) In a chip
erased device, no 0xFFs in the data file(s) need to be programmed.
6. Any memory location can be verified by using the Read instruction which returns the
content at the selected address at serial output PDO. When reading the Flash memory,
use the instruction Load Extended Address Byte to define the upper address byte,
which is not included in the Read Program Memory instruction. The extended address
byte is stored until the command is re-issued, i.e., the command needs only be issued
for the first page, and when crossing the 64KWord boundary.
7. At the end of the programming session, RESET can be set high to commence normal
operation.
8. Power-off sequence (if needed):
Set RESET to “1”.
Turn VCC power off.
Table 29-15. Minimum Wait Delay Before Writing the Next Flash or EEPROM Location
Symbol Minimum Wait Delay
tWD_FLASH 4.5 ms
tWD_EEPROM 9.0 ms
tWD_ERASE 9.0 ms
384 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Figure 29-11. Serial Programming Waveforms
SERIAL DATA INPUT MSB LSB
(MOSI)
SAMPLE
385
7593D–AVR–07/06
Table 29-16. Serial Programming Instruction Set
Instruction Format
Instruction Byte 1 Byte 2 Byte 3 Byte4 Operation
1010 1100 0101 0011 xxxx xxxx xxxx xxxx Enable Serial Programming after
Programming Enable
RESET goes low.
Chip Erase 1010 1100 100x xxxx xxxx xxxx xxxx xxxx Chip Erase EEPROM and Flash.
0100 1101 0000 0000 cccc cccc xxxx xxxx Defines Extended Address Byte for
Load Extended Address Byte Read Program Memory and Write
Program Memory Page.
0010 H000 aaaa aaaa bbbb bbbb oooo oooo Read H (high or low) data o from
Read Program Memory Program memory at word address
c:a:b.
0100 H000 xxxx xxxx xxbb bbbb iiii iiii Write H (high or low) data i to Program
Memory page at word address b. Data
Load Program Memory Page low byte must be loaded before Data
high byte is applied within the same
address.
0100 1100 aaaa aaaa bbxx xxxx xxxx xxxx Write Program Memory Page at
Write Program Memory Page
address c:a:b.
1010 0000 0000 aaaa bbbb bbbb oooo oooo Read data o from EEPROM memory at
Read EEPROM Memory
address a:b.
1100 0000 0000 aaaa bbbb bbbb iiii iiii Write data i to EEPROM memory at
Write EEPROM Memory
address a:b.
1100 0001 0000 0000 0000 00bb iiii iiii Load data i to EEPROM memory page
Load EEPROM Memory
buffer. After data is loaded, program
Page (page access)
EEPROM page.
Write EEPROM Memory 1100 0010 0000 aaaa bbbb bb00 xxxx xxxx
Write EEPROM page at address a:b.
Page (page access)
0101 1000 0000 0000 xxxx xxxx xxoo oooo Read Lock bits. “0” = programmed, “1”
Read Lock bits = unprogrammed. See Table 29-1 on
page 368 for details.
1010 1100 111x xxxx xxxx xxxx 11ii iiii Write Lock bits. Set bits = “0” to
Write Lock bits program Lock bits. See Table 29-1 on
page 368 for details.
Read Signature Byte 0011 0000 000x xxxx xxxx xxbb oooo oooo Read Signature Byte o at address b.
1010 1100 1010 0000 xxxx xxxx iiii iiii Set bits = “0” to program, “1” to
Write Fuse bits
unprogram.
1010 1100 1010 1000 xxxx xxxx iiii iiii Set bits = “0” to program, “1” to
Write Fuse High bits
unprogram.
1010 1100 1010 0100 xxxx xxxx iiii iiii Set bits = “0” to program, “1” to
Write Extended Fuse Bits unprogram. See Table 29-3 on page
369 for details.
0101 0000 0000 0000 xxxx xxxx oooo oooo Read Fuse bits. “0” = programmed, “1”
Read Fuse bits
= unprogrammed.
0101 1000 0000 1000 xxxx xxxx oooo oooo Read Fuse High bits. “0” = pro-
Read Fuse High bits
grammed, “1” = unprogrammed.
386 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Table 29-16. Serial Programming Instruction Set (Continued)
Instruction Format
Instruction Byte 1 Byte 2 Byte 3 Byte4 Operation
0101 0000 0000 1000 xxxx xxxx oooo oooo Read Extended Fuse bits. “0” = pro-
Read Extended Fuse Bits grammed, “1” = unprogrammed. See
Table 29-3 on page 369 for details.
Read Calibration Byte 0011 1000 000x xxxx 0000 0000 oooo oooo Read Calibration Byte
1111 0000 0000 0000 xxxx xxxx xxxx xxxo If o = “1”, a programming operation is
Poll RDY/BSY still busy. Wait until this bit returns to
“0” before applying another command.
Note: a = address high bits, b = address low bits, c = address extended bits, H = 0 - Low byte, 1 - High Byte, o = data out, i = data in,
x = don’t care
387
7593D–AVR–07/06
Figure 29-12. State Machine Sequence for Changing the Instruction Word
1 Test-Logic-Reset
0 1 1 1
Run-Test/Idle Select-DR Scan Select-IR Scan
0 0
1 1
Capture-DR Capture-IR
0 0
Shift-DR 0 Shift-IR 0
1 1
1 1
Exit1-DR Exit1-IR
0 0
Pause-DR 0 Pause-IR 0
1 1
0 0
Exit2-DR Exit2-IR
1 1
Update-DR Update-IR
1 0 1 0
388 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
29.9.4 PROG_COMMANDS (0x5)
The AVR specific public JTAG instruction for entering programming commands via the JTAG
port. The 15-bit Programming Command Register is selected as Data Register. The active
states are the following:
• Capture-DR: The result of the previous command is loaded into the Data Register.
• Shift-DR: The Data Register is shifted by the TCK input, shifting out the result of the previous
command and shifting in the new command.
• Update-DR: The programming command is applied to the Flash inputs
• Run-Test/Idle: One clock cycle is generated, executing the applied command
389
7593D–AVR–07/06
29.9.8 Reset Register
The Reset Register is a Test Data Register used to reset the part during programming. It is
required to reset the part before entering Programming mode.
A high value in the Reset Register corresponds to pulling the external reset low. The part is reset
as long as there is a high value present in the Reset Register. Depending on the Fuse settings
for the clock options, the part will remain reset for a Reset Time-out period (refer to “Clock
Sources” on page 40) after releasing the Reset Register. The output from this Data Register is
not latched, so the reset will take place immediately, as shown in Figure 8-1 on page 60.
0xA370
D
A
T
= D Q Programming Enable
TDO
390 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Figure 29-14. Programming Command Register
TDI
S
T
R
O
B
E
S
Flash
EEPROM
A
Fuses
D
D
Lock Bits
R
E
S
S
/
D
A
T
A
TDO
391
7593D–AVR–07/06
Table 29-17. JTAG Programming Instruction
Set a = address high bits, b = address low bits, c = address extended bits, H = 0 - Low byte, 1 - High Byte, o = data out,
i = data in, x = don’t care
Instruction TDI Sequence TDO Sequence Notes
0100011_10000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
0110001_10000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
1a. Chip Erase
0110011_10000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
0110011_10000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
1b. Poll for Chip Erase Complete 0110011_10000000 xxxxxox_xxxxxxxx (2)
2a. Enter Flash Write 0100011_00010000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
2b. Load Address Extended High Byte 0001011_cccccccc xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx (10)
2c. Load Address High Byte 0000111_aaaaaaaa xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
2d. Load Address Low Byte 0000011_bbbbbbbb xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
2e. Load Data Low Byte 0010011_iiiiiiii xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
2f. Load Data High Byte 0010111_iiiiiiii xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
0110111_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
2g. Latch Data 1110111_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx (1)
0110111_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
0110111_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
0110101_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
2h. Write Flash Page (1)
0110111_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
0110111_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
2i. Poll for Page Write Complete 0110111_00000000 xxxxxox_xxxxxxxx (2)
3a. Enter Flash Read 0100011_00000010 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
3b. Load Address Extended High Byte 0001011_cccccccc xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx (10)
3c. Load Address High Byte 0000111_aaaaaaaa xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
3d. Load Address Low Byte 0000011_bbbbbbbb xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
0110010_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
3e. Read Data Low and High Byte 0110110_00000000 xxxxxxx_oooooooo Low byte
0110111_00000000 xxxxxxx_oooooooo High byte
4a. Enter EEPROM Write 0100011_00010001 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
4b. Load Address High Byte 0000111_aaaaaaaa xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx (10)
4c. Load Address Low Byte 0000011_bbbbbbbb xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
4d. Load Data Byte 0010011_iiiiiiii xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
0110111_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
4e. Latch Data 1110111_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx (1)
0110111_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
0110011_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
0110001_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
4f. Write EEPROM Page (1)
0110011_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
0110011_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
392 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Table 29-17. JTAG Programming Instruction (Continued)
Set (Continued) a = address high bits, b = address low bits, c = address extended bits, H = 0 - Low byte, 1 - High Byte,
o = data out, i = data in, x = don’t care
Instruction TDI Sequence TDO Sequence Notes
4g. Poll for Page Write Complete 0110011_00000000 xxxxxox_xxxxxxxx (2)
5a. Enter EEPROM Read 0100011_00000011 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
5b. Load Address High Byte 0000111_aaaaaaaa xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx (10)
5c. Load Address Low Byte 0000011_bbbbbbbb xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
0110011_bbbbbbbb xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
5d. Read Data Byte 0110010_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
0110011_00000000 xxxxxxx_oooooooo
6a. Enter Fuse Write 0100011_01000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
6b. Load Data Low Byte(6) 0010011_iiiiiiii xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx (3)
0111011_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
0111001_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
6c. Write Fuse Extended Byte (1)
0111011_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
0111011_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
6d. Poll for Fuse Write Complete 0110111_00000000 xxxxxox_xxxxxxxx (2)
(7)
6e. Load Data Low Byte 0010011_iiiiiiii xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx (3)
0110111_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
0110101_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
6f. Write Fuse High Byte (1)
0110111_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
0110111_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
6g. Poll for Fuse Write Complete 0110111_00000000 xxxxxox_xxxxxxxx (2)
6h. Load Data Low Byte(7) 0010011_iiiiiiii xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx (3)
0110011_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
0110001_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
6i. Write Fuse Low Byte (1)
0110011_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
0110011_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
6j. Poll for Fuse Write Complete 0110011_00000000 xxxxxox_xxxxxxxx (2)
7a. Enter Lock Bit Write 0100011_00100000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
7b. Load Data Byte(9) 0010011_11iiiiii xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx (4)
0110011_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
0110001_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
7c. Write Lock Bits (1)
0110011_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
0110011_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
7d. Poll for Lock Bit Write complete 0110011_00000000 xxxxxox_xxxxxxxx (2)
8a. Enter Fuse/Lock Bit Read 0100011_00000100 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
0111010_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
8b. Read Extended Fuse Byte(6)
0111011_00000000 xxxxxxx_oooooooo
0111110_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
8c. Read Fuse High Byte(7)
0111111_00000000 xxxxxxx_oooooooo
393
7593D–AVR–07/06
Table 29-17. JTAG Programming Instruction (Continued)
Set (Continued) a = address high bits, b = address low bits, c = address extended bits, H = 0 - Low byte, 1 - High Byte,
o = data out, i = data in, x = don’t care
Instruction TDI Sequence TDO Sequence Notes
0110010_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
8d. Read Fuse Low Byte(8)
0110011_00000000 xxxxxxx_oooooooo
0110110_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
8e. Read Lock Bits(9) (5)
0110111_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxoooooo
0111010_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx (5)
0111110_00000000 xxxxxxx_oooooooo Fuse Ext. byte
8f. Read Fuses and Lock Bits 0110010_00000000 xxxxxxx_oooooooo Fuse High byte
0110110_00000000 xxxxxxx_oooooooo Fuse Low byte
0110111_00000000 xxxxxxx_oooooooo Lock bits
9a. Enter Signature Byte Read 0100011_00001000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
9b. Load Address Byte 0000011_bbbbbbbb xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
0110010_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
9c. Read Signature Byte
0110011_00000000 xxxxxxx_oooooooo
10a. Enter Calibration Byte Read 0100011_00001000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
10b. Load Address Byte 0000011_bbbbbbbb xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
0110110_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
10c. Read Calibration Byte
0110111_00000000 xxxxxxx_oooooooo
0100011_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
11a. Load No Operation Command
0110011_00000000 xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
Notes: 1. This command sequence is not required if the seven MSB are correctly set by the previous command sequence (which is
normally the case).
2. Repeat until o = “1”.
3. Set bits to “0” to program the corresponding Fuse, “1” to unprogram the Fuse.
4. Set bits to “0” to program the corresponding Lock bit, “1” to leave the Lock bit unchanged.
5. “0” = programmed, “1” = unprogrammed.
6. The bit mapping for Fuses Extended byte is listed in Table 29-3 on page 369
7. The bit mapping for Fuses High byte is listed in Table 29-4 on page 370
8. The bit mapping for Fuses Low byte is listed in Table 29-5 on page 370
9. The bit mapping for Lock bits byte is listed in Table 29-1 on page 368
10. Address bits exceeding PCMSB and EEAMSB (Table 29-11 and Table 29-12) are don’t care
11. All TDI and TDO sequences are represented by binary digits (0b...).
394 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Figure 29-15. State Machine Sequence for Changing/Reading the Data Word
1 Test-Logic-Reset
0 1 1 1
Run-Test/Idle Select-DR Scan Select-IR Scan
0 0
1 1
Capture-DR Capture-IR
0 0
Shift-DR 0 Shift-IR 0
1 1
1 1
Exit1-DR Exit1-IR
0 0
Pause-DR 0 Pause-IR 0
1 1
0 0
Exit2-DR Exit2-IR
1 1
Update-DR Update-IR
1 0 1 0
395
7593D–AVR–07/06
ture-DR encountered after entering the PROG_PAGEREAD command. The Program Counter is
post-incremented after reading each high byte, including the first read byte. This ensures that
the first data is captured from the first address set up by PROG_COMMANDS, and reading the
last location in the page makes the program counter increment into the next page.
STROBES
State
Machine
TDI
ADDRESS
Flash
EEPROM
Fuses
Lock Bits
D
A
T
A
TDO
The state machine controlling the Flash Data Byte Register is clocked by TCK. During normal
operation in which eight bits are shifted for each Flash byte, the clock cycles needed to navigate
through the TAP controller automatically feeds the state machine for the Flash Data Byte Regis-
ter with sufficient number of clock pulses to complete its operation transparently for the user.
However, if too few bits are shifted between each Update-DR state during page load, the TAP
controller should stay in the Run-Test/Idle state for some TCK cycles to ensure that there are at
least 11 TCK cycles between each Update-DR state.
396 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
29.9.15 Performing Chip Erase
1. Enter JTAG instruction PROG_COMMANDS.
2. Start Chip Erase using programming instruction 1a.
3. Poll for Chip Erase complete using programming instruction 1b, or wait for tWLRH_CE
(refer to Table 29-13 on page 382).
397
7593D–AVR–07/06
1. Enter JTAG instruction PROG_COMMANDS.
2. Enable Flash read using programming instruction 3a.
3. Load the page address using programming instructions 3b, 3c and 3d. PCWORD (refer
to Table 29-11 on page 373) is used to address within one page and must be written as
0.
4. Enter JTAG instruction PROG_PAGEREAD.
5. Read the entire page (or Flash) by shifting out all instruction words in the page (or
Flash), starting with the LSB of the first instruction in the page (Flash) and ending with
the MSB of the last instruction in the page (Flash). The Capture-DR state both captures
the data from the Flash, and also auto-increments the program counter after each word
is read. Note that Capture-DR comes before the shift-DR state. Hence, the first byte
which is shifted out contains valid data.
6. Enter JTAG instruction PROG_COMMANDS.
7. Repeat steps 3 to 6 until all data have been read.
398 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
6. Load data low byte using programming instructions 6e. A “0” will program the fuse, a
“1” will unprogram the fuse.
7. Write Fuse low byte using programming instruction 6f.
8. Poll for Fuse write complete using programming instruction 6g, or wait for tWLRH (refer to
Table 29-13 on page 382).
399
7593D–AVR–07/06
30. Electrical Characteristics
30.2 DC Characteristics
TA = -40°C to 85°C, VCC = 1.8V to 5.5V (unless otherwise noted)
Symbol Parameter Condition Min.(5) Typ. Max.(5) Units
(1)
Input Low Voltage,Except VCC = 1.8V - 2.4V -0.5 0.2VCC
VIL V
XTAL1 and Reset pin VCC = 2.4V - 5.5V -0.5 0.3VCC(1)
Input Low Voltage,
VIL1 VCC = 1.8V - 5.5V -0.5 0.1VCC(1) V
XTAL1 pin
Input Low Voltage,
VIL2 VCC = 1.8V - 5.5V -0.5 0.1VCC(1) V
RESET pin
Input High Voltage,
VCC = 1.8V - 2.4V 0.7VCC(2) VCC + 0.5
VIH Except XTAL1 and V
VCC = 2.4V - 5.5V 0.6VCC(2) VCC + 0.5
RESET pins
Input High Voltage, VCC = 1.8V - 2.4V 0.8VCC(2) VCC + 0.5
VIH1 V
XTAL1 pin VCC = 2.4V - 5.5V 0.7VCC(2) VCC + 0.5
Input High Voltage,
VIH2 VCC = 1.8V - 5.5V 0.9VCC(2) VCC + 0.5 V
RESET pin
IOL = 10mA, VCC = 5V 0.7
VOL Output Low Voltage(3), V
IOL = 5mA, VCC = 3V 0.5
IOH = -20mA, VCC = 5V 4.2
VOH Output High Voltage(4), V
IOH = -10mA, VCC = 3V 2.3
Input Leakage VCC = 5.5V, pin low
IIL 1 µA
Current I/O Pin (absolute value)
Input Leakage VCC = 5.5V, pin high
IIH 1 µA
Current I/O Pin (absolute value)
RRST Reset Pull-up Resistor 30 60 kΩ
RPU I/O Pin Pull-up Resistor 20 50 kΩ
400 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
TA = -40°C to 85°C, VCC = 1.8V to 5.5V (unless otherwise noted) (Continued)
Symbol Parameter Condition Min.(5) Typ. Max.(5) Units
Active 1MHz, VCC = 2V
0.8 mA
(AT90USB64/128)
Active 4MHz, VCC = 3V
5 mA
(AT90USB64/128)
Active 8MHz, VCC = 5V
18 mA
(AT90USB64/128)
(6)
Power Supply Current
Idle 1MHz, VCC = 2V
ICC 0.4 0.75 mA
(AT90USB64/128)
Idle 4MHz, VCC = 3V
2.2 mA
(AT90USB64/128)
Idle 8MHz, VCC = 5V
8 mA
(AT90USB64/128)
WDT enabled, VCC = 3V <10 20 µA
Power-down mode
WDT disabled, VCC = 3V <1 3 µA
401
7593D–AVR–07/06
30.3 External Clock Drive Waveforms
V IH1
V IL1
Note: All DC Characteristics contained in this datasheet are based on simulation and characterization of
other AVR microcontrollers manufactured in the same process technology. These values are pre-
liminary values representing design targets, and will be updated after characterization of actual
silicon.
402 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Figure 30-2. Maximum Frequency vs. VCC, AT90USB64/128
403
7593D–AVR–07/06
Table 30-2. 2-wire Serial Bus Requirements (Continued)
Symbol Parameter Condition Min Max Units
Bus free time between a STOP and START fSCL ≤ 100 kHz 4.7 – µs
tBUF
condition fSCL > 100 kHz 1.3 – µs
Notes: 1. In AT90USB64/128, this parameter is characterized and not 100% tested.
2. Required only for fSCL > 100 kHz.
3. Cb = capacitance of one bus line in pF.
4. fCK = CPU clock frequency
5. This requirement applies to all AT90USB64/128 2-wire Serial Interface operation. Other devices connected to the 2-wire
Serial Bus need only obey the general fSCL requirement.
6. The actual low period generated by the AT90USB64/128 2-wire Serial Interface is (1/fSCL - 2/fCK), thus fCK must be greater
than 6 MHz for the low time requirement to be strictly met at fSCL = 100 kHz.
7. The actual low period generated by the AT90USB64/128 2-wire Serial Interface is (1/fSCL - 2/fCK), thus the low time require-
ment will not be strictly met for fSCL > 308 kHz when fCK = 8 MHz. Still, AT90USB64/128 devices connected to the bus may
communicate at full speed (400 kHz) with other AT90USB64/128 devices, as well as any other device with a proper tLOW
acceptance margin.
tLOW tLOW
SCL
tSU;STA tHD;STA tHD;DAT tSU;DAT
tSU;STO
SDA
tBUF
404 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
30.7 SPI Timing Characteristics
See Figure 30-4 and Figure 30-5 for details.
Note: 1. In SPI Programming mode the minimum SCK high/low period is:
- 2 tCLCL for fCK < 12 MHz
- 3 tCLCL for fCK > 12 MHz
SCK
(CPOL = 0)
2 2
SCK
(CPOL = 1)
4 5 3
MISO
MSB ... LSB
(Data Input)
7 8
MOSI
MSB ... LSB
(Data Output)
405
7593D–AVR–07/06
Figure 30-5. SPI Interface Timing Requirements (Slave Mode)
SS
10 16
9
SCK
(CPOL = 0)
11 11
SCK
(CPOL = 1)
13 14 12
MOSI
MSB ... LSB
(Data Input)
15 17
MISO
MSB ... LSB X
(Data Output)
RESET
tSHRH tHHRH
ALE/HWB
406 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
30.9 ADC Characteristics – Preliminary Data
Table 30-5. ADC Characteristics
Symbol Parameter Condition Min(1) Typ(1) Max(1) Units
Single Ended Conversion 10 Bits
Differential Conversion
8 Bits
Resolution Gain = 1x or 20x
Differential Conversion
7 Bits
Gain = 200x
Single Ended Conversion
VREF = 4V, VCC = 4V, 2 2.5 LSB
ADC clock = 200 kHz
Single Ended Conversion
VREF = 4V, VCC = 4V, 4.5 LSB
ADC clock = 1 MHz
Absolute accuracy (Including
INL, DNL, quantization error, Single Ended Conversion
gain and offset error) VREF = 4V, VCC = 4V,
2 LSB
ADC clock = 200 kHz
Noise Reduction Mode
Single Ended Conversion
VREF = 4V, VCC = 4V,
4.5 LSB
ADC clock = 1 MHz
Noise Reduction Mode
Single Ended Conversion
Integral Non-Linearity (INL) VREF = 4V, VCC = 4V, 0.5 LSB
ADC clock = 200 kHz
Single Ended Conversion
Differential Non-Linearity (DNL) VREF = 4V, VCC = 4V, 0.25 LSB
ADC clock = 200 kHz
Single Ended Conversion
Gain Error VREF = 4V, VCC = 4V, 2 LSB
ADC clock = 200 kHz
Single Ended Conversion
Offset Error VREF = 4V, VCC = 4V, 2 LSB
ADC clock = 200 kHz
Conversion Time Free Running Conversion 13 260 µs
Clock Frequency Single Ended Conversion 50 1000 kHz
AVCC Analog Supply Voltage VCC - 0.3 VCC + 0.3 V
Single Ended Conversion 1.0 AVCC V
VREF Reference Voltage
Differential Conversion 1.0 AVCC - 0.5 V
Single ended channels GND VREF V
VIN Input Voltage
Differential Conversion 0 AVCC V
Single Ended Channels 38,5 kHz
Input Bandwidth
Differential Channels 4 kHz
VINT1 Internal Voltage Reference 1.1V 1.0 1.1 1.2 V
407
7593D–AVR–07/06
Table 30-5. ADC Characteristics (Continued)
Symbol Parameter Condition Min(1) Typ(1) Max(1) Units
VINT2 Internal Voltage Reference 2.56V 2.4 2.56 2.8 V
RREF Reference Input Resistance 32 kΩ
RAIN Analog Input Resistance 100 MΩ
Notes: 1. Values are guidelines only. Actual values are TBD
Notes: 1. This assumes 50% clock duty cycle. The half period is actually the high time of the external clock, XTAL1.
2. This assumes 50% clock duty cycle. The half period is actually the low time of the external clock, XTAL1.
408 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Table 30-7. External Data Memory Characteristics, 4.5 - 5.5 Volts, 1 Cycle Wait-state
8 MHz Oscillator Variable Oscillator
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Unit
0 1/tCLCL Oscillator Frequency 0.0 16 MHz
10 tRLDV Read Low to Data Valid 200 2.0tCLCL-50 ns
12 tRLRH RD Pulse Width 240 2.0tCLCL-10 ns
15 tDVWH Data Valid to WR High 240 2.0tCLCL ns
16 tWLWH WR Pulse Width 240 2.0tCLCL-10 ns
Table 30-8. External Data Memory Characteristics, 4.5 - 5.5 Volts, SRWn1 = 1, SRWn0 = 0
4 MHz Oscillator Variable Oscillator
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Unit
0 1/tCLCL Oscillator Frequency 0.0 16 MHz
10 tRLDV Read Low to Data Valid 325 3.0tCLCL-50 ns
12 tRLRH RD Pulse Width 365 3.0tCLCL-10 ns
15 tDVWH Data Valid to WR High 375 3.0tCLCL ns
16 tWLWH WR Pulse Width 365 3.0tCLCL-10 ns
Table 30-9. External Data Memory Characteristics, 4.5 - 5.5 Volts, SRWn1 = 1, SRWn0 = 1
4 MHz Oscillator Variable Oscillator
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Unit
0 1/tCLCL Oscillator Frequency 0.0 16 MHz
10 tRLDV Read Low to Data Valid 325 3.0tCLCL-50 ns
12 tRLRH RD Pulse Width 365 3.0tCLCL-10 ns
14 tWHDX Data Hold After WR High 240 2.0tCLCL-10 ns
15 tDVWH Data Valid to WR High 375 3.0tCLCL ns
16 tWLWH WR Pulse Width 365 3.0tCLCL-10 ns
Table 30-10. External Data Memory Characteristics, 2.7 - 5.5 Volts, No Wait-state
4 MHz Oscillator Variable Oscillator
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Unit
0 1/tCLCL Oscillator Frequency 0.0 8 MHz
1 tLHLL ALE Pulse Width 235 tCLCL-15 ns
(1)
2 tAVLL Address Valid A to ALE Low 115 0.5tCLCL-10 ns
Address Hold After ALE Low,
3a tLLAX_ST 5 5 ns
write access
409
7593D–AVR–07/06
Table 30-10. External Data Memory Characteristics, 2.7 - 5.5 Volts, No Wait-state (Continued)
4 MHz Oscillator Variable Oscillator
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Unit
Address Hold after ALE Low,
3b tLLAX_LD 5 5 ns
read access
4 tAVLLC Address Valid C to ALE Low 115 0.5tCLCL-10(1) ns
5 tAVRL Address Valid to RD Low 235 1.0tCLCL-15 ns
6 tAVWL Address Valid to WR Low 235 1.0tCLCL-15 ns
(2) (2)
7 tLLWL ALE Low to WR Low 115 130 0.5tCLCL-10 0.5tCLCL+5 ns
(2) (2)
8 tLLRL ALE Low to RD Low 115 130 0.5tCLCL-10 0.5tCLCL+5 ns
9 tDVRH Data Setup to RD High 45 45 ns
10 tRLDV Read Low to Data Valid 190 1.0tCLCL-60 ns
11 tRHDX Data Hold After RD High 0 0 ns
12 tRLRH RD Pulse Width 235 1.0tCLCL-15 ns
(1)
13 tDVWL Data Setup to WR Low 105 0.5tCLCL-20 ns
14 tWHDX Data Hold After WR High 235 1.0tCLCL-15 ns
15 tDVWH Data Valid to WR High 250 1.0tCLCL ns
16 tWLWH WR Pulse Width 235 1.0tCLCL-15 ns
Notes: 1. This assumes 50% clock duty cycle. The half period is actually the high time of the external clock, XTAL1.
2. This assumes 50% clock duty cycle. The half period is actually the low time of the external clock, XTAL1.
Table 30-11. External Data Memory Characteristics, 2.7 - 5.5 Volts, SRWn1 = 0, SRWn0 = 1
4 MHz Oscillator Variable Oscillator
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Unit
0 1/tCLCL Oscillator Frequency 0.0 8 MHz
10 tRLDV Read Low to Data Valid 440 2.0tCLCL-60 ns
12 tRLRH RD Pulse Width 485 2.0tCLCL-15 ns
15 tDVWH Data Valid to WR High 500 2.0tCLCL ns
16 tWLWH WR Pulse Width 485 2.0tCLCL-15 ns
Table 30-12. External Data Memory Characteristics, 2.7 - 5.5 Volts, SRWn1 = 1, SRWn0 = 0
4 MHz Oscillator Variable Oscillator
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Unit
0 1/tCLCL Oscillator Frequency 0.0 8 MHz
10 tRLDV Read Low to Data Valid 690 3.0tCLCL-60 ns
12 tRLRH RD Pulse Width 735 3.0tCLCL-15 ns
15 tDVWH Data Valid to WR High 750 3.0tCLCL ns
16 tWLWH WR Pulse Width 735 3.0tCLCL-15 ns
410 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Table 30-13. External Data Memory Characteristics, 2.7 - 5.5 Volts, SRWn1 = 1, SRWn0 = 1
4 MHz Oscillator Variable Oscillator
Symbol Parameter Min Max Min Max Unit
0 1/tCLCL Oscillator Frequency 0.0 8 MHz
10 tRLDV Read Low to Data Valid 690 3.0tCLCL-60 ns
12 tRLRH RD Pulse Width 735 3.0tCLCL-15 ns
14 tWHDX Data Hold After WR High 485 2.0tCLCL-15 ns
15 tDVWH Data Valid to WR High 750 3.0tCLCL ns
16 tWLWH WR Pulse Width 735 3.0tCLCL-15 ns
ALE
4 7
Write
14
6 16
WR
3b 9 11
Read
5 10
8 12
RD
411
7593D–AVR–07/06
Figure 30-8. External Memory Timing (SRWn1 = 0, SRWn0 = 1)
T1 T2 T3 T4 T5
ALE
4 7
Write
14
6 16
WR
3b 9 11
Read
5 10
8 12
RD
ALE
4 7
15
2 3a 13
Write
14
6 16
WR
3b 9 11
Read
5 10
8 12
RD
412 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Figure 30-10. External Memory Timing (SRWn1 = 1, SRWn0 = 1)()
T1 T2 T3 T4 T5 T6 T7
ALE
4 7
15
2 3a 13
Write
14
6 16
WR
3b 9 11
Read
5 10
8 12
RD
The ALE pulse in the last period (T4-T7) is only present if the next instruction accesses the RAM (internal
or external).
413
7593D–AVR–07/06
31. Register Summary
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Page
(0xFF) Reserved - - - - - - - -
(0xFE) Reserved - - - - - - - -
(0xFD) Reserved - - - - - - - -
(0xFC) Reserved - - - - - - - -
(0xFB) Reserved - - - - - - - -
(0xFA) Reserved - - - - - - - -
(0xF9) OTGTCON 1 PAGE VALUE
(0xF8) UPINT PINT7:0
(0xF7) UPBCHX - - - - - PBYCT10:8
(0xF6) UPBCLX PBYCT7:0
(0xF5) UPERRX - COUNTER1:0 CRC16 TIMEOUT PID DATAPID DATATGL
(0xF4) UEINT EPINT6:0
(0xF3) UEBCHX - - - - - BYCT10:8
(0xF2) UEBCLX BYCT7:0
(0xF1) UEDATX DAT7:0
(0xF0) UEIENX FLERRE NAKINE - NAKOUTE RXSTPE RXOUTE STALLEDE TXINE
(0xEF) UESTA1X - - - - - CTRLDIR CURRBK1:0
(0xEE) UESTA0X CFGOK OVERFI UNDERFI ZLPSEEN DTSEQ1:0 NBUSYBK1:0
(0xED) UECFG1X EPSIZE2:0 EPBK1:0 ALLOC
(0xEC) UECFG0X EPTYPE1:0 ISOSW AUTOSW NYETSDIS EPDIR
(0xEB) UECONX STALLRQ STALLRQC RSTDT EPEN
(0xEA) UERST EPRST6:0
(0xE9) UENUM EPNUM2:0
(0xE8) UEINTX FIFOCON NAKINI RWAL NAKOUTI RXSTPI RXOUTI STALLEDI TXINI
(0xE7) UDTST OPMODE2 TSTPCKT TSTK TSTJ
(0xE6) UDMFN FNCERR
(0xE5) UDFNUMH FNUM10:8
(0xE4) UDFNUML FNUM7:0
(0xE3) UDADDR ADDEN UADD6:0
(0xE2) UDIEN UPRSME EORSME WAKEUPE EORSTE SOFE MSOFE SUSPE
(0xE1) UDINT UPRSMI EORSMI WAKEUPI EORSTI SOFI MSOFI SUSPI
(0xE0) UDCON LSM RMWKUP DETACH
(0xDF) OTGINT STOI HNPERRI ROLEEXI BCERRI VBERRI SRPI
(0xDE) OTGIEN STOE HNPERRE ROLEEXE BCERRE VBERRE SRPE
(0xDD) OTGCON 0 HNPREQ SRPREQ SRPSEL VBUSHWC VBUSREQ VBUSRQC
(0xDC) UDPADDH DPACC DPADD10:8
(0xDB) UDPADDL DPADD7:0
(0xDA) USBINT IDTI VBUSTI
(0xD9) USBSTA SPEED ID VBUS
(0xD8) USBCON USBE HOST FRZCLK OTGPADE IDTE VBUSTE
(0xD7) UHWCON UIMOD UIDE UVCONE UVREGE
(0xD6) Reserved
(0xD5) Reserved
(0xD4) Reserved
(0xD3) Reserved
(0xD2) Reserved - - - - - - - -
(0xD1) Reserved - - - - - - - -
(0xD0) Reserved - - - - - - - -
(0xCF) Reserved - - - - - - - -
(0xCE) UDR1 USART1 I/O Data Register
(0xCD) UBRR1H - - - - USART1 Baud Rate Register High Byte
(0xCC) UBRR1L USART1 Baud Rate Register Low Byte
(0xCB) Reserved - - - - - - - -
(0xCA) UCSR1C UMSEL11 UMSEL10 UPM11 UPM10 USBS1 UCSZ11 UCSZ10 UCPOL1
(0xC9) UCSR1B RXCIE1 TXCIE1 UDRIE1 RXEN1 TXEN1 UCSZ12 RXB81 TXB81
(0xC8) UCSR1A RXC1 TXC1 UDRE1 FE1 DOR1 PE1 U2X1 MPCM1
(0xC7) Reserved - - - - - - - -
(0xC6) Reserved - - - - - - - -
(0xC5) Reserved - - - - - - - -
(0xC4) Reserved - - - - - - - -
(0xC3) Reserved - - - - - - - -
(0xC2) Reserved - - - - - - - -
(0xC1) Reserved - - - - - - - -
(0xC0) Reserved - - - - - - - -
(0xBF) Reserved - - - - - - - -
414 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Page
(0xBE) Reserved - - - - - - - -
(0xBD) TWAMR TWAM6 TWAM5 TWAM4 TWAM3 TWAM2 TWAM1 TWAM0 -
(0xBC) TWCR TWINT TWEA TWSTA TWSTO TWWC TWEN - TWIE
(0xBB) TWDR 2-wire Serial Interface Data Register
(0xBA) TWAR TWA6 TWA5 TWA4 TWA3 TWA2 TWA1 TWA0 TWGCE
(0xB9) TWSR TWS7 TWS6 TWS5 TWS4 TWS3 - TWPS1 TWPS0
(0xB8) TWBR 2-wire Serial Interface Bit Rate Register
(0xB7) Reserved - - - - - - - -
(0xB6) ASSR - EXCLK AS2 TCN2UB OCR2AUB OCR2BUB TCR2AUB TCR2BUB
(0xB5) Reserved - - - - - - - -
(0xB4) OCR2B Timer/Counter2 Output Compare Register B
(0xB3) OCR2A Timer/Counter2 Output Compare Register A
(0xB2) TCNT2 Timer/Counter2 (8 Bit)
(0xB1) TCCR2B FOC2A FOC2B - - WGM22 CS22 CS21 CS20
(0xB0) TCCR2A COM2A1 COM2A0 COM2B1 COM2B0 - - WGM21 WGM20
(0xAF) UPDATX PDAT7:0
(0xAE) UPIENX FLERRE NAKEDE - PERRE TXSTPE TXOUTE RXSTALLE RXINE
(0xAD) UPCFG2X INTFRQ7:0
(0xAC) UPSTAX CFGOK OVERFI UNDERFI DTSEQ1:0 NBUSYBK1:0
(0xAB) UPCFG1X PSIZE2:0 PBK1:0 ALLOC
(0xAA) UPCFG0X PTYPE1:0 PTOKEN1:0 PEPNUM3:0
(0xA9) UPCONX PFREEZE INMODE AUTOSW RSTDT PEN
(0xA8) UPRST PRST6:0
(0xA7) UPNUM PNUM2:0
(0xA6) UPINTX FIFOCON NAKEDI RWAL PERRI TXSTPI TXOUTI RXSTALLI RXINI
(0xA5) UPINRQX INRQ7:0
(0xA4) UHFLEN FLEN7:0
(0xA3) UHFNUMH FNUM10:8
(0xA2) UHFNUML FNUM7:0
(0xA1) UHADDR HADD6:0
(0xA0) UHIEN UPRSME EORSME WAKEUPE EORSTE SOFE MSOFE SUSPE
(0x9F) UHINT HWUPI HSOFI RXRSMI RSMEDI RSTI DDISCI DCONNI
(0x9E) UHCON RESUME RESET SOFEN
(0x9D) OCR3CH Timer/Counter3 - Output Compare Register C High Byte
(0x9C) OCR3CL Timer/Counter3 - Output Compare Register C Low Byte
(0x9B) OCR3BH Timer/Counter3 - Output Compare Register B High Byte
(0x9A) OCR3BL Timer/Counter3 - Output Compare Register B Low Byte
(0x99) OCR3AH Timer/Counter3 - Output Compare Register A High Byte
(0x98) OCR3AL Timer/Counter3 - Output Compare Register A Low Byte
(0x97) ICR3H Timer/Counter3 - Input Capture Register High Byte
(0x96) ICR3L Timer/Counter3 - Input Capture Register Low Byte
(0x95) TCNT3H Timer/Counter3 - Counter Register High Byte
(0x94) TCNT3L Timer/Counter3 - Counter Register Low Byte
(0x93) Reserved - - - - - - - -
(0x92) TCCR3C FOC3A FOC3B FOC3C - - - - -
(0x91) TCCR3B ICNC3 ICES3 - WGM33 WGM32 CS32 CS31 CS30
(0x90) TCCR3A COM3A1 COM3A0 COM3B1 COM3B0 COM3C1 COM3C0 WGM31 WGM30
(0x8F) Reserved - - - - - - - -
(0x8E) Reserved - - - - - - - -
(0x8D) OCR1CH Timer/Counter1 - Output Compare Register C High Byte
(0x8C) OCR1CL Timer/Counter1 - Output Compare Register C Low Byte
(0x8B) OCR1BH Timer/Counter1 - Output Compare Register B High Byte
(0x8A) OCR1BL Timer/Counter1 - Output Compare Register B Low Byte
(0x89) OCR1AH Timer/Counter1 - Output Compare Register A High Byte
(0x88) OCR1AL Timer/Counter1 - Output Compare Register A Low Byte
(0x87) ICR1H Timer/Counter1 - Input Capture Register High Byte
(0x86) ICR1L Timer/Counter1 - Input Capture Register Low Byte
(0x85) TCNT1H Timer/Counter1 - Counter Register High Byte
(0x84) TCNT1L Timer/Counter1 - Counter Register Low Byte
(0x83) Reserved - - - - - - - -
(0x82) TCCR1C FOC1A FOC1B FOC1C - - - - -
(0x81) TCCR1B ICNC1 ICES1 - WGM13 WGM12 CS12 CS11 CS10
(0x80) TCCR1A COM1A1 COM1A0 COM1B1 COM1B0 COM1C1 COM1C0 WGM11 WGM10
(0x7F) DIDR1 - - - - - - AIN1D AIN0D
(0x7E) DIDR0 ADC7D ADC6D ADC5D ADC4D ADC3D ADC2D ADC1D ADC0D
(0x7D) - - - - - - - - -
415
7593D–AVR–07/06
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Page
(0x7C) ADMUX REFS1 REFS0 ADLAR MUX4 MUX3 MUX2 MUX1 MUX0
(0x7B) ADCSRB - ACME - - MUX5 ADTS2 ADTS1 ADTS0
(0x7A) ADCSRA ADEN ADSC ADATE ADIF ADIE ADPS2 ADPS1 ADPS0
(0x79) ADCH ADC Data Register High byte
(0x78) ADCL ADC Data Register Low byte
(0x77) Reserved - - - - - - - -
(0x76) Reserved - - - - - - - -
(0x75) XMCRB XMBK - - - - XMM2 XMM1 XMM0
(0x74) XMCRA SRE SRL2 SRL1 SRL0 SRW11 SRW10 SRW01 SRW00
(0x73) Reserved - - - - - - - -
(0x72) Reserved - - - - - - - -
(0x71) TIMSK3 - - ICIE3 - OCIE3C OCIE3B OCIE3A TOIE3
(0x70) TIMSK2 - - - - - OCIE2B OCIE2A TOIE2
(0x6F) TIMSK1 - - ICIE1 - OCIE1C OCIE1B OCIE1A TOIE1
(0x6E) TIMSK0 - - - - - OCIE0B OCIE0A TOIE0
(0x6D) Reserved - - - - - - - -
(0x6C) Reserved - - - - - - - -
(0x6B) PCMSK0 PCINT7 PCINT6 PCINT5 PCINT4 PCINT3 PCINT2 PCINT1 PCINT0
(0x6A) EICRB ISC71 ISC70 ISC61 ISC60 ISC51 ISC50 ISC41 ISC40
(0x69) EICRA ISC31 ISC30 ISC21 ISC20 ISC11 ISC10 ISC01 ISC00
(0x68) PCICR - - - - - - - PCIE0
(0x67) Reserved - - - - - - - -
(0x66) OSCCAL Oscillator Calibration Register
(0x65) PRR1 PRUSB - - - PRTIM3 - - PRUSART1
(0x64) PRR0 PRTWI PRTIM2 PRTIM0 - PRTIM1 PRSPI - PRADC
(0x63) Reserved - - - - - - - -
(0x62) Reserved - - - - - - - -
(0x61) CLKPR CLKPCE - - - CLKPS3 CLKPS2 CLKPS1 CLKPS0
(0x60) WDTCSR WDIF WDIE WDP3 WDCE WDE WDP2 WDP1 WDP0
0x3F (0x5F) SREG I T H S V N Z C
0x3E (0x5E) SPH SP15 SP14 SP13 SP12 SP11 SP10 SP9 SP8
0x3D (0x5D) SPL SP7 SP6 SP5 SP4 SP3 SP2 SP1 SP0
0x3C (0x5C) Reserved - - - - - - - -
0x3B (0x5B) RAMPZ - - - - - - RAMPZ1 RAMPZ0
0x3A (0x5A) Reserved - - - - - - - -
0x39 (0x59) Reserved - - - - - - - -
0x38 (0x58) Reserved - - - - - - - -
0x37 (0x57) SPMCSR SPMIE RWWSB SIGRD RWWSRE BLBSET PGWRT PGERS SPMEN
0x36 (0x56) Reserved - - - - - - - -
0x35 (0x55) MCUCR JTD - - PUD - - IVSEL IVCE
0x34 (0x54) MCUSR - - - JTRF WDRF BORF EXTRF PORF
0x33 (0x53) SMCR - - - - SM2 SM1 SM0 SE
0x32 (0x52) Reserved - - - - - - - -
OCDR/ OCDR7 OCDR6 OCDR5 OCDR4 OCDR3 OCDR2 OCDR1 OCDR0
0x31 (0x51) MONDR Monitor Data Register
0x30 (0x50) ACSR ACD ACBG ACO ACI ACIE ACIC ACIS1 ACIS0
0x2F (0x4F) Reserved - - - - - - - -
0x2E (0x4E) SPDR SPI Data Register
0x2D (0x4D) SPSR SPIF WCOL - - - - - SPI2X
0x2C (0x4C) SPCR SPIE SPE DORD MSTR CPOL CPHA SPR1 SPR0
0x2B (0x4B) GPIOR2 General Purpose I/O Register 2
0x2A (0x4A) GPIOR1 General Purpose I/O Register 1
0x29 (0x49) PLLCSR - - - PLLP2 PLLP1 PLLP0 PLLE PLOCK
0x28 (0x48) OCR0B Timer/Counter0 Output Compare Register B
0x27 (0x47) OCR0A Timer/Counter0 Output Compare Register A
0x26 (0x46) TCNT0 Timer/Counter0 (8 Bit)
0x25 (0x45) TCCR0B FOC0A FOC0B - - WGM02 CS02 CS01 CS00
0x24 (0x44) TCCR0A COM0A1 COM0A0 COM0B1 COM0B0 - - WGM01 WGM00
0x23 (0x43) GTCCR TSM - - - - - PSRASY PSRSYNC
0x22 (0x42) EEARH - - - - EEPROM Address Register High Byte
0x21 (0x41) EEARL EEPROM Address Register Low Byte
0x20 (0x40) EEDR EEPROM Data Register
0x1F (0x3F) EECR - - EEPM1 EEPM0 EERIE EEMPE EEPE EERE
0x1E (0x3E) GPIOR0 General Purpose I/O Register 0
0x1D (0x3D) EIMSK INT7 INT6 INT5 INT4 INT3 INT2 INT1 INT0
0x1C (0x3C) EIFR INTF7 INTF6 INTF5 INTF4 INTF3 INTF2 INTF1 INTF0
416 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Page
0x1B (0x3B) PCIFR - - - - - - - PCIF0
0x1A (0x3A) Reserved - - - - - - - -
0x19 (0x39) Reserved - - - - - - - -
0x18 (0x38) TIFR3 - - ICF3 - OCF3C OCF3B OCF3A TOV3
0x17 (0x37) TIFR2 - - - - - OCF2B OCF2A TOV2
0x16 (0x36) TIFR1 - - ICF1 - OCF1C OCF1B OCF1A TOV1
0x15 (0x35) TIFR0 - - - - - OCF0B OCF0A TOV0
0x14 (0x34) Reserved - - - - - - - -
0x13 (0x33) Reserved - - - - - - - -
0x12 (0x32) Reserved - - - - - - - -
0x11 (0x31) PORTF PORTF7 PORTF6 PORTF5 PORTF4 PORTF3 PORTF2 PORTF1 PORTF0
0x10 (0x30) DDRF DDF7 DDF6 DDF5 DDF4 DDF3 DDF2 DDF1 DDF0
0x0F (0x2F) PINF PINF7 PINF6 PINF5 PINF4 PINF3 PINF2 PINF1 PINF0
0x0E (0x2E) PORTE PORTE7 PORTE6 PORTE5 PORTE4 PORTE3 PORTE2 PORTE1 PORTE0
0x0D (0x2D) DDRE DDE7 DDE6 DDE5 DDE4 DDE3 DDE2 DDE1 DDE0
0x0C (0x2C) PINE PINE7 PINE6 PINE5 PINE4 PINE3 PINE2 PINE1 PINE0
0x0B (0x2B) PORTD PORTD7 PORTD6 PORTD5 PORTD4 PORTD3 PORTD2 PORTD1 PORTD0
0x0A (0x2A) DDRD DDD7 DDD6 DDD5 DDD4 DDD3 DDD2 DDD1 DDD0
0x09 (0x29) PIND PIND7 PIND6 PIND5 PIND4 PIND3 PIND2 PIND1 PIND0
0x08 (0x28) PORTC PORTC7 PORTC6 PORTC5 PORTC4 PORTC3 PORTC2 PORTC1 PORTC0
0x07 (0x27) DDRC DDC7 DDC6 DDC5 DDC4 DDC3 DDC2 DDC1 DDC0
0x06 (0x26) PINC PINC7 PINC6 PINC5 PINC4 PINC3 PINC2 PINC1 PINC0
0x05 (0x25) PORTB PORTB7 PORTB6 PORTB5 PORTB4 PORTB3 PORTB2 PORTB1 PORTB0
0x04 (0x24) DDRB DDB7 DDB6 DDB5 DDB4 DDB3 DDB2 DDB1 DDB0
0x03 (0x23) PINB PINB7 PINB6 PINB5 PINB4 PINB3 PINB2 PINB1 PINB0
0x02 (0x22) PORTA PORTA7 PORTA6 PORTA5 PORTA4 PORTA3 PORTA2 PORTA1 PORTA0
0x01 (0x21) DDRA DDA7 DDA6 DDA5 DDA4 DDA3 DDA2 DDA1 DDA0
0x00 (0x20) PINA PINA7 PINA6 PINA5 PINA4 PINA3 PINA2 PINA1 PINA0
Note: 1. For compatibility with future devices, reserved bits should be written to zero if accessed. Reserved I/O memory addresses
should never be written.
2. I/O registers within the address range $00 - $1F are directly bit-accessible using the SBI and CBI instructions. In these reg-
isters, the value of single bits can be checked by using the SBIS and SBIC instructions.
3. Some of the status flags are cleared by writing a logical one to them. Note that the CBI and SBI instructions will operate on
all bits in the I/O register, writing a one back into any flag read as set, thus clearing the flag. The CBI and SBI instructions
work with registers 0x00 to 0x1F only.
4. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the I/O addresses $00 - $3F must be used. When addressing I/O reg-
isters as data space using LD and ST instructions, $20 must be added to these addresses. The AT90USB64/128 is a
complex microcontroller with more peripheral units than can be supported within the 64 location reserved in Opcode for the
IN and OUT instructions. For the Extended I/O space from $60 - $1FF in SRAM, only the ST/STS/STD and LD/LDS/LDD
instructions can be used.
417
7593D–AVR–07/06
32. Instruction Set Summary
Mnemonics Operands Description Operation Flags #Clocks
ARITHMETIC AND LOGIC INSTRUCTIONS
ADD Rd, Rr Add two Registers Rd ← Rd + Rr Z,C,N,V,H 1
ADC Rd, Rr Add with Carry two Registers Rd ← Rd + Rr + C Z,C,N,V,H 1
ADIW Rdl,K Add Immediate to Word Rdh:Rdl ← Rdh:Rdl + K Z,C,N,V,S 2
SUB Rd, Rr Subtract two Registers Rd ← Rd - Rr Z,C,N,V,H 1
SUBI Rd, K Subtract Constant from Register Rd ← Rd - K Z,C,N,V,H 1
SBC Rd, Rr Subtract with Carry two Registers Rd ← Rd - Rr - C Z,C,N,V,H 1
SBCI Rd, K Subtract with Carry Constant from Reg. Rd ← Rd - K - C Z,C,N,V,H 1
SBIW Rdl,K Subtract Immediate from Word Rdh:Rdl ← Rdh:Rdl - K Z,C,N,V,S 2
AND Rd, Rr Logical AND Registers Rd ← Rd • Rr Z,N,V 1
ANDI Rd, K Logical AND Register and Constant Rd ← Rd • K Z,N,V 1
OR Rd, Rr Logical OR Registers Rd ← Rd v Rr Z,N,V 1
ORI Rd, K Logical OR Register and Constant Rd ← Rd v K Z,N,V 1
EOR Rd, Rr Exclusive OR Registers Rd ← Rd ⊕ Rr Z,N,V 1
COM Rd One’s Complement Rd ← 0xFF − Rd Z,C,N,V 1
NEG Rd Two’s Complement Rd ← 0x00 − Rd Z,C,N,V,H 1
SBR Rd,K Set Bit(s) in Register Rd ← Rd v K Z,N,V 1
CBR Rd,K Clear Bit(s) in Register Rd ← Rd • (0xFF - K) Z,N,V 1
INC Rd Increment Rd ← Rd + 1 Z,N,V 1
DEC Rd Decrement Rd ← Rd − 1 Z,N,V 1
TST Rd Test for Zero or Minus Rd ← Rd • Rd Z,N,V 1
CLR Rd Clear Register Rd ← Rd ⊕ Rd Z,N,V 1
SER Rd Set Register Rd ← 0xFF None 1
MUL Rd, Rr Multiply Unsigned R1:R0 ← Rd x Rr Z,C 2
MULS Rd, Rr Multiply Signed R1:R0 ← Rd x Rr Z,C 2
MULSU Rd, Rr Multiply Signed with Unsigned R1:R0 ← Rd x Rr Z,C 2
FMUL Rd, Rr Fractional Multiply Unsigned R1:R0 ← (Rd x Rr) << 1 Z,C 2
FMULS Rd, Rr Fractional Multiply Signed R1:R0 ← (Rd x Rr) << 1 Z,C 2
FMULSU Rd, Rr Fractional Multiply Signed with Unsigned R1:R0 ← (Rd x Rr) << 1 Z,C 2
BRANCH INSTRUCTIONS
RJMP k Relative Jump PC ← PC + k + 1 None 2
IJMP Indirect Jump to (Z) PC ← Z None 2
EIJMP Extended Indirect Jump to (Z) PC ←(EIND:Z) None 2
JMP k Direct Jump PC ← k None 3
RCALL k Relative Subroutine Call PC ← PC + k + 1 None 4
ICALL Indirect Call to (Z) PC ← Z None 4
EICALL Extended Indirect Call to (Z) PC ←(EIND:Z) None 4
CALL k Direct Subroutine Call PC ← k None 5
RET Subroutine Return PC ← STACK None 5
RETI Interrupt Return PC ← STACK I 5
CPSE Rd,Rr Compare, Skip if Equal if (Rd = Rr) PC ← PC + 2 or 3 None 1/2/3
CP Rd,Rr Compare Rd − Rr Z, N,V,C,H 1
CPC Rd,Rr Compare with Carry Rd − Rr − C Z, N,V,C,H 1
CPI Rd,K Compare Register with Immediate Rd − K Z, N,V,C,H 1
SBRC Rr, b Skip if Bit in Register Cleared if (Rr(b)=0) PC ← PC + 2 or 3 None 1/2/3
SBRS Rr, b Skip if Bit in Register is Set if (Rr(b)=1) PC ← PC + 2 or 3 None 1/2/3
SBIC P, b Skip if Bit in I/O Register Cleared if (P(b)=0) PC ← PC + 2 or 3 None 1/2/3
SBIS P, b Skip if Bit in I/O Register is Set if (P(b)=1) PC ← PC + 2 or 3 None 1/2/3
BRBS s, k Branch if Status Flag Set if (SREG(s) = 1) then PC←PC+k + 1 None 1/2
BRBC s, k Branch if Status Flag Cleared if (SREG(s) = 0) then PC←PC+k + 1 None 1/2
BREQ k Branch if Equal if (Z = 1) then PC ← PC + k + 1 None 1/2
BRNE k Branch if Not Equal if (Z = 0) then PC ← PC + k + 1 None 1/2
BRCS k Branch if Carry Set if (C = 1) then PC ← PC + k + 1 None 1/2
BRCC k Branch if Carry Cleared if (C = 0) then PC ← PC + k + 1 None 1/2
BRSH k Branch if Same or Higher if (C = 0) then PC ← PC + k + 1 None 1/2
BRLO k Branch if Lower if (C = 1) then PC ← PC + k + 1 None 1/2
BRMI k Branch if Minus if (N = 1) then PC ← PC + k + 1 None 1/2
BRPL k Branch if Plus if (N = 0) then PC ← PC + k + 1 None 1/2
BRGE k Branch if Greater or Equal, Signed if (N ⊕ V= 0) then PC ← PC + k + 1 None 1/2
BRLT k Branch if Less Than Zero, Signed if (N ⊕ V= 1) then PC ← PC + k + 1 None 1/2
BRHS k Branch if Half Carry Flag Set if (H = 1) then PC ← PC + k + 1 None 1/2
BRHC k Branch if Half Carry Flag Cleared if (H = 0) then PC ← PC + k + 1 None 1/2
BRTS k Branch if T Flag Set if (T = 1) then PC ← PC + k + 1 None 1/2
BRTC k Branch if T Flag Cleared if (T = 0) then PC ← PC + k + 1 None 1/2
BRVS k Branch if Overflow Flag is Set if (V = 1) then PC ← PC + k + 1 None 1/2
418 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
Mnemonics Operands Description Operation Flags #Clocks
BRVC k Branch if Overflow Flag is Cleared if (V = 0) then PC ← PC + k + 1 None 1/2
BRIE k Branch if Interrupt Enabled if ( I = 1) then PC ← PC + k + 1 None 1/2
BRID k Branch if Interrupt Disabled if ( I = 0) then PC ← PC + k + 1 None 1/2
BIT AND BIT-TEST INSTRUCTIONS
SBI P,b Set Bit in I/O Register I/O(P,b) ← 1 None 2
CBI P,b Clear Bit in I/O Register I/O(P,b) ← 0 None 2
LSL Rd Logical Shift Left Rd(n+1) ← Rd(n), Rd(0) ← 0 Z,C,N,V 1
LSR Rd Logical Shift Right Rd(n) ← Rd(n+1), Rd(7) ← 0 Z,C,N,V 1
ROL Rd Rotate Left Through Carry Rd(0)←C,Rd(n+1)← Rd(n),C←Rd(7) Z,C,N,V 1
ROR Rd Rotate Right Through Carry Rd(7)←C,Rd(n)← Rd(n+1),C←Rd(0) Z,C,N,V 1
ASR Rd Arithmetic Shift Right Rd(n) ← Rd(n+1), n=0..6 Z,C,N,V 1
SWAP Rd Swap Nibbles Rd(3..0)←Rd(7..4),Rd(7..4)←Rd(3..0) None 1
BSET s Flag Set SREG(s) ← 1 SREG(s) 1
BCLR s Flag Clear SREG(s) ← 0 SREG(s) 1
BST Rr, b Bit Store from Register to T T ← Rr(b) T 1
BLD Rd, b Bit load from T to Register Rd(b) ← T None 1
SEC Set Carry C←1 C 1
CLC Clear Carry C←0 C 1
SEN Set Negative Flag N←1 N 1
CLN Clear Negative Flag N←0 N 1
SEZ Set Zero Flag Z←1 Z 1
CLZ Clear Zero Flag Z←0 Z 1
SEI Global Interrupt Enable I←1 I 1
CLI Global Interrupt Disable I←0 I 1
SES Set Signed Test Flag S←1 S 1
CLS Clear Signed Test Flag S←0 S 1
SEV Set Twos Complement Overflow. V←1 V 1
CLV Clear Twos Complement Overflow V←0 V 1
SET Set T in SREG T←1 T 1
CLT Clear T in SREG T←0 T 1
SEH Set Half Carry Flag in SREG H←1 H 1
CLH Clear Half Carry Flag in SREG H←0 H 1
DATA TRANSFER INSTRUCTIONS
MOV Rd, Rr Move Between Registers Rd ← Rr None 1
MOVW Rd, Rr Copy Register Word Rd+1:Rd ← Rr+1:Rr None 1
LDI Rd, K Load Immediate Rd ← K None 1
LD Rd, X Load Indirect Rd ← (X) None 2
LD Rd, X+ Load Indirect and Post-Inc. Rd ← (X), X ← X + 1 None 2
LD Rd, - X Load Indirect and Pre-Dec. X ← X - 1, Rd ← (X) None 2
LD Rd, Y Load Indirect Rd ← (Y) None 2
LD Rd, Y+ Load Indirect and Post-Inc. Rd ← (Y), Y ← Y + 1 None 2
LD Rd, - Y Load Indirect and Pre-Dec. Y ← Y - 1, Rd ← (Y) None 2
LDD Rd,Y+q Load Indirect with Displacement Rd ← (Y + q) None 2
LD Rd, Z Load Indirect Rd ← (Z) None 2
LD Rd, Z+ Load Indirect and Post-Inc. Rd ← (Z), Z ← Z+1 None 2
LD Rd, -Z Load Indirect and Pre-Dec. Z ← Z - 1, Rd ← (Z) None 2
LDD Rd, Z+q Load Indirect with Displacement Rd ← (Z + q) None 2
LDS Rd, k Load Direct from SRAM Rd ← (k) None 2
ST X, Rr Store Indirect (X) ← Rr None 2
ST X+, Rr Store Indirect and Post-Inc. (X) ← Rr, X ← X + 1 None 2
ST - X, Rr Store Indirect and Pre-Dec. X ← X - 1, (X) ← Rr None 2
ST Y, Rr Store Indirect (Y) ← Rr None 2
ST Y+, Rr Store Indirect and Post-Inc. (Y) ← Rr, Y ← Y + 1 None 2
ST - Y, Rr Store Indirect and Pre-Dec. Y ← Y - 1, (Y) ← Rr None 2
STD Y+q,Rr Store Indirect with Displacement (Y + q) ← Rr None 2
ST Z, Rr Store Indirect (Z) ← Rr None 2
ST Z+, Rr Store Indirect and Post-Inc. (Z) ← Rr, Z ← Z + 1 None 2
ST -Z, Rr Store Indirect and Pre-Dec. Z ← Z - 1, (Z) ← Rr None 2
STD Z+q,Rr Store Indirect with Displacement (Z + q) ← Rr None 2
STS k, Rr Store Direct to SRAM (k) ← Rr None 2
LPM Load Program Memory R0 ← (Z) None 3
LPM Rd, Z Load Program Memory Rd ← (Z) None 3
LPM Rd, Z+ Load Program Memory and Post-Inc Rd ← (Z), Z ← Z+1 None 3
ELPM Extended Load Program Memory R0 ← (RAMPZ:Z) None 3
ELPM Rd, Z Extended Load Program Memory Rd ← (Z) None 3
ELPM Rd, Z+ Extended Load Program Memory Rd ← (RAMPZ:Z), RAMPZ:Z ←RAMPZ:Z+1 None 3
419
7593D–AVR–07/06
Mnemonics Operands Description Operation Flags #Clocks
SPM Store Program Memory (Z) ← R1:R0 None -
IN Rd, P In Port Rd ← P None 1
OUT P, Rr Out Port P ← Rr None 1
PUSH Rr Push Register on Stack STACK ← Rr None 2
POP Rd Pop Register from Stack Rd ← STACK None 2
MCU CONTROL INSTRUCTIONS
NOP No Operation None 1
SLEEP Sleep (see specific descr. for Sleep function) None 1
WDR Watchdog Reset (see specific descr. for WDR/timer) None 1
BREAK Break For On-chip Debug Only None N/A
420 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
33. Ordering Information
Table 33-1. Possible Order Entries
USB Speed Power Supply
Ordering Code interface (MHz) (V) Package Operation Range Product Marking
421
7593D–AVR–07/06
33.1 TQFP64
422 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
33.2 QFN64
423
7593D–AVR–07/06
34. Errata
The revision letter in this section refers to the revision of the AT90USB64/128 device.
Problem fix/workaround
None.
Problem Fix/workaround
No known workaround, enable AT90USB64/128 TWI first versus the others nodes of the
TWI network.
Problem Fix/workaround
Before entering sleep, interrupts not used to wake up the part from the sleep mode should
be disabled.
Problem Fix/workaround
A software workaround is to wait with performing the sleep instruction until
TCNT2>OCR2+1.
424 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
34.2 AT90USB1287/6 Rev A
• USB signal rate
• VBUS residual level
• Spike on TWI pins when TWI is enabled
• High current consumption in sleep mode
• Async timer interrupt wake up from sleep generate multiple interrupts
5. UBS signal rate
The average USB signal rate may sometime be measured out of the USB specifications
(12MHz ±30kHz) with short frames. When measured on a long period, the average signal
rate value complies with the specifications. This bit rate deviation does not generates com-
munication or functional errors.
Problem fix/workaround
None.
4. VBUS residual level
In USB device and host mode, once a 5V level has been detected to the VBUS pad, a resid-
ual level (about 3V) can be measured on the VBUS pin.
Problem fix/workaround
None.
Problem Fix/workaround
No known workaround, enable AT90USB64/128 TWI first versus the others nodes of the
TWI network.
Problem Fix/workaround
Before entering sleep, interrupts not used to wake up the part from the sleep mode should
be disabled.
Problem Fix/workaround
A software workaround is to wait with performing the sleep instruction until
TCNT2>OCR2+1.
425
7593D–AVR–07/06
35. Datasheet Revision History for AT90USB64/128
Please note that the referring page numbers in this section are referred to this document. The
referring revision in this section are referring to the document revision.
426 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
1 Pin Configurations ................................................................................... 3
1.1Disclaimer ..................................................................................................................4
2 Overview ................................................................................................... 4
2.1Block Diagram ...........................................................................................................5
2.2Pin Descriptions .........................................................................................................6
1
7593D–AVR–07/06
7.1Idle Mode .................................................................................................................54
7.2ADC Noise Reduction Mode ....................................................................................54
7.3Power-down Mode ...................................................................................................54
7.4Power-save Mode ....................................................................................................54
7.5Standby Mode .........................................................................................................55
7.6Extended Standby Mode .........................................................................................55
7.7Power Reduction Register .......................................................................................56
7.8Minimizing Power Consumption ..............................................................................57
9 Interrupts ................................................................................................ 70
9.1Interrupt Vectors in AT90USB64/128 ......................................................................70
10 I/O-Ports .................................................................................................. 74
10.1Introduction ............................................................................................................74
10.2Ports as General Digital I/O ...................................................................................75
10.3Alternate Port Functions ........................................................................................79
10.4Register Description for I/O-Ports ..........................................................................92
2 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
14.1Overview ..............................................................................................................119
14.2Accessing 16-bit Registers ..................................................................................121
14.3Timer/Counter Clock Sources .............................................................................124
14.4Counter Unit ........................................................................................................124
14.5Input Capture Unit ...............................................................................................126
14.6Output Compare Units .........................................................................................128
14.7Compare Match Output Unit ................................................................................129
14.8Modes of Operation .............................................................................................131
14.9Timer/Counter Timing Diagrams .........................................................................138
14.1016-bit Timer/Counter Register Description ........................................................140
3
7593D–AVR–07/06
18.8Multi-processor Communication Mode ................................................................199
18.9USART Register Description ...............................................................................200
18.10Examples of Baud Rate Setting .........................................................................205
4 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
22 USB Device Operating modes ............................................................ 269
22.1Introduction ..........................................................................................................269
22.2Power-on and reset .............................................................................................269
22.3Speed identification on startup ............................................................................269
22.4Endpoint reset .....................................................................................................270
22.5USB reset ............................................................................................................270
22.6Endpoint selection ...............................................................................................270
22.7Endpoint activation ..............................................................................................270
22.8Address Setup .....................................................................................................271
22.9Suspend, Wake-up and Resume .........................................................................272
22.10Detach ...............................................................................................................272
22.11Remote Wake-up ...............................................................................................273
22.12STALL request ...................................................................................................273
22.13CONTROL endpoint management ....................................................................274
22.14OUT endpoint management ..............................................................................275
22.15IN endpoint management ..................................................................................277
22.16Isochronous mode .............................................................................................278
22.17Overflow ............................................................................................................279
22.18Interrupts ...........................................................................................................279
22.19Registers ...........................................................................................................281
5
7593D–AVR–07/06
23.16Registers ...........................................................................................................300
6 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
AT90USB64/128
28.3Read-While-Write and No Read-While-Write Flash Sections ..............................352
28.4Boot Loader Lock Bits .........................................................................................355
28.5Entering the Boot Loader Program ......................................................................356
28.6Addressing the Flash During Self-Programming .................................................360
28.7Self-Programming the Flash ................................................................................361
7
7593D–AVR–07/06
35 Datasheet Revision History for AT90USB64/128 .............................. 426
35.1Changes from 7593A to 7593B ...........................................................................426
35.2Changes from 7593B to 7593C ...........................................................................426
35.3Changes from 7593C to 7593D ...........................................................................426
8 AT90USB64/128
7593D–AVR–07/06
Atmel Corporation Atmel Operations
2325 Orchard Parkway Memory RF/Automotive
San Jose, CA 95131, USA 2325 Orchard Parkway Theresienstrasse 2
Tel: 1(408) 441-0311 San Jose, CA 95131, USA Postfach 3535
Fax: 1(408) 487-2600 Tel: 1(408) 441-0311 74025 Heilbronn, Germany
Fax: 1(408) 436-4314 Tel: (49) 71-31-67-0
Fax: (49) 71-31-67-2340
Regional Headquarters Microcontrollers
Europe 2325 Orchard Parkway 1150 East Cheyenne Mtn. Blvd.
Atmel Sarl San Jose, CA 95131, USA Colorado Springs, CO 80906, USA
Route des Arsenaux 41 Tel: 1(408) 441-0311 Tel: 1(719) 576-3300
Case Postale 80 Fax: 1(408) 436-4314 Fax: 1(719) 540-1759
CH-1705 Fribourg
Switzerland La Chantrerie Biometrics/Imaging/Hi-Rel MPU/
Tel: (41) 26-426-5555 BP 70602 High Speed Converters/RF Datacom
Fax: (41) 26-426-5500 44306 Nantes Cedex 3, France Avenue de Rochepleine
Tel: (33) 2-40-18-18-18 BP 123
Asia Fax: (33) 2-40-18-19-60 38521 Saint-Egreve Cedex, France
Room 1219 Tel: (33) 4-76-58-30-00
Chinachem Golden Plaza ASIC/ASSP/Smart Cards Fax: (33) 4-76-58-34-80
77 Mody Road Tsimshatsui Zone Industrielle
East Kowloon 13106 Rousset Cedex, France
Hong Kong Tel: (33) 4-42-53-60-00
Tel: (852) 2721-9778 Fax: (33) 4-42-53-60-01
Fax: (852) 2722-1369
1150 East Cheyenne Mtn. Blvd.
Japan Colorado Springs, CO 80906, USA
9F, Tonetsu Shinkawa Bldg. Tel: 1(719) 576-3300
1-24-8 Shinkawa Fax: 1(719) 540-1759
Chuo-ku, Tokyo 104-0033
Japan Scottish Enterprise Technology Park
Tel: (81) 3-3523-3551 Maxwell Building
Fax: (81) 3-3523-7581 East Kilbride G75 0QR, Scotland
Tel: (44) 1355-803-000
Fax: (44) 1355-242-743
Literature Requests
www.atmel.com/literature
Disclaimer: The information in this document is provided in connection with Atmel products. No license, express or implied, by estoppel or otherwise,to anyintellectu-
alproperty right is granted by this document or in connection with the sale of Atmel products. EXCEPT AS SET FORTH IN ATMEL’S TERMS AND CONDI-TIONS OF
SALE LOCATED ON ATMEL’S WEB SITE, ATMEL ASSUMES NO LIABILITY WHATSOEVER AND DISCLAIMS ANY EXPRESS, IMPLIED OR STATUTORYWAR-
RANTY RELATING TO ITS PRODUCTS INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTY OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICU-
LARPURPOSE, OR NON-INFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL ATMEL BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE, SPECIAL
OR INCIDEN-TAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, DAMAGES FOR LOSS OF PROFITS, BUSINESS INTERRUPTION, OR LOSS OF INFORMA-
TION) ARISING OUTOF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THIS DOCUMENT, EVEN IF ATMEL HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAM-
AGES. Atmel makes norepresentationsor warranties with respect to the accuracy or completeness of the contents of this document and reserves the right to make
changes to specificationsand product descriptions at any time without notice. Atmel does not make any commitment to update the information contained herein.
Unless specifically provided otherwise, Atmel products are not suitable for, and shall not be used in, automotive applications. Atmel’s products are not intended,
authorized, or warranted for useas components in applications intended to support or sustainlife.
© Atmel Corporation 2006. All rights reserved. Atmel ®, logo and combinations thereof, are registered trademarks, and Everywhere You Are ®
are the trademarks of Atmel Corporation or its subsidiaries. Other terms and product names may be trademarks of others.
7593D–AVR–07/06